TranslationProblems Textbook by Hasan Ghazla
TranslationProblems Textbook by Hasan Ghazla
TranslationProblems Textbook by Hasan Ghazla
Problems of translation are mainly caused by grammar, words, style and sounds of
the Source Language (SL) (i.e. English here) when translated into the Target Language
(TL) (i.e. Arabic) which has different grammar and sometimes different words, sounds
and style. Solutions to these problems are suggested on the bases of the types of text,
context, readership, grammatical differences, etc. (More discussion of translation
problems and solutions will be given later on in this introduction). Thus, this approach
is completely practical, composed of problems and solutions of translating possible,
real and natural texts of different types. But, first, what is translation?
2. What is Translation?
As a subject, translation generally refers to all the processes and methods used to
render and / or transfer the meaning of the source language text into the target language
as closely, completely and accurately as possible, using: (1) words/phrases which
already have a direct equivalent in Arabic language; (2) new words or terms for which
no ready-made equivalents are available in Arabic; (3) foreign words or terms written
in Arabic letters as pronounced in their native origin; and (4) foreign words or terms
made to fit Arabic pronunciation, spelling and grammar. Here are examples to illustrate
these four types respectively:
1. ‘speak’ ()يتكلم
2. ‘satellite’ (اصطناعي )قمر
3. ‘aspirin’ ()أسبريين
4. ‘democracy’ ()دميقراطية
(More examples and illustrations are given throughout the forthcoming chapters).
1
Now, when we translate, what do we translate? Grammar, words, style or/and
sounds, or something else? The following point answers this question.
3. What Do We Translate?
LANGUAGE COMPONENTS
(Fig. 1)
2
We are always interested in how they combine, produce, influence, reflect and
crystallize meaning.
Hence, with few exceptions, we translate meaning, nothing else but meaning. This
means that anything not relevant to meaning is usually disregarded in translation
(except for certain texts like poetry where sound/prosodic features are sometimes more
important than meaning). On the other hand, meaning is not the product of words only
-as many would wrongly think - but also of grammar, style and sounds. Figure 2
illustrates the relationship between meaning, language, language components and
translation (it can be read both ways, top-bottom and bottom-up):
LANGUAGE
MEANING
TRANSLATION
(Fig. 2)
Having identified what we translate, the next point is to consider the way we
translate (or how we translate).
4. How Do We Translate?
This question implies two major points: (1) Methods of Translation and (2) The
Process of Translation.
3
2. Semantic vs. communicative translation (Newmark, op. cit.)
3. Formal correspondence vs. textual equivalence (Catford, 1965)
4. Formal equivalence vs. dynamic translation (Nida, 1964, Nida &Taber, 1969)
5. Non-pragmatic vs. pragmatic translation (Bell, 1991; Hatim&Mason, 1990
&1997, Baker, 1998; Snell-Hornby, 1988; and others).
6. Non-creative vs. creative translation (Beylard-Ozeroff and others, 1998).
7. Non-idiomatic vs. idiomatic translation (Newmark, 1988).
Perhaps there is no need to elaborate with details about these pairs of methods.
Suffice it to point out that the first pair, ‘literal vs. free translation’ explains more or
less the remaining pairs in general terms. As a matter of fact, the argument of today
about the methods of translation is not very much different in essence from the age-old
debate about literal and free translation methods, as Newmark (op. cit.) also declares:
"The central problem of translating has always been whether to translate literally or
freely". Thus, by discussing these two methods, we may understand the main lines of
argument about translation methods from a new angle, I hope.
Each English word is translated into an equivalent word in Arabic which is kept
the same as, and in line with that of English: e.g.
a. That child is intelligent
4
d. Please, stay with me on the campus
In fact, this method is risky as it may disrupt meaning and, hence, translation, for
a number of reasons, some of which are:
(1) It ignores the Target Language completely, making it subject to the Source
Language wholly and entirely.
(2) It disregards the grammatical differences between the two languages which belong
to two sometimes sharply different language families. That is, English is an Indo-
European, West Germanic language, whereas Arabic is Semitic.
(3) It transfers the SL grammar and word order (Newmark, 1988: 69). It does not
acknowledge the different word order(s) of the two languages.
5
(4) It has no respect for the context of words in language and allows for words to be
understood in isolation, not in combination with other surrounding words.
(5) It transfers the primary (or common) meanings of words (Newmark, op.cit.: 69).
By this, it dismisses the possibility of any polysemous, special, indirect or
metaphorical use of words.
(6) It cannot deal with the SL words that have no equivalents in the TL.
(7) It views meaning as the product of words only, which is not acceptable (see point
3 above).
Accordingly, the Arabic versions above are unacceptable, and have to be corrected
as follows (the unacceptable words or grammatical sequences are underlined):
(ذاك الطفل
------------------------------------------------------------ )ذكي
.a)ً→(ذاك الطفل يكون ذكيا
ماري
.b)ًشاي(ا
-----------------------------------
أرادت أن تأخذ → ))شايا
ً (أرادت ماري أن تشرب(تتناول
.-------------------------------------------------
c)→(هو يكون عائشاً من يد إىل فم )(يعيش على الكفاف
احلرم →(من فضلك امكث(ابق)معي على-----------------)(من فضلك ابق معي يف احلرم اجلامعي
.d)اجلامعي
-------------------------------------)املراوغة عن/والدوران
.e)الشجرية عن اللف
الضرب حول (كفأوقف
َّ (→
6
nouns into two nouns, one adjective into one adjective, two into two, and so on and so
forth. In a similar way, an idiom should be translated into an idiom, a collocation into a
collocation, a proverb into a proverb, a metaphor into a metaphor, etc. All these
translations are done in context, not out of context: e.g.
This method of literal translation is similar to the first one in two respects:
7
Therefore, it is perhaps more acceptable and better than word-for-word
translation. Yet, both methods are questionable. In fact, one-to-one translation is
sometimes unsatisfactory because:
(1) It transfers the SL grammar and word order, regardless of the TL grammar and
word order. This is confirmed in the examples by: (a) starting all the Arabic versions
with a subject then a verb each, ignoring nominal sentences ( ( اجلمل االمسيةand the start
with the verb in verbal sentences ((الفعلية ( ;اجلملb) insisting on translating verbs ‘be’
into ( )يكونand ‘have’ into ( )ميلكonly in all the examples; and (c) translating all
personal pronouns.
(2) It insists on having the same number and types of the SL words and lexical groups
in the TL. The result is two possible mistakes: first, the insistence on having an SL
collocation, idiom, metaphor, etc. translated into a TL equivalent collocation, idiom or
metaphor, even though it may not be available in its lexicon. ‘Shake hands’, for
example, has no equivalent collocation in Arabic, for ( )يصافح باأليديis not a collocation
and has an unnecessary use of()باأليدي, which is implied in ()يصافح. After all, people
have ( )مصافحةwith ‘hands’ only. Another example is the translation of the metaphor ‘a
can of worms’ into (مشاكل )حفنة. Usually, in Arabic such a metaphor is not available,
just an ordinary collocation (عويصة )مشكلة, which is a good translation, is available in
Arabic; secondly, the insistence on the same number of words in the translation, which
is sometimes not possible to achieve. That is why the one-word good translation, (
)يصافحis not used here to translate the two-word collocation, ‘shake hands’. Likewise,
‘well-known’ should not be translated into one word like ( bشهرية/معروفة/)مشهورة, despite
its possibility in Arabic. Nor is it acceptable to join the two short sentences of ‘c’ into
one sentence as the number of words will be less than the original, although it is quite
feasible in Arabic, as the following improved versions for the above examples on the
right handside show (the changed or omitted words are underlined):
8
f. (لنتصافح/نتصافح )دعنا (باأليدي )دعنا نتصافح
g. ‘h’ and ‘i’ are unchanged .
j. (الصعوبة بالغة/)هذه املهمة مشكلة عويصة (مشاكل )هذه املهمة تكون حفنة
More details about the problems of translating such examples are forthcoming.
1. “To
السباق) run in the race” ( يركض يف/جيري
9
9. “To run across” ()يصادف
10.“To
الوراء) run back” ( يعود بذاكرته إىل
15.“To
التناقص) run out” ( يأخذ يف/يتضاءل/ينفد
Similarly, metaphorical expressions like idioms can be looked at in the same way.
That is, their metaphorical meanings are the only meanings available in language and,
hence, in translation. Thus, “to beat around/about the bush” means only ( يلف
يراوغ/“ ;)ويدورto get the sack” has only the meaning of (طرد
َ ُ)ي, regardless of its origin;
“monkey business” means ( )أشياء مريبةonly; “tall order” has only one meaning as ( مهمة
( )شاقةsee Ch.2:5 on idioms). Other equivalent translations for these idioms are
acceptable, anyway. In literal translation of meaning, these are the only meanings
available and permissible to the translator.
It is possible to say, then, that literal translation is committed to the real meaning,
or meanings, of a word or an expression in language, regardless of whether it is direct
or indirect, common or uncommon, non-metaphorical or metaphorical. In other words,
10
literal meaning is the real, accurate and contextual meaning of a word, whether used
metaphorically or non-metaphorically, as illustrated in Figure 3.
(Fig. 3)
ً)منثورا, because they are metaphorical and expressive and, therefore, far from the direct
meanings of such a simple, straightforward sentence, especially in a general text.
However, such translations can be described as free translations which are justifiable in
certain texts and contexts (see the next subsection. See also 3. 11. later).
Thus, this method of literal translation is the translation of the real meaning of a
word, or an expression in its linguistic context as accurately and closely as possible,
regardless of its metaphorical/non-metaphorical use. It is confined to, and conditioned
by its context. Indeed, it is a contextual meaning that is enveloped in its context,
neither free, flexible nor variable, but straightforward, accurate, close and full.
Therefore, this method can be the most acceptable among the methods of literal
translation, and the most widely spread and popular in practice among students of
translation and translators. Hence, it is recommended for the students in particular, and
translators in general. Yet, this does not mean that free translation is unacceptable, for
it is highly recommended for certain texts, especially literary and figurative texts (see
below).
11
Like literal translation, free translation has been a well-established method of
translation since antiquity. Usually, it is associated with translating the spirit, or the
message, not the letter or the form of the text(see Newmak, 1988: 45). It used to earn
wide reputation as the better method at the expense of literal translation, the worse
method of translation. It is the method that is not committed to translate every single
word in a text. It means to translate freely without constraints. The translator is not
strictly constrained by the type of text or context, or the direct and available meaning
of words and phrases. He goes outside texts and out of contexts, behind and beyond
words and phrases, looking perhaps for the spirit, or the message. He can translate
something the way he understands it. His way of understanding is confined by text and
context variably to some or great extent. It is perhaps the only restriction on him. He
cannot translate the way he likes, but the way he understands. (All other terms pointed
out above and used nowadays to substitute for “free”, such as ‘communicative’,
‘dynamic’, ‘pragmatic’, ‘creative’ and 'idiomatic' coincide with many of these
implications).
The question now is whether free translation is acceptable or not. The answer can
be sought for in the next two types suggested for this method. The first type is close
and related to context directly, whereas the second is far and related to context
indirectly, as the following discussion and examples confirm:
This type of free translation is derived from the context in a direct way, though it
may go out of it in some way or another, in the form of exaggeration, expressivity, and
effective, rhetorical or formal language. It is the type we usually understand by the
term 'free translation'. Here are examples:
12
9. She) had a new baby
جديدا
ً
( ًرزقها اهلل مولودا
(e) collocations (2,3) (احلزن تفطر من/ )رابط اجلأشand 8 (يف أسرع من الربق+;)امتطى صهوة
(f) poetry (5 & 6);
(g) pompous, exaggerated expressions(7).
All these free translations are derived in one way or another from the original.
Although they have gone far from the context, they have not gone too far from it, or
outside it. This means that this type of free translation is not loose, or without
limitations, but is bound to context in some way. For these reasons, this method of free
translation can be acceptable, especially when justified by the type of text, or language
which allows for exaggeration or expressivity of some kind. It is very close to creative
translation. However, when the translation is quite strange to, and far away from the
context and type of text and, it is not advisable. Having said that, accurate,
straightforward, literal translation of meaning is probably a more preferable version for
these statements, especially in simple, general texts, as suggested below:
13
) (أتكذب علي؟.10 ً)(وضعت مولوداً جديدا.9
4. 1.2. 2. Loose Free Translation:
This free translation method goes far away from the direct linguistic context to
inferences. It is based on the translator's conclusions about what the speaker/writer
wants to say. In other words, it is the translation of intentions. In this sense, it is a
version of pragmatic translation. Therefore, it does not relate directly to the original
context, but is concluded from it. Here are some illustrative examples:
1. Thank you, Mr. Wilson. Next please. ( عندنا غريكb.ويلسون )تفضل باالنصراف يا سيد
2. It is half past nine. (حان الوقت/ًكثريا تأخرنا/علينا باملغادرة/انتهت احلصة/)انتهى الوقت
3. Thank
والسيدات) you, thank you ladies and gentlemen. ( هدوء أيها السادة
All these translations are conclusions, based on the original. They are indirect,
pragmatic translations, rendering the meaning intended by the speakers beyond what
they say. That is, in ‘1’, the speaker says “thank you” to a guest or a customer at the
end of their meeting, as an indirect way to ask him/her to leave. So, instead of asking
him/her directly to leave, he goes for “thank you”, which is understood as “will you
leave, the interview is over”( انتهت املقابلة، )تفضل باالنصراف.
The speaker of ‘2’ implies that the time of a class, a meeting, etc. is over, or the
time of leaving, or doing something is due.
14
The speaker of ‘4’ means to say that he/she cannot stay on his/her own because
he/she is afraid of something. Therefore, he/she asks the listener to stay with him/her,
however indirectly.
In ‘5’, the speaker uses the idiom, 'bigmouth' to express his dissatisfaction with a
person who yells at talking, or talks excessively, noisily and boastfully. Hence, the
translation, ( )أغلق فمكexpresses this dissatisfaction, ordering the big-mouthed person to
hush in a rude way.
“No bacon” in ‘6’ indicates that the speaker is a Muslim because pork is forbidden
meat in Islam, but not in Christianity. That is why the Arabic translation jumps to
religion.
On the other hand, ‘7’ is taken as an indirect comment on a dishonest act by the
hearer. Hence the translation, ( )أنت خنت األمانة.
These are loose translations that have in a sense deserted their direct, linguistic
contexts. They are more personal conclusions by the translator than direct translations
restricted in some way to context. Therefore, other translators may rightly and equally
have different conclusions. In other words, this method of free translation allows such
loose freedom for the translator to go far and translate the intentions and implications
beyond the direct context of texts. It does not matter whether these translations are
convincing and justified or not; rather, what matters is the fact that they do not translate
the language and the context on the page. They reflect indirect inferences and far
interpretations of translators. Therefore, they seem completely different from the
original to the extent that they can be seen by many as unrelated to it.
15
to readers in both languages to conclude. After all, this is a matter of respect for them.
The translator should not do the reading for the TL readers. It is not his responsibility,
then, to interpret and reveal what the source text hides or says indirectly. Hence, the
following are suggested alternative, closer and more advisable Arabic versions for the
same English sentences, to compare with the loose versions above:
Having said that, and as pointed out earlier, this does not mean that free
translation of both types cannot be recommended as good methods of translation. On
the contrary, they are perhaps more appropriate than literal methods for the translation
of specific types of language and text like literary texts of all genres, general, cultural,
journalistic, political or any text translated with the purpose of understanding its
message (the so-called (’ بتصرفb‘الرتمجة, regardless of full details. Free translation has
always been in use a long time ago in history by famous translators, and is still popular
and favourable among many translators nowadays. After all, it is the translator's
decision to adopt either a literal or a free translation method, provided he translates in
context as directly as possible.
Having discussed methods of translation, it is high time now to introduce the process of
translation: 'how translators proceed in translation'.
16
above). In fact, we do not proceed this way; we proceed a unit by unit. Each unit is
called ‘a unit of translation’.
A unit of translation is any word, or a group of words that can give either a small
or a large part of the meaning of a sentence. Therefore, it is a unit (or a part) of
meaning which can be taken together and understood independently. It marks a stop we
take at translating to write down a meaningful part of a sentence that is not affected by,
or dependent on its remaining part. This means that it can be one word (like: thus,
therefore, yet, actually, clearly, but and other adverbials at the beginning of sentences);
a phrase (e.g. collocations like: pass a law (ً)يسن قانونا, brain drain ()هجرة األدمغة, etc.; and
idioms such as: tall order (شاقة )مهمة, sitting duck (bفريسة سهلة/( )لقمة سائغةsee chapter 2 for
more examples); a clause (e.g. (1) “she did not come to work yesterday (2) because she
was sick” ( ألهنا كانت مريضة،)مل تأت إىل العمل أمس: two clauses = two units); or a sentence
(e.g. “the man who paid me a visit last week when I was away, was an old friend of
mine.”(صديقاً قدمياً يل،ً)كان الرجل الذي قام بزياريت حني كنت مسافرا. The last example is
regarded as one unit because the main clause (i.e. “the man was an old friend of mine”)
is divided into two parts: one at the beginning of the sentence (i.e. ‘the man’) and
another at the end of it (i.e. ‘was an old friend of mine’). Thus, the main verb of the
sentence (i.e. ‘was’) occurs toward the end of the sentence, away from its subject (i.e.
‘man’). In Arabic, we start the sentence with this verb (i.e.(كان, which means that we
have to read the whole English sentence before starting translating.
Thus, in practical terms, the largest unit of translation is the sentence for it is the
basic unit of thought (Newmark, 1988: 30-31), not the clause(Bell, 1991), nor the text
(Hatim&Mason, 1990&1997). Yet, from time to time, we might have clearcut clause
borderlines in a sentence, where clauses are separated parts of meaning that can be
taken as a unit of translation each. Similarly, at times, we may need to resort to the
whole text to understand a sentence. Yet, this is the exception, not the rule.
So far, we have discussed basic concepts about translation, including: the meaning
of translation, what we translate, and how we translate, with concentration on methods
of translation and the process of translation. We also have recommended the literal
method of direct translation of meaning to students for it might be safer, more secure
and appropriate to them than other methods of translation suggested above. At the
same time, free translation is not rejected nor undermined, but, rather, recommended
strongly more than literal translation for certain texts (see 4.2.2. above). Sometimes,
both methods, literal and free, can be applied alternately by the translator when the
need arises to use free translation only when literal translation makes the translation
17
inaccurate, "when it is unnatural, or when it will not work" as also Newmark (1988:
31) points out. Now we may discuss the obstacles presumably faced at translating and
how we overcome them. In other words, what are the problems of translation? What
are the solutions that can be suggested to them? And on what bases?
5. Translation Problems:
b. Different TL grammar:
Most English tenses, for example, do not exist in Arabic grammar. Also , all
English sentences are verbal (i.e. should include a main verb each), whereas in Arabic
they are either verbal, or nominal(viz. no verbs at all). Likewise, some modal
auxiliaries have no grammatical equivalent. etc. (See Ch.1 for further details).
18
2. Translation of modal verbs.
3. Translation of questions and negations.
4. Nominal vs. verbal sentences.
5. Word order.
6. Translation of personal pronouns.
7. Translation of present participle vs. gerund.
8. Translation of the past participle.
9. Translation of adjectives.
10. Translation of tenses.
11. Translation of conditional sentences.
12. The change of word class.
13. Translation of articles.
14. Translation of sentence connectors (like and, or, but, in fact, etc.).
All these problems are defined and exemplified for clearly in the next chapter,
with a view to pointing out their ensuing difficulties, and the possible solutions to
them. After all, our discussion of grammatical problems aims solely at locating any lost
or unclear part of meaning. We always trace meaning in translation, nothing else but
meaning, with very few exceptions, though.
2. Synonymy:
Words which have the same, or similar meaning are called synonyms. Synonymy
poses problems concerning the difference between the levels of closeness or absolute
identification of the meanings of synonymous words compared with one another in the
same language as well as between the two languages, the SL and the TL, and how
effective/ineffective that difference may be on meaning in context.
19
4. Collocations:
Two or more Words which usually occur together in language are called a
collocation. There are several types of collocations whose translation has problems that
require a good deal of attention from the students.
5. Idioms:
Phrases which have fixed forms and special meanings that cannot be known from
the direct meaning of their words, are called idioms (e.g. “to walk on water”) ( يصنع
)املعجزات. They also include phrasal verbs like “get on, get off, get out, get up, etc”.
They can sometimes be quite problematic for students.
6. Proverbs:
Proverbs are popular fixed sayings. They are a part of culture. Therefore, they
have their own problems of translation for eveybody, especially students of translation.
7. Metaphors:
Metaphors are indirect, non-literal language. They are used to say something but
mean something else. They are usually quite problematic and difficult for students.
In the past, style was not considered as a part of meaning, but outside meaning.
However, nowadays, it is rightly and properly seen as a part and parcel of meaning.
The latter view is adopted here in this textbook. The style of the SL text may pose
20
problems for the translator. They are important and strongly relevant to meaning, and
can sometimes affect it heavily. Among these problems are the following:
2. Fronting:
A word, a phrase, or a clause can be put at the beginning of a sentence in an
unusual way (e.g. “Suicide he committed”, instead of: “He committed suicide”. Such
fronting is done on purpose to achieve a stylistic function of some kind: emphasis of
the fronted word, or drawing attention to its special importance to the meaning of the
sentence. The students of translation may be unfamiliar with such a stylistic function,
and, hence, ignore the style of fronting. But this is not advisable since meaning will be
affected, however indirectly. On the other hand, there could be a problem conveying
the same style in Arabic. A good number of examples are provided in chapter three to
illustrate the different problems and stylistic functions of fronting.
3. Parallelism:
Two clauses, or sentences may have the same structure and are, therefore, parallel.
Such style of parallelism is not always easy to translate, and may have its problems in
Arabic. Moreover, it has stylistic functions which can be directly relevant to meaning.
Hence, we are required to attend to it carefully.
4. Ambiguity:
One of the common, but difficult problems of translation is the style of ambiguity.
It may cause misunderstanding, confusing, losing or dispersing meaning. Therefore, it
is important to discuss here under stylistic problems rather than under lexical problems
as conventionally done, for ambiguity of meaning is a matter of style before anything
else.
21
6. Style of short vs. long sentences:
Each of these two styles has its own translation problems and stylistic effects.
That is why they have to be retained in Arabic. Students are required to avoid
confusing or ignoring them by, for example, joining short sentences into one long
sentence, or dividing a long sentence into short sentences.
9. Redundancy:
The use of unnecessary, extra words to express something is called redundancy.
Usually, redundancy is disposed of in translation. But this is not always advisable
because it might be used on purpose to achieve a specific function. Thus, it should not
be ignored in Arabic. Rendering redundant style has its own problems which are
discussed through a variety of examples.
22
12. The style of irony:
One of the the extremely difficult styles of any language is that of irony. At the
same time, it is a lively, enjoyable, delicate, expressive and effective style that
translators have to be extra-careful with at reproducing it in the Arabic translation. In
the third chapter, this type of style is discussed in detail.
Therefore, meaning is affected and directed by style. The difficult point for the
students to understand is perhaps stylistic functions and effects, and how to conclude
them. The most important thing about them is that they are implied meanings we
conclude from the use of a particular style of language, on five main bases:
The discussion of stylistic problems in chapter three will hopefully provide great
help to readers in general, and to students of translation in particular to realize the
importance of style in translation.
These problems are concerned with sounds and their relation to, and effect on
meaning. They are assigned a separate chapter for their significance to meaning as well
as to the beauty of language, especially in poetry and certain texts of rhythmical
language. However, two points should be made here about these problems:
23
1. They are difficult to imitate or reflect in Arabic for the new students of
translation at the first stage of learning. Yet, at an advanced stage, the students
can tackle these problems more easily, especially when simplified (see chapter
four).
2. They are limited to advertising, literature, especially poetry, and to a small
number of general texts. Yet, they may be influential on meaning, but not as
influential as the other three types discussed earlier.
It must be pointed out here that most – but not all- of the translation problems are
discussed in this textbook. They have been simplified as much as possible to be
convenient with the students’ level of study as well as the general reader’s demands for
clarity and simplicity. Most of the time, they are numbered for the sake of easy
comprehension and location. However , they are sometimes just briefly pointed out in
the course of discussion when many details are not required. Complicated problems
like those of culture and phonology are postponed to a late position in the book to be
introduced to students and trainee translators at an advanced stage of their translation
course, when they will have become mature enough in translation to be able to grasp
and handle them more competently. Finally, each example used to illustrate any of
these problems has other problems of different kinds, but they are not discussed
together on the same occasion, in order to help the students avoid distraction of
concentration on a single problem, or else they might be confused. In other words, any
SL text can have all types of problems at the same time: grammatical, lexical, stylistic
and phonological. In practice, they cannot be separated; but in theory they can for the
convenience of discussion and comprehension.
24
3. The major linguistic context: the whole text, which could be one sentence
only, one paragraph, a poem, a short story, etc.
4. The type of readership: uneducated, educated, highly educated readers,
specialists, children, etc.
5. The possibility of saying something in the TL or not (e.g. for ‘fat salary’ we
can say ()راتب ضخم, but not ()راتب مسني.
6. The possibility or not of using an identical TL grammatical structure.
7. The logical acceptability of an expression (e.g. for ‘to eat one’s words’ the
logical translation is (يعتذر/)يسحب كالمه, but not (b )يأكل كلماتهbecause nobody
can eat words).
8. The social acceptability of an expression (e.g. for ‘good morning’ we say
( )صباح اخلريwhereas ( )صباح جيدis not accepted socially).
9. The normality or abnormality of an expression, or a grammatical structure
(e.g. ‘once upon a time’ is normal, while ‘once below a time’ is abnormal.
Each of which has its functions, and should be translated into an identical
Arabic version as follows:
(كان يا ما كان/يف يوم من األيام/ )ذات يومand (كان يا ما ما كان/يف يوم ليس من األيام/)ذات ال يوم
10. The frequency or non-frequency of an expression or a grammatical structure
(e.g. ‘to sow division’ is frequently translated into ( )يزرع الشقاقnot into( يبذر
)االنقسام. Also, “heart and soul” has the grammatical structure of(ً )قلباً وقالباnot
( )قلب وقالبin context, etc.).
11. The degree of familiarity or strangeness of an expression, or a grammatical
structure (e.g. ‘good reasons’ has the familiar translation of ()أسباب وجيهة
whereas ((جيدة أسبابseems strange, although both mean the same. Likewise,
‘I will verily do it’ has the familiar Arabic grammatical structure ( سوف أفعلها
b)بالتأكيد, but ( )أنا لسوف بالتأكيد أفعلهاis a little strange, etc. ).
12. The understandability or not of an expression (e.g. ‘tall order’ is understood
when translated into ()مهمة شاقة, but not understood as ())أمر طويل.
13. The applicability of the back–translation test. This test is to translate the
Arabic version back into English. When this is possible, translation is correct.
For example, ‘it is half past three’ can be translated back into English as such
when it is translated into Arabic as ()إهنا الثالثة والنصف. But if it is translated into
(الوقت )انتهىor ()حان وقت الرحيل, it cannot be translated back into ‘it is half past
time’, but into ‘time is up /over’ and ‘it is the time to leave’ respectively. In
this case, the translation is not acceptable.
25
Suggesting a solution to a translation problem can be based on one or more of
these criteria. On the other hand, one problem can have more than one solution, as
much as one solution can be applied to solve more than one problem.
In practice, and in the course of the forthcoming chapters, solutions are considered
alongside with problems, though they are discussed separately for the convenience of
reading and pursuit of discussion.
8. Translation as Problems and Solutions: A Practical Approach:
Although translation problems and solutions are sometimes unpredictable, and the
same problems can have different solutions in different texts and contexts to different
types of readership, they can be defined and numbered in general but clear terms. This
is confirmed by their classification in the work into grammatical, lexical, stylistic and
phonological problems, together with their solutions. Other complicated types of
problems -like pragmatic problems- are not included here because they are not well-
established yet. Therefore, they are not suitable for students at this stage in particular.
26
them up as inappropriate, and substituted them for a unified theory about the
importance, unimportance and better writing of texts (pp. 36-7).
Now it is possible to discuss in detail the major sets of translation problems pointed out
above, starting with the simplest and least difficult set of Grammatical Problems.
It remains to say that, unless referred otherwise, the examples used in this book
are of my own devising.
27
Chapter One
GRAMMATICAL PROBLEMS
Introduction:
English and Arabic belong to two different and distant language families: West Germanic, and
Semitic. Consequently, their grammars are sharply different. Several grammatical features of English
create variable problems of translation into Arabic. Experience shows that one of the primary mistakes
committed by the students of translation is their presupposition that English grammar and Arabic
grammar can translate each other in a straightforward way. To confirm that, the problems of
translating the most prominent points of English grammar into Arabic are discussed below. All the
problems are followed by one or more suggested solutions.
When these verbs are the main and only verbs in the sentence, they are translated by many
students literally into ()يكون, which is a poor translation: e.g.
Solution: 'am, is, are’ can be omitted altogether here, thus changing the English verbal sentences
into Arabic nominal ones: i.e. into a topic and a comment( )مبتدأ وخربeach. e.g.
28
Therefore, verb ‘be’ in the present simple is used here to connect as much as equate between two
words. It is exactly like saying: ‘X=Z’. Thus: ‘I’=student': ( البbb‘ ;)أنا = طShe = kind’: ( ;)هي=طيبةand
‘You=father’: ()أنت=أب. That is why it is called an ‘equative verb’.
The same applies to the translation of ‘am, is, are’ when used as auxiliary verbs to form the
present progressive tense and the present passive voice.A good number of students translate them
literally: e. g.
29
3. “They are put in the same situation”: (املوقف نفسه )هم يوضعون(موضوعون)يف
Thus, verb ‘be’ in the present simple, ‘am, is, are’ is usually dropped in Arabic, both as main as
well as auxiliary. It is mostly unacceptable and poor in Arabic grammar and word order.to translate it
into (( )يكونexception: 'Be, and it is'(()كن فيكون.
Unlike ‘am, is, are’, the past simple of ‘be’ ‘was’ and ‘were', are translated literally into ( انbb)ك
both as main as well as auxiliary verbs:
a. As main verbs: e. g.
Yet literal translation is unfavourable when these verbs are used as auxiliaries to form the past
passive voice, as illustrated in the following examples:
30
2. “I was deceived”: ((خدعت )أنا
ُ)
3. “The boys were dismissed”: (األوالد )طٌرد
Therefore, ‘was’ and ‘were’ are retained in ‘a’ and ‘b’, but dropped in ‘c’ only.
The past participle of ‘be’ (i.e. been) is wrongly ignored, or translated literally into ( ائنbb )كin
Arabic:
Solution: ‘Been’ ( )كائنis changed into the past simple (see 1&2 below) or disregarded (see3):
Thus, the dictionary meaning of ‘been’ as ( )كائنin Arabic is strictly not advisable to use.
Contrastively, the full form of verb ‘be’ (i.e. be) is always literally translated and, thus, poses no
problem: e.g.
31
1.2.Translation of Verb ‘DO’:
As a main verb, ‘do’ does not pose a grammatical problem. However, as an auxiliary, it poses
more than one problem:
Verb ‘do’ is used in English to form the negative of all verbs, except ‘be’, ‘have’ and the modal
verbs. ‘Do’ and ‘does’ are used with the present simple, whereas ‘did’ is used with the past. All these
forms are meaningless in Arabic. However, they have the function of indicating the tense of the verb
(i.e. present or past ). What is translated into Arabic is the negative particle ‘not’ ( )الonly: e. g.
The same can be said of the translation of ‘did not’. The negative word ‘not’ is usually translated
into ( )ملwith the present, and occasionally into ( )ماwith the past.
e.g.
Verb ‘do’ is used to form the questions of all English verbs except 'be’, ‘have’ and modal verbs.
At translating it into Arabic, it always implies the question particle ( )هلwhether in the present or in
the past: e.g.
32
1. “Do you sleep early?”: (تنام باكراً؟
)هل
2. “Does John play football? ”: ()هل يلعب جون كرة القدم
3. “Did Ali wait for you last night?”: ()هل انتظرك علي ليلة أمس؟
ّ
Problem 4 and solution The misunderstanding of ‘do’ as a substitute verb:
‘Do’ is used as a substitute verb replacing a whole clause to avoid repetition, especially as an
answer to a question. It is not easy for students to understand it clearly, because it can substitute for all
the verbs which require ‘do’ in the interrogative.
Solution: The general solution for this problem is to translate ‘do’ into. ( )يفعل:e. g
1. “Do you admit that? Yes, I do”: (أفعل )هل تقر بذلك؟ نعم
2. “Did she swear? Yes, she did”: ()هل أقسمت؟ نعم فعلت
3. “Do they work at night ? No, they don’t”: (ال يفعلون، )هل يعملون يف الليل؟ ال
This solution is acceptable. Not only this, it is easier and more favourable to students. Yet, the
better solution is to translate it into the main verb of the first sentence: e. g.
1. “Do you admit that? Yes, I do”: (أقر بذلك )هل تقر بذلك؟ نعم
2. “ Did she swear? Yes, she did”: (سمتْ؟ نعم أقسمت َ )هل َأْق
3. “ Do they work at night? No, they don’t”: ( يف الليل؟ ال ال يعملونb)هل يعملون
As a main verb, ‘do’ is meaningful in translation. Usually, it is translated into Arabic as ( )يفعل.
However, it can sometimes be translated into:
( يفعل، يعمل، يؤديb،ً يؤدي عمالb،))يقوم بـ(عملe.g.
33
In the following example, 'do' can be translated either as ( يعمل ، )يؤديor exceptionally as ‘write’ (
)يكتب:
Thus, at translating verb ‘do’, the students see whether it has a grammatical function (i.e. used as
an auxiliary), or is a main verb. As an auxiliary, it has no lexical meaning in Arabic, but implies the
grammatical question particle ()هل. However, as a main verb, it has a full lexical meaning.
This verb can be exceptionally used as an emphatic device. Therefore, it is translated: e.g.
The three forms of verb ‘do’ are used in the same sense and for the same function of emphasis.
Therefore, they can be translated equally into any of the following Arabic emphatic words and phrases
( ال ريب، مما ال شك فيه، ال شك، من املؤكدb، بالتأكيد،ً حقا،ًفعال،
)وما إىل ذلك
34
1 3 Translation of Verb ‘HAVE’:
Like the previous two verbs, ‘Be’ and ‘Do’, verb ‘Have’ (i.e. have, has, had ) is used both as an
auxiliary and a main verb. As an auxiliary, it is not so problematic. However, as a main verb, it can
pose a few problems to the students of translation.
Problem 1 and solution: ‘Have’ as an auxiliary:
Verb ‘have’ is used as an auxiliary to perform important grammatical functions with regard to
tenses in particular (see tenses later). In this case, it is meaningless in Arabic, and the students can
simply ignore it altogether:e.g.
1. “The workers have left early today”: (باكراً اليوم )غادر العمال
2. “Two girls had finished knitting fast”: ( )أهنت فتاتان احلبك بسرعة
3. “The patient has had the medicine”: ( )أخذ(تناول) املريض الدواء
Many students translate ‘have’ into one version only, that is: ( )ميلك, when it is the main verb of
the sentence. This is only one of its several meanings, and students are advised to be careful at
translating it.
Solution: Students should understand ‘have’ as a verb of several manings. Here they are:
1. “She has money”: ((معها نقود)هي/لديها نقود/نقود يف حوزهتا/عندها نقود/ًمتلك نقودا
(All these translations are possible, but the last version may be the most common, while the first could
be the least common).
35
6. “ She has to speak two languages”: (بلغتني)جيب عليها أن تتحدث
7. “She had a nice holiday”: ( مجيلةb)قضت عطلة
8 .“Have a good journey”: (أمتىن لك رحلة ممتعة/)استمتِ ْع برحلة مجيلة
9. “Have a bash” ()جرب(حظك/)حاول
What helps students distinguish between these meanings of ‘have’ is the consideration of the
word immediately after it (i.e. its object).Together with its object, ‘have’ makes a special combination
in Arabic(i.e.collocation). For instance, although we can say ( ً)ميلك نقودا, we cannot say ()ميلك دواء, or (
)ميلك مكاملة هاتفية, etc.
36
1. 4. Translation of MODAL AUXILIARY VERBS/MODALS:
There are ten main auxiliary verbs (or modals / modal auxiliaries) in English: ‘can, could, may,
might, will, would, shall, should, must, ought to’. They create several problems of translation for two
major reasons:
(1) They do not have one-to-one single semantic equivalent in Arabic. Moreover, there is no
grammatical class of verbs called modal auxiliaries (اعدةbb ال مسbb )أفعin Arabic. The so-called
Arabic 'defective verbs' (ناقصة )أفعالare different.
(2) They have several, complex and complicated functions in English. Here is a short list with
the main functions of each of these verbs (mostly adopted from Quirk et al (1973: 52-57):
Clearly, these verbs are complicated and multifunctional in English. Therefore, it is difficult to
give one single specific meaning for each of them. Usually, the students know them by their most
common meanings (underlined above). The following comparative discussion of the problems of
translating some of the functions of these modals into Arabic and the possible solutions to them may
be helpful to students to understand. The concentration on the grammatical differences between the
two languages would be enlightening in this connection.
37
Solution: They are translated into ( وفbb )سor ( )سـ, regardless of the possibility of the reference of the
latter to the near future, and the former to the far future(as stated in Arabic grammar books), for this is
not the frequent case in actual use of Arabic. e.g.:
Solution: They are translated into the following: (أن تطيعbb يس،جيب أن، )ميكن أنbecause ( )أنis implied in
each of these verbs. At the same time, grammatically it is obligatory in Arabic. e.g.:
1. “We can walk”: (منشي )نستطيع أن (We cannot say: (منشي نستطيع
3. “we may walk”: ()ميكننا أن منشي (not: (منشي ميكننا
4. “We must walk”: (يلزمنا أن منشي/) )جيب(علينا (not: (جيب(علينا )منشي
(the second version, ( )يلزمناexpresses necessity, which is one of the meanings of ‘must’).
The same applies to the past tenses of these verbs, ‘could’, ‘might’, and ‘must’: They are
translated into two words each: (استطاع أن، أمكن أن، )وجب (لزم) أن
Problem 3: The special use of ‘shall’:
‘Shall’ has a special use in the language of law in particular. It is not used to refer to future, but
to obligation.
38
3. “I should believe my parents”: ((َي)جيب
َّ والد )علي أن أصدق
Problem 5: The confusion of ‘must have’ and ‘should have’:
Many students understand these two constructions as having the same meaning in the past. But
they are not so; on the contrary, they are opposites.
Solution: ‘Must have’=action which took place; ‘should have’=action which did not take place. At
translating these two examples, we must distinguish between the first which implies action, and the
second which implies no action:
1. “They must have finished wok”: ()ال بد أهنم أهنوا العمل
2. “They should have finished work”: (العمل أن ينهواb)كان عليهم
(but they have not) ()لكنهم مل ينهوه
( )ال بدis used to express the doing, or the expectation and necessity of doing something in the
past; whereas (bان عليهمbb )كexpresses the wish to have something done, but for some reason, it did not
take place.
It is not possible to understand these three modals as verbs in the past. They reflect the
grammatical functions of expressing possibility, permission and/or polite request here.
Problem 7 and solution: ‘can’, ‘will’ = may:
‘Can’ usually expresses ability and means (تطيع أنbb )يسin Arabic, whereas ‘will’ is used for the
future tense to mean ( سوف/ )سـin Arabic. However, both are used here in the same meaning of ‘may’
to express possibility and/or permission (i.e.‘can’ and ‘may’). e.g.:
39
Or a polite request (i.e. ‘can’, ‘will’, ‘may’): e.g.
‘Will’ is, therefore, used in this sense only in the form of a question to express polite request. On
the other hand, ‘can, will, may’ are interchangeable with ‘could, would, might’. All have the meaning
of ‘may’ .
Modal verbs are, then, problematic. Their main problem may lie in the lack of one single,
unchanged meaning for each of them. The following notes, may help the students of translation to
distinguish the different meanings and functions of modals.
1. It should be borne in mind that none of them has one fixed meaning only. This makes us more
careful at translating them into Arabic.
2. Understanding their grammatical functions of possibility, permission, Politeness, expectancy,
ability, etc. enables us to distinguish their different meanings in Arabic.
3. The careful consideration of the difference in Arabic between the common meaning and the
unusual meaning of a modal. ‘Will’, for instance, has a common meaning of referring to the future as (
سوف/ )سـin Arabic. But it has an unusual meaning of ( باإلمكان/ )إذا أمكنto make a polite request. Just for
the sake of illustration and comparison, we may translate ‘will’ in the following example into its
common, and then unusual meaning respectively:
The comparison of the two versions shows that the second is more conceivable, as the future is
irrelevant here. The same comparison can be helpful with ‘could’, ‘would’, ‘must’, and ‘should’ in
particular.
4. When ‘will’, ‘would’, and ‘shall’ are used to refer to the future, they are not translated into verbs
in Arabic, but into the future particles ( وفbbس/)سـ. However, care should be taken that they have other
meanings such as implying a polite request/willingness (i.e. will), a possibility, permission and/or
politeness (i.e. would), or an obligation (i.e. shall, should). These meanings have their equivalents in
Arabic, as the previous discussion confirms.
40
1.5.Translation of QUESTIONS:
1.The conversion of the subject and the verb when one of the following verbs is used: ‘be’, ‘have’ and
the modal verbs(see examples below).
2. The use of the auxiliary verb ‘do’ with the rest of verbs in English (see also examples below).
Problems could arise at translating the different types of questions, because making questions is
not the same in Arabic. Both types of questions are called ‘yes-no questions’ because they are
answered by ‘yes or no’.
The students might think of translating the types of English questions into equivalent types in
Arabic. They will find this not possible and quite problematic, because simply there are no such
equivalents.
The solution for the problems of translating all types of English questions is simply by using only
one word in Arabic, that is, the question particle, ( )هلto begin all the equivalent Arabic questions: e.g.
Two more, less frequent question words can be sometimes interchangeable with ( )هل. The first
is the Arabic alphabetical letter, al-hamza ( )أ, and the second is (ّ)هال. The latter is quite rare and may
imply the meaning of request. Therefore, it is advisable to avoid using it frequently. The former,
however, is more popular than the latter, and interchanges with ( )هلperfectly as follows: ( ، أتلعب،ألعبت
أتلعب؟،)ألعبت
41
Problem ‘2’: The disappearance of ( )هلwith WH-questions:
Some questions are formed by using one of the following words: ‘what’ ( ماذا/)ما, ‘why’ (ملاذا / )َمل,
‘where’ (‘ )أينwhich’ ( )أي, ‘who’ ( )َمن, ‘whom’ ( من/ممن/)ملن, 'whose' (‘ )ملنwhen’( )مىت, ‘how’ ()كيف. All
these question words (except ‘how’) start with ‘wh’, which is why the questions stared with them are
called WH-questions.
When ‘do’ and the subject-verb conversion are used in a WH-question, they are meaningless. (
)هلis no longer used in the Arabic translation: e.g.
42
Negation in English includes words like ‘not’, ‘do not’, ‘does not’, ‘never’, ‘neither’, 'nor’ and
‘no’. The translation of these words is not always as easy as many students might think. The following
discussion illustrates this.
‘Not’ seems a simple word and has a straightforward translation as ( )الin Arabic. But it is not
always so. Other translations are given to ‘not’, but all of them are negative words, as the following
examples show:
The students are required to search for the suitable word in Arabic. It can be either ( )ال, ()لن, ()ليس
or ()ما:e.g.
‘Not’ is strong after ‘will’ and ‘shall’, and is, therefore, always translated into the strong ( )لن
only for future reference in Arabic.
Problem 2: A difference between ‘do not’ ‘does not’ and ‘ did not’:
These constructions are different in English. Therefore, some students might think that they
equally have to be translated into different forms in Arabic in terms of word-for-word translation. But
we do not have a word for each of these three particles. Two equivalent particles only are used in
Arabic, one for ‘do not’ and ‘does not’ (in the present), and another for 'did not’(in the past).
( )الis used in Arabic to make negation in the present. It is, therefore, equivalent to ‘do not’ and
‘does not’. But ( )ملis to negate something in the past. That is why it translates ‘did not’. It
43
interchanges with another negative device, ( )ماwhich is followed by the past tense in Arabic. Yet, it is
more frequent than it in use. e.g.:
1. “Many people do not play chess”: (الشطرنج ))كثري من الناس ال يلعبون (ال يلعب كثري من الناس
2. “Her sister does not eat much”:(ًال تأكل أختها كثريا/ً)أختها ال تأكل كثريا
3. “The children did not sleep early yesterday”: ()مل ينم األطفال باكراً أمس
4. “The cat did not catch the mouse”: ()مل ميسك القط بالفأر
Dictionaries give ‘never’ one meaning in Arabic, which is ( ً)أبدا. But we cannot translate it into it
only. For instance, it is not allowed to say the following versions in Arabic.
‘Never’ is a strong negative word in English, and translated into two words in Arabic, preferably
(ًأبدا... )لنor (ًأبدا...)مل. Therefore, the previous examples can be translated suitably as follows:
44
Problem 4: The confusion of ‘neither…nor’ with ‘either…or’:
Because of their lexical similarity, these two constructions might be confused. However, they are
opposite to one another: The first (وال... )لاis negative, whereas the second (أو... )إماis positive. e.g.:
1. “I like neither lying nor cheating”: ((الغش)أنا )ال أحب الكذب أو
Solution: ‘Neither nor’=( وال...)ال:
Since it is a negation, ‘neither…nor’ does not imply a choice between two things implied by
‘either…or’(أو...)إما, but a denial of two things. Thus , the previous example should be:
1. “I like neither lying nor cheating”: ((الغش)أنا )ال أحب (ال) الكذب وال
(Notice the possible addition of the second ( )الin Arabic for more emphasis). This means that there
are three ()ال, which is normal for emphatic reasons. As to ()أنا, it is left between brackets as optional,
just in case emphasis is meant to be put on it.)
Problem 5: ‘No’ as ( )الonly:
Normally, students take ‘no’ to mean ( )الonly in Arabic. But it can have other words to translate
it, all of which are negative words. We cannot say the following in
Arabic:
‘No’ needs to be conveyed into Arabic by a proper word. It cannot be always translated into ( )ال
only. Thus, the previous examples would be as follows:
45
1.7. Translation of Sentence Types: NOMINAL VS. VERBAL SENTENCES:
There are two major types of sentence, nominal and verbal. One of the main differences between
English and Arabic grammar is that English has verbal sentences only (in the sense that every
grammatical English sentence should contain a main verb), whereas Arabic has both verbal and
nominal sentences. A nominal sentence requires no verb of any kind. In general, it consists of two
nouns, the first is called 'Topic/Subject' ( إليهbاملسند/)املبتدأ, and the second is called 'Comment /Predicate'(
املسند/ )اخلرب. Although English sentences start with a noun, this noun is called 'subject' (املسند إليه/)الفاعل,
followed by the main verb ( )الفعلof the sentence and an object, or a complement (the last three
categories are called 'Predicate' (ندbb b)املس. There is no English sentence that can be described as
grammatically well-formed unless it contains a main verb (an auxiliary verb is not enough, there must
be a main/lexical verb), what is known in Arabic as 'verb', for there are no auxiliaries in its grammar.
In this sense, if English sentences were translated in the same word order, there would be no verbal
sentences in Arabic, only nominal sentences. Here is a short list with the main sentence types in
Arabic:
There are variations on (Nominal (a-d) and verbal (e-h)) sentence types: e.g.
a. 'Inna sentence (وأخواهتا )مجلة إ ّن: ( )إ ّنset of semi-verbal particles + a sentence (a particle of the
set+topic (accusative) + comment (nominative)).
b. Prepositional sentence type (اجلار واجملرور
ّ )مجلة: A prepositional phrase pertaining to an
embedded comment, followed by a belated topic.
c. Adverbial sentence type ()اجلملة الظرفية: An adverb of time/place related to an embedded
comment, followed by a belated topic.
d. Fronted comment and belated topic sentence type (اخلرب )مجلة تقدمي.
e. Passive voice sentence type (bللمجهول )مجلة املبين
f. Fronted Object+V+O sentence type ()مجلة املفعول به املقدم: An embedded verb+O+V+O
g. 'Kaana' sentence()مجلة كان وأخواهتا: ( )كانset of so-called 'defective/imperfective
verbs'+sentence (a verb of this set+topic (nominative)+comment (accusative)).
46
h. Conditional sentences (الشرطية )اجلمل: A conditional particle (e.g. إخلb،م ْن/
َ إ ْن/لوال/لو/إذا.)
+topic+V, or V+S+O/C. etc. (See Alghalayeeni (1999)).
i. Imperative sentence type ()مجلة صيغة األمر
Thus, there is a considerable difference of sentence types between the two languages. Such
difference causes some problems for students of translation:
When ‘am’, ‘is’, and ‘are’ are used as main verbs, their sentences are nominal in Arabic.
Therefore, they are deleted completely in Arabic. They have the function of the the mathematical
symbol, equals ‘=’(see specially l.1. above). By applying this to the first three examples above, the
following translations can be suggested:
Verb ‘have’ is also used as a main verb in the two forms ‘have, and ‘has’, and can be translated
into a verbal, or a nominal construction. The following retranslation of the examples 4-6 above
illustrates the point:
47
4. “She has a headache”: (صداع )عندها
5. “We have money”: (يف حوزتنا نقود/معنا نقود/)عندنا نقود
6. “You have many friends”: (كثر
ُ )عندك أصدقاء
Hence, the English verbal sentences become nominal sentences in Arabic, having a topic and a
comment instead of a subject and a verb.
Problem ‘2’: The confusion of the present with past tenses of ‘Be’ and ‘Have’:
Problem ‘2’ is caused by confusing the solution to the first problem to be applied by some
students to the translation of these two verbs in the past tense as well (i.e. translating sentences into
nominal constructions of 'topic and comment/subject and predicate' in Arabic). However, the past
tense of 'Be' and 'Have' are translated into verbal sentences(verb+subject) in Arabic, thus retaining the
past tense of verbs and sentences.
When ‘was’, ‘were’ and ‘had’ are used, they should be translated as verbs in the past, as the
following examples show:
1. “He was in the hospital last week”: (املاضي )كان يف املستشفى يف األسبوع
2. “The players were ready for the match”: ()كان الالعبون جاهزين للمباراة
3. “We had some problems there”: ()كان عندنا بعض املشاكل هناك
Clearly, the common verb in these examples is ( )كان. Therefore, it is not common here to change
the verbal structure into a nominal structure in Arabic, unless the tense of verb is ignored, which is not
advisable (see also 1.1. and 1.3. earlier for more discussion).
48
1.8. Translation of WORD ORDER:
The normal order of the words of the Arabic sentence is sometimes different from that of the
English sentence whose normal order is as follows: subject-verb-object/complement. In Arabic,
however, the normal word order is two types:
1.Nominal word order: Topic and comment/subject and predicate( وخرب )مبتدأ: Two nouns, a noun and
an adjective, or a noun and a verb when the noun is emphasised.
The English word order is usually translated literally: N-V-O/C into Arabic, regardless of its
normal word order, which is possible, but not advisable as a rule unless the noun is emphasised. In the
following examples, the word order is normal, and the English subject is not emphasised. Therefore,
translating them into English word order in Arabic is not justified:
1. “The diplomat left Damascus for London”: ()الدبلوماسي غادر دمشق إىل لندن
2. “The sky became cloudy”: (بالغيوم )السماء تلبدت
3. “The pupils enjoyed their holiday”: (bبعطلتهم/)التالميذ استمتعوا بإجازهتم
Solution: The change into normal Arabic word order:
In normal cases, the English word order is replaced by the more frequent and normal Arabic
word order of: verb–subject-object/complement. The examples can, therefore, be retranslated as
follows:
1. “The diplomat left Damascus for London”: ()غادر الدبلوماسي دمشق إىل لندن
2. “The sky was cloudy”: (بالغيوم
السماءb)تلبدت
3. “The pupils enjoyed their holiday”: (b التالميذ بعطلتهمb)استمتع
where the verb is first, followed by the subject and then the object(1), or the complement(2&3)(see
also the previous section).
There is one type of word order in Arabic which is identical with the English word order:
subject-verb-object/complement. However, in Arabic it is a nominal rather than a verbal word order,
because the subject becomes a topic and the verb functions as a comment. The problem with this
similarity is that students mostly translate English into this identical word order in Arabic, regardless
of the more normal nominal and verbal word orders discussed above. This is due to the possibility of
49
translating word for word into Arabic. In other words, this word order of a noun and a verb becomes
the rule for the students.
As a matter of fact, this identical English-Arabic word order is the exception, not the rule. It is
used when greater emphasis than usual is intended to be put on the subject. To understand this, we
may compare the part of the verse of the Holy Quran(( )اهلل يتوىف األنفسwhere the subject( )اهللis unusally
first for more emphasis, for Allah the Almighty only can take the souls, followed by the verb (( )يتوىفto
the more normal version, (األنفس ( )يتوىف اهللi.e. the verb( )يتوىفis prior to the subject ())اهلل. Understanding
the difference between the original verse and the hypothetical version makes the point clearer, I hope.
At all events, such Arabic word order is not wrong, nor meaning is affected considerably. There is a
possibility that the students may always follow the same English word order, ignoring in effect the
other types of word order available in Arabic grammar, especially the more frequent verb-subject
order. In the following examples, the first word receives special emphasis in both languages:
However, we cannot always translate in this word order in Arabic because we do not emphasise
everything in translation. On the contrary, emphasis is the exception, not the rule. Therefore, it is not
advisable to translate the following English examples with an identical Arabic word order, as follows:
50
In Arabic, there is one type of sentence where both the English and Arabic word orders meet, that
is, the 'inna' ( )إ ّنsentence. It is a sentence headed by ( )إنthat, on the one hand, retains the English
subject-verb word order, with an acceptable Arabic word order in effect. So all we do is put 'inna' at
the beginning of the English sentence, with no change of word order. Here are paired examples with
two equally acceptable versions of translation, the first of which is more emphasised than the second:
This type of sentence and word order is frequent in Arabic. However, it should not be overused at
the expense of the frequent nominal sentences and the more frequent verbal sentences. On the other
hand, ( )إنis emphatic and, hence, would rather be used with care. In any case, these three possible
types reflect the flexibility of Arabic word order, in comparison to the single, inflexible English word
order.
51
1.9.Translation of PERSONAL PRONOUNS:
To students, English personal pronouns have a straightforward translation into Arabic. This is
correct when they are translated in isolation, or translated into a topic followed by a comment in an
Arabic nominal sentence: e. g.
1. “I am tired”: (متعب
َ )أنا
2. “She is a nurse”: ()هي ممرضة
3. “They are butchers”: (جزارون )هم
However, in Arabic verbal sentences, they can be omitted, unless emphasised, because there is a
letter in the verb which replaces the reference of the pronoun.
When the sentence is verbal in Arabic, the pronoun (which is the subject) is deleted because it is
included in the verb’s reference to it as the subject of the sentence: e.g.
(It is not required to translate ‘we’ literally into ( )حننin Arabic, as the first letter ( )نin the verb ( )نتوقع
implies it)
Verbs can have a reference to all personal pronouns in Arabic as follows (in the present and in
the past):
52
Write (present) ()يكتب (Past) ()كتب
I write )أكتب(أ I wrote)(ت
ُ كتبت
ُ
We write )نكتب (ن We wrote )كتبنا(نا
تكتبين/تكتب/ You wrote)(تِ ِ
You write َ /بت
َ َكت/كتبت
كتبنت/كتبتم/ن))كتبتما/م/ما )(ت/تكتبن/تكتبون
He writes )يكتب(ي He wrote كتب
She writes )تكتب(ت She wrote )(ت
ْ ت ْ كتب
It writes )ي-يكتب(ت/تكتب It wrote )ْ(ت
ْ كتبت/كتب
They write )يكتبن(ي/يكتبون/يكتبان They wrote)ت/ن/وا/كتبت (ا/
ْ كتنْب/كتبوا/كتبا
(The same reference ( )تin (‘ )تكتبyou write’ and ‘she writes’ is usually not confusing in Arabic.
Also, the reference of the third person pronoun singular ‘he’ ( )هوis absent from ( )كتبbecause it is
understood as the implied pronoun ( )هوand as a root verb in Arabic).
I ()إنين
We ()إننا
You (إنكن/إنكم/إنكما/ِإنك/)إنك
He ()إنه
She ()إهنا
It (إهنا/)إنه
They (إهنا/إهنن/إهنم/)إهنما
53
1.10: Translation of THE PRESENT PARTICIPLE VS. THE GERUND (-ING):
Both the present participle and the gerund have the same grammatical form in English: ‘verb+-
ing', but the first is a verb, whereas the second is a noun. All English main verbs accept the ‘-ing’
ending to be changed into nouns (i.e. gerunds).
It is problematic for the students to translate the present participle and the gerund into Arabic for
they find it difficult to distinguish between them in English. Once they overcome this difficulty, they
can translate them properly into Arabic. The best way to make such a distinction is to substitute them
for a noun of any kind. If the sentence is well-formed grammatically as well as semantically, the ‘-ing’
form is a gerund; if not, it is a present participle.
While the first translation is correct both in grammar and meaning, the second is not acceptable
either grammatically or semantically, and resembles two separate, incomplete expressions: ( األكل
ومbوال اليbرب طb )والشand ()دةbده مغص (يف املعbار عنbص. However, the use of the equivalent present participle in
Arabic is possible, yet a little awkward and, hence, the least acceptable:
1. “Eating and drinking all day, he had a stomachache”:()املعدة مغص (يف صار عنده، آكالً وشارباً طوال اليوم
Another better solution is the translation of the present participle into a prepositional phrase (i.e.
a preposition and a noun) (جار وجمرور
ّ ) with the proper personal pronoun reference:
2. “Eating and drinking all day, he had a stomachache”:(مغص (يف دهbbار عنbb ص،ومbbوال اليbbربه طb وشbثرة)أكلهbbمن (ك
)املعدة.
(The prepositional phrase is ()من+((ثرةb)ك )أكلهand the personal pronoun reference is the letter ( )هـin (
وشربهb )أكلهwhich refers to ‘he’):
54
2. “Eating and drinking all day, he had a stomachache”:(مغص صار عنده، )بسبب األكل والشرب طوال اليوم.
(The first word, 'because' is the prepositional phrase which is added at the beginning to fill in a gap to
solve the grammatical problem here).
We may also try to change the present participle and the gerund into verbs in Arabic as follows:
2.“Swimming in cold water in winter is risky”: (باملخاطر السباحة يف املاء البارد يف الشتاء حمفوفة/
أن تسبح باملاء البارد...)
The translation of the gerund into a noun is perhaps the best version in Arabic.
3. “Swimming in cold water in winter, he got cold”: (بالزكام أصيب،)مبا أنه سبح يف املاء البارد يف الشتاء.
Without using a prepositional phrase like (أنه ()مباsince/as, etc.), it is not possible to translate the
present participle into a verb only in Arabic.
The third form of the verb in English is the past participle. It has different uses in English and,
therefore, has different translations into Arabic.
55
Usually the past participle is taken in Arabic to mean ( املفعول )اسمonly, as follows: ‘love’ ( )حيب,
‘loved’ ()أحب, ‘loved’()حمبوب:
1. “She is a loved lady”: ( حمبوبةb)سيدة )هي(إهنا
2. “The lady is loved”: ( )السيدة حمبوبة
But this is only one meaning of the pp. Other meanings are assigned to it.
The past participle is translated into a verb in the past tense in Arabic in two cases:
a. When used in the present and past perfect tenses (see also ‘Tenses’ later): e.g.
1. “The guests have left “(present perfect)”: (قليل غادر الضيوف منذ/)قد غادر الضيوف
(The particle, (')قدqad' of the first is used in Arabic to express an action that has just taken place. The
same applies to(قليل ' )منذa short time ago', which is added in Arabic to distinguish the present perfect
tense from the past perfect in particular).
2. “The child had disappeared “(past perfect)”: (فرتة اختفى الطفل منذ/)لقد اختفى الطفل
(The particle, (' )لقدlaqad' of the first version is usually used in Arabic grammar to indicate an action
that took place some time ago in the past. As to (رتةbbف ' )منذsome/ a long time ago', it is added to the
second version to imply in a way the past perfect). Having said that, the rule for 'qad' and 'laqad' has
several exceptions in Arabic.
b. When used in the passive voice in the past (see 3.8. below on passive and active): e.g.
Some verbs do not have independent adjective forms. Therefore, the past participle is used
instead: e.g.
1. “The police arrested the accused person”: ((الشخص) املتهم )اعتقلت الشرطة
56
2. “I was very pleased”: (ًمسروراً جدا )كنت
3. “That is the wanted man”: ()ذاك هو الرجل املطلوب
4. “Let us save the injured(people)”: ()نساعد (األشخاص) املصابني(اجلرحى
ْ )دعونا
All the adjectives here have the form of ( ولbbاملفع )اسمin Arabic. This is identical with the more
usual and general version of the translation of the English past participle in Arabic, referred to in
“problem 1” above (see also the next subsection).
1.12.Translation of ADJECTIVES:
Adjectives in English have quite variable forms. Some of them are interchangeable with nouns.
Above all, they are ordered in the sentence in a way different from Arabic.
57
It is a general, well-known rule in English that the adjective occurs before the noun, whereas in
Arabic it comes after the noun.
A number of adjectives can follow one another in a certain order in English. When translated into
Arabic, usually the same order is reserved. However, translating them in the back order is also
feasible.
Successive adjectives in English can be translated either from left to right, or from right to left in
Arabic: e. g.
1 .“The English weather may be cloudy, rainy and sunny at the same time”:
()قد يكون الطقس اإلجنليزي غائِماً وماطراً ومشمساً (مشمسا وماطراً وغائماً) يف الوقت نفسه
2. “He read a big, popular, useful book”:()ًشعبياً كبرياً)قرأ كتاباً كبرياًشعبياً مفيداً (مفيدا
3. “Throw that small, round ball”:())ارم تلك الكرة الصغرية املدورة(املدورة الصغرية
1 2 3
1."The United Nations Educational, Scientific and Cultural Organization (UNESCO)".
( اليونسكو: والثقافة والعلوم )منظمة األمم املتحدة للرتبية
3 2 1
58
At using a number of English adjectives consecutively, a comma is used to separate them from
one another, with ‘and’ being used only before the last one. Many students and translators do the same
in Arabic. But the sequence in Arabic is different, and we have to abide by it.
When ‘and’ is used before the last adjective in English, it is repeated before every adjective in
Arabic: e. g.
1.“The two ministers discussed the political, social and economic matters”:
()ناقش الوزيران القضايا السياسية واالجتماعية واالقتصادية
2. “Her dress is blue, soft, comfortable and cheap”: (ورخيص )ثوهبا أزرق وناعم ومريح
But when ‘and’ is not used in English, it may either be dropped, or retained in Arabic, as follows:
e. g.
1.“Lucy is an innocent, good, kind girl”: (ولطيفة لوسي فتاة بريئة وطيبة/)لوسي فتاة بريئة طيبة لطيفة
2.“Mohammad prefers simple, homely, tasty food”:
()(واملألوف واللذيذ/b الطعام البسيط املألوف اللذيذb)يفضل حممد
Adjectives can be used as collective nouns in English when preceded by ‘the’ and not followed
by nouns: e g.
Some students may confuse such a special use of adjectives as singular nouns or adjectives in
Arabic.
Solution: ‘The+adjective’ → plural noun in Arabic:
Adjectives used as collective nouns are translated into plural nouns in Arabic, not into adjectives
or singular nouns: e. g.
1.“The rich should help the poor = rich people should help poor people”:
()جيب على األغنياء أن يساعدوا الفقراء
(We cannot translate ‘the rich’ into ( )الغينor ‘the poor’ into ())الفقري
59
2. “The elderly are wiser than the young’=the elderly people are wiser than the young people”:( املسنون
)أعقل من الشباب.
“People' is included both in ‘the elderly’ and ()املسنون.
3. “The handicapped can do many things ‘=’the handicapped people can do many things”: ( تطيعbb يس
)املعاقون أن يفعلوا أشياء كثرية
‘The handicapped’ cannot be translated into ((اقbb b معbecause the noun singular in English is ‘a
handicap’.
In English, there are over fourteen tenses, the most common of which are twelve: Simple tenses,
perfect tenses, progressive tenses, and perfect progressive tenses in the present (4), in the past (4),
and in the future(4). Most of them have no precise equivalents in Arabic which has only two tenses,
the present ( )املضارعand the past (( )املاضيthe imperative is not form, not a tense). This causes a few
problems to the students of translation, for some English tenses are difficult and can be confused
60
when rendered into Arabic. The following discussion gives an account of some of these problems,
and suggests possible solutions to them in regard to the main tenses in particular. The discussion is
based on comparing the major differences between English and Arabic grammars in this respect, and
the semantic implications of that, making it easier for the students to translate by understanding the
techniques of both languages here.
These two tenses have no one-to-one equivalents in Arabic. This causes a problem to students
who try hard to convey the exact time of action implied in these two tenses. Some translators suggest
( )قدfor the present perfect and ( )لقدfor the past perfect, to precede the verb in the past(see also 1.11.
above). This is a likely solution, but there are exceptions for this rule, for either particle can be used
with any kind of verb in the near or far past.(Examples can be traced in the Holy Quran). Other
words like (قبل قليل/ )للتوfor 'qad', and () )قبل مدة (من الزمنfor 'laqad' have been suggested to indicate
these two tenses. However, this can be an optional solution.
Thus, the present and the past perfect tenses are both treated as past simple, and translated into
the past tense in Arabic, with or without ( )قدor ()لقد.
Problem 2: The present and the past progressives:
These two tenses also have no equivalents in Arabic. Therefore, students could find them
problematic in translation when they insist on literal transmission.
Simply, the present progressive (am/is/are+ing) is translated into the present tense in Arabic.
The only way to indicate the time of this tense in it is to use a word like ‘now’ ( )اآلنin English: e. g.
61
2. “The wind is blowing now”: (اآلن )هتب الريح
3. “Joseph is writing an essay these days”: ()يكتب جوزيف مقالة هذه األيام
1. “The pilgrims are leaving for Makkah Al-Mukarramah”:(املكرمة )احلجاج مغادرون إىل مكة
2. “We are listening to you”: ()حنن(إننا)مصغون إليك
“We cannot say ( )هو(إنه)ميتbecause it means he is no longer alive, whereas the first version means
he is still breathing, and may become healthy and well again.
There is one common feature among all these examples, that is, the disregard of ‘verb be’.
The past progressive (was/were+ing) is translated into ( )كانand the present simple of the verb
in Arabic: e.g.
Here verb ‘be’ is translated into ( )كانin Arabic. It is always translated like this when it occurs in the
past simple in English.
These two English tenses are quite complex for students to understand and, therefore, to
translate into Arabic, for they have no equivalent in Arabic grammar. Thus, students try in vain to
62
find identical versions for them. By insisting on translating them literally, they produce broken, poor
translations: e.g.
Like the past progressive, the present perfect progressive (has/have+been+ing and the past
perfect progressive (had+been+ing)are translated into ( )كانand the present tense in Arabic, as
follows:
1. “The soldiers have been fighting all day”: (اليوم كان اجلنود يقاتلون طوال
2. “The tailor had been sewing all night”: ()كان اخلياط خييط طوال الليل
The future tense in the past is problematic and discussed in the next point (see conditional
sentences)
This tense is less problematic than the future past to students. Yet, translating it literally, students
commit a mistake when they come to the main verb (the verb with the -ing): e.g.
63
Solution: The future progressive: ()يكون+present participle (الفاعل )اسمpresent only:
Two choices are available for the translation of this tense: Either into verb ‘Be” in the present +
the present participle of the main verb; or simply into present. Both are preceded by the future
particle (سوف/سـ, as illustrated by the following three examples:
It is not easy for students to translate the reference of the future perfect. Usually, they resort to
literal translation, which might lead to slightly awkward Arabic: e.g.
Solution: The future perfect: ()قد+past/ (انتهى )قدfollowed by the prepositional phrase:
()من+ a noun: e. g.
Obviously, these translations seem unusual, even awkward. Yet, they reflect the awkward,complex
tense of the original.
English Arabic
1. present simple
2.Present progresssive present ()مضارع
64
3. past simple
4. present perfect past ()ماض
5. past perfect
6. past progressive
7. present perfect prog. were+present (مضارع+)كان
8. past perfect progressive
There are three types of conditional sentences in English, but only two in Arabic. The main
problem here is the translation of the future past ‘would have’ into Arabic. Students might try to
match the reference of the English future past: e. g.
1.“If you finish work early, I will visit you”: (أزورك)إذا تنهي العمل باكراً فسوف
2.“If you finished work early, I would visit you”: ( فسوف زرتك،ً)إذا أهنيت العمل باكرا
3.“If you had finished early, I would have visited you”:
( فسوف كنت زرتك، ً)إذا أهنيت العمل باكرا
The three translations are unacceptable in Arabic grammar for ()إذا.cannot be followed by the
present(1), and ( )سوفdoes not precede the past(2,3).
65
1 .The real/possible future present (Arabic sequence: if+past/will+present): e.g.
1.“If you finish work early, I will visit you”: ( فسوف أزورك، ً)إذا أهنيت العمل باكرا
‘If’ ( )إذاin Arabic is usually followed by the past whether the reference is to the past or to the
future. However, ‘if’ as ( )لوcan be followed by the present:
2.“If you finish work early, I will visit you”: (أزورك فسوف، ً)لو تنهي العمل باكرا
The grammatical classes (or categories) of words in English are: nouns, verbs, adjectives,
adverbs, prepositions, articles and connectors (or conjunctions). When a noun is translated into a
verb, an adjective into a noun, an adverb into an adjective, etc., the word class is changed. This
creates one or two problems for the students.
Usually English adjectives are translated into equivalent adjectives in Arabic. The problem for
the students is the application of this as a fixed rule to the translation of all adjectives in both
languages. But the case is not always so.
66
1. “The presidential palace”: (الرئاسة قصر/ )القصر الرئاسي
2. “ The United Nations Educational, Scientific and Cultural Organization
(UNESCO)”: () والعلوم والثقافة(اليونسكوbاملتحدة للرتبية األممbمنظمة
(This example does not have another translation into adjectives ).
3. “Political, administrative and economical affairs”:
(شؤون السياسة واإلدارة واالقتصاد/)الشؤون السياسية واإلدارية واالقتصادية
Problem 2: Nouns as adjectives:
Nouns can be used as adjectives in English. They might cause a problem to students.
The choice is between translating some English nouns into nouns or adjectives in
Arabic: e.g.
It is clear from these examples that most of the phrases have more than one version of translation
each, some of which are identical with English, some are not in this regard. More interesting is the
translation of ‘Quranic verses’ into both (آيات من القرآن الكرمي/)آيات قرآنية، (i.e.‘noun+adjective’, and
‘prepositional phrase’), but ‘Quranic Chapters’ cannot accept but one version that has become a
collocation in Arabic nowadays, namely, (( )سور من القرآن الكرميChapters from the Holy Quran).
Usually we do not come across (قرآنية )سورat least in formal writings and discourses .
67
Problem 3. Nouns as verbs:
English nouns are usually translated into nouns, or at times into adjectives in Arabic. However,
a noun can be translated into a verb too.
The majority of English nouns are translated into nouns or adjectives. Yet, some of them would
accept translations into verbs in Arabic: e.g.
Generally speaking, main verbs in English are usually translated into verbs in Arabic. But some
can be changed into nouns.
Moreover, some verbs may have two versions in Arabic: verbs and nouns: e. g.
Usually, the first versions of these pairs are natural and recurrent, whereas the second versions
-especially '2' and '5'- are artificial, poor and awkward. Therefore, the students are not advised to use
them, despite their possible use in Arabic grammar.
68
1.16. Translation of ARTICLES:
It is obvious that the use of ‘the’ is usually brought to a minimum in English. Moreover, in
general and abstract words, for instance, ‘the’ is implied, not mentioned, but in Arabic it is
mentioned. On the other hand, in the genitive case ( ‘ )اإلضافةthe’ is mentioned before each of the two
nouns in English, whereas in Arabic it is used only before the second noun.
69
1. “Man is a speaking animal” (general): (ناطق)اإلنسان حيوان
2. “Philosophy is my favourite subject”(abstract): ()الفلسفة ماديت املفضلة
3. “Keep medicine out of children’s reach”(abstract): ()أبعد الدواء عن متناول األطفال
(Notice also the general noun “children”, which is not preceded by an article in English,
yet ( )الـis used in Arabic).
4. “Scientists work day and night’ (general): (هنار
)يعمل العلماء ليل
5. “Prayer is an obligation”(abstract): ()الصالة فريضة
6. “Man-made shoes are of a high quality”(general): ()األحذية املصنوعة يدوياً ذات جودة عالية
7. “Ladies like good manners”(general;abstract): ()حتب السيدات السلوك احلسن
8. “Translators may commit mistakes (general): ()قد يرتكب املرتمجون أخطاء
9. “Is translation easy or difficult ?”(abstract): ( أم صعبة؟b)هل الرتمجة سهلة
10. “Domestic animals are useful and harmless”(general): ()احليوانات األليفة مفيدة وغري ضارة
In fact, there are examples where the definite article is not used in either language: e.g.
The definite article is used twice in the English ‘of-genitive’, but only once in the Arabic
translation for the genitive replaces the second definite article : e. g.
1. “The Organization of the United Nations”: ( األمم املتحدةb)منظمة
2. “The singing of the birds”: (الطيور )غناء
3. “The man of the match”: (أفضل العب يف املباراة/)جنم املباراة
70
3. “It is a story of black magic”: (شعوذة )إهنا قصة
Like the definite article, the definite genitive functions as a specifier for something or somebody
in particular, whereas the indefinite genitive is similar to the indefinite article, specifying nothing or
nobody in particular. This applies to both languages. Therefore, either use of the genitive in English
is preferably reproduced in Arabic for reasons of specification or non-specification, which may
sometimes make a considerable difference of meaning.
Thus, it is not advisable to undermine such a translation problem of definte and indefinite
articles. Indeed, sometimes it is too crucial to meaning to drop the definite article or to keep it, as
illustrated in the following two versions of the notorious Security Counil's Resolution, 242, after the
Zionist Israeli war against the neighbouring Arab Countries in June, 1967:
A. (The English version): "Withdrawal (of Israeli forces) from Arab Occupied Territories."
B. (The French version): "Withdrawal (of Israeli forces) from the Arab Occupied Territories."
A long dispute has been going on between the Arabs and the Zionists about the two versions, as
the first(without 'the') is adopted by the Israelis for it is interpreted as 'withdrwal from some Arab
occupied territories', whereas the second version(with 'the') is adopted by the Arabs as it means
'withdrawal from all Arab occupied territories'. The difference is obviously big between 'some' and
'all'.
1.17. Translation of CONJUNCTIONS: SENTENCE CONNECTORS
Conjunctions (or Sentence Connectors) are the words or the phrases used to connect sentences
together. They usually occur at the beginning of sentences, with possible occasional variations of
position in the middle, or at the end of them.
It is hard to imagine a text of two or more sentences without some conjunctions used to connect
its parts (i.e. sentences) with one another. Here is an example.
Here we have independent statements rather than a united text, for sentence connectors which
bring about this unity are left out. Consequently, translating them into Arabic as such will have an
equally disintegrated text, as follows:
( رمبا تكون أقدم. تعد العربية إحدى اللغات القدمية.تعترب اللغة اإلجنليزية نسبياً لغة حديثة العهد
مزيد من األدلة مطلوب للتحقق من ذلك.)لغة على وجه األرض
We feel that something is missing in between the sentences. Therefore, comprehension of the
text as one whole unit is obstructed. By contrast, the provision of proper sentence connectors makes
the text one organic unit that can be easily comprehended. (Sentence connectors are underlined):
71
“English is relatively a modern language. On the other hand, Arabic is an
ancient language. Not only this, perhaps it is the oldest language on earth.
However, more evidence is required to confirm that”.
The connectors, ‘on the other hand’, ‘not only this’ and ‘however’, are inserted in between sentences
to compose a unified text. The same can be said about the Arabic translation:
(فحسب ليس هذا.ً تعترب العربية لغة قدمية جدا، من ناحية أخرى. تعترب اإلجنليزية نسبياً لغة حديثة العهد،
على أية حال هناك حاجة إىل مزيد من األدلة للتحقق من ذلك.)رمبا هي أقدم لغة على وجه األرض.
The connectors: على أية حال، ليس هذا فحسب، ) )من ناحية أخرىare employed to unite these sentences into
one comprehensible text.
‘and, also, or, furthermore, in addition, besides, beside that, alternatively, likewise, similarly, in the
same way, for instance, for, that is, I mean, etc.’
72
-Beside that -ذلك باإلضافة إىل
-Alternatively
-باإلضافة إىل ذلك/إىل جانب ذلك
-Likewise -بدل ذلك/بدالً(عوضاً) عن ذلك
-Similarly/in a similar way, -وباملثل
These conjunctions are used to add more information and details by way of addition (using:
‘and, also, besides, beside that, moreover, further, furthermore, in addition’); alternation (using: ‘or,
alternatively, instead, rather’); exemplification (by means of: ‘for example, for instance, a case in
point, to give(cite) an example, etc.’); explanation (using: ‘that is, I mean, namely, viz. etc.’), or
resemblance (using: ‘likewise, similarly, in a similar way, in the same way, by the same token, etc.’).
“But, however, yet, though, although, nevertheless, nonetheless, despite that, in spite of, instead,
rather, on the one hand … on the other, on the other hand, on the contrary, in fact, actually, well, as a
matter of fact, in any case, anyhow, at any rate, after all, above all, it is true that, etc.”:
73
-On the other hand )من ناحية (من جهة) أخرى-
-On the contrary
)على العكس(من ذلك-
-In fact, actually, well, as a matter of يف واقع/ًحسنا/يف الواقع/يف احلقيقة-
fact, the fact of the matter
-In any case, anyhow, at any rate حقيقة األمر/األمر
مهما يكن من أمر/على أية حال-
-After all, above all
-It is true that قبل هذا وذاك/قبل كل شيء-
... صحيح أن-
These conjunctions give the meaning of contrast to what has been said before. Six of them
demand special attendance to: ‘in fact, as a matter of fact, the fact of the matter, actually, well, it
is true’ Their equivalents in Arabic can be misleading, for they are used positively in informal
Arabic. However, formally (يف احلقيقة)يف/رbbع؛ حقيقة األمbb يف الواق/رbb )واقع األمand (حيح أنbb )صare used in a
contrastive sense; whereas (ً )حسناcan be used in both senses, the positive and the negative.
1. Reason: (for this reason, because of this, on account of this, for, because, as, as to, as for, for
this purpose, with this in mind, it follows, on this basis, therefore).(ًاءbb بن،ذاbbبب هbb بس،ببbbهلذا الس
ذاbb ينتج عن ه،بانbbذا باحلسbbذاً هbb آخ،رضbb هلذا الغ، أما فيما خيص،بة لـbbبالنس/ أما عن، ألن،)بب (مبا أنbb بس، ألن،ذاbbعلى ه
لذلك/لذا/ هلذا، على هذا األساس،).
2. Result: (as a result, in consequence, consequently, in this regard, in this respect, thus, hence,
so, etc.).( ذاb لb،)ذاbوهك/ذاb هلذا(ل،)ًذا(إذاb هك،ددbذا الصb يف ه،ددbذا الصb يف ه،ايلb وبالتb، بالنتيجة،)لذلك/وكنتيجة (هلذا
)(هلذا
74
3. Condition: (in that (this) case, in such an event, that being so, under the circumstances, under
other circumstances, etc.)( يف ظل،ذلكbb مبا أن األمر ك،)ةbb ذه احلالbb رف(هbb ذا الظbb يف مثل ه،ةbb ذه)احلالbb ك(هbb يف تل
) يف ظروف أخرى(خمتلفة،الظروف الراهنة
1. Sequence (e.g. first, secondly, next, then, after that, etc.).(مَث (بعد من،)ايلbbك(التbb بعد ذل،ًاb ثاني،ًأوال
بعد ذلكb،)بعدئذ/)ذلك
2. Simultaneity (e.g. at the same time, in the meantime).( يف/كbذل اءbاء(أثنbbذه األثنb يف ه،هbوقت نفسbbيف ال
) )غضون ذلك
1. Synonymous translations for the same English connector are usually interchangeable. That is,
‘however’, for instance, can be translated into one of the following: ( على أية، بيد أن، إال إن،لكن
ّ ،لكن
ْ
75
غري أن،رb مهما يكن من أم،) حال. The same applies to ‘though/although’ which would have the following
translations, each of which is perfectly valid: ( برغم؛ إخل، على الرغم من، مع أن،برغم أن.).
2. Some Arabic connectors are sometimes misunderstood, or used in the wrong sense like()أما
and ( )و.The latter is normally used for addition to mean ‘and’, whereas the former means ‘but’ and is
used for contrast. Sometimes these contrastive meanings are confused, as " "أماcould be used for
addition, ‘and’, for contrast. Consider these examples:
In the second example, ‘ ’أماshould be replaced by ‘ ’وfor the relationship here is of addition, not
contrast. It has to be corrected, then, as follows:(هبا bتمتعbb ذلك أسbb وأنا ك،باحةbb اس بالسbb تمتع كثري من النbb )يس.
Moreover, both connectors can be used together in Arabic only: “Many people enjoy swimming, but
I don’t”( وأما أنا فال،)يستمتع كثري من الناس بالسباحة
3. Some connectors are added necessarily or not in Arabic to achieve better cohesion among
sentences, especially when a clearcut connector is not used. They can be described as initiating
particles (استئناف/)أدوات استهالل. Here are some of them:
(و فإ ّن؛ هذا، إ ّن، حيث أن، إذ،لقد،فـ؛ فقد...). e.g.
1. “Dear Sister,
76
( رمضان20 فقد تلقيت رسالتك املؤرخة يف... الغالية/أخيت العزيزة...)
( )فقدis added as an initiator, may be unnecessarily, just as a stylistic formula marking the start of a
letter.
3. “Watching T.V. programs is merely a waste of time. Many of these programs aim at entertaining
T.V. watchers, sometimes cheaply. Some T.V. channels try to improve on the quality of their
programs":
بشكل رخيص، إذ يهدف الكثري من هذه الربامج إىل تسلية املشاهدين.(إن مشاهدة بعض برامج التلفاز جمرد مضيعة للوقت
) براجمهاb هذا وحتاول بعض القنوات التلفازية حتسني نوعية.ًأحيانا
Here, the three connectors, ()إن, ()إذand(ذا وbbه...) are used necessarily in Arabic to achieve
cohesion, as the absence of connectors in English might lead to ambiguity and unclearness of
cohesion.
In sum, sentence connectors are useful conjunctions, used to achieve the best possible degree of
cohesion among sentences and paragraphs in both languages, English and Arabic, putting together an
organic, comprehended text. Failing to use them properly in translation into Arabic would result in
misunderstanding the original meaning properly. Therefore, translators and students of translation are
required to take care of them as accurately as possible.
77
CONCLUSIONS:
The grammatical problems of English-Arabic translation are numerous. They arise from
differences between the two languages in grammatical aspects like tenses, word order, questions,
negation, personal pronouns, adjectives, classes of words (verbs, nouns, adjectives, etc.) articles,
sentence connectors, etc.
The account of grammatical problems given in this chapter is not final. Other problems like the
translation of adverbs and prepositions are not included. Prepositions are partly discussed in chapter
two (see the translation of collocations) whereas adverbs are included in the examples used
throughout this book. Further, there are three grammatical forms in Arabic which can be used to
translate English adverbs, except adverbs of time, place and frequency:
78
English adverbs of time, place and frequency have their equivalents in Arabic: e.g.
“When, while, before, after, etc.”: (إخل ، بعد، قبل،يف حني/، بينما،عندما.)
“Here, there, over, under , etc.”: ( إخل، حتت، فوق، هناك،هنا.)
“Always, usually, often, sometimes, occasionally, etc.”:
( إخل،ً عرضيا،ً نادرا،ً أحيانا،ً غالبا، عادة،ًدائما.)
Another minor grammatical problem is the translation of direct and indirect objects. There is no
problem when the direct object is first, followed by the indirect object :e. g.
(1) (2)
1.”He gave a present to his daughter”: ( البنتهb)أعطى هدية
(1) (2)
2. “He bought a car to his daughter”: (سيارة البنته )اشرتى
However, the problem arises when the indirect object precedes the direct object:
(2) (1)
1. “ He gave his daughter a present”: (ابنته هدية )أعطى
(2) (1)
2. “He bought his daughter a car”: (سيارة )اشرتى ابنته
Although the first is not problematic, as ( )أعطىtakes two objects in Arabic as well, the second
can cause confusion to some students, for ( )اشرتىtakes only one object in Arabic. Therefore, it would
be misunderstood as:
“He bought his daughter!” (ابنته )! اشرتىand nobody can buy or sell his daughter!
Solution:
The indirect object in English should be translated with its deleted preposition into Arabic as
follows: ( سيارةb)اشرتى البنته.
79
Thus, confusion is disposed of, and the Arabic version is made grammatical, as ( )اشرتىdoes
not accept two objects.
All grammatical problems of translation discussed earlier in this chapter are followed by their
possible solutions, so that the process of translation can proceed fluently and properly, and the search
for meaning may, therefore, continue in the right direction, giving way for the far more important
and difficult lexical problems of translation to be discussed in detail, located and, then, solved. Hence
Chapter Two: Lexical Problems.
EXERCISES:
2. Translate the following statements into verbal structures ( )فعل وفاعلin Arabic:
1. Everybody is required to do his/her job well.
2. Won’t you tell me the whole truth?
3. I don’t understand what you mean.
4. Writing his homeworks properly, he passed the exam easily.
5. Get well soon.
3. Translate each of these statements into Arabic: First into nominal structures; second,
into verbal structures:
80
1. How old are you, boy?
2. Ahmad may be bed-ridden
3. Here is my home address
4. Be careful with your superiors!
5. He wants to confess something
4. Translate the following sentences into Arabic with emphasis on the doer of action:
5. Change the word class of the underlined words in the Arabic translations of the
following (e.g. an adjective into a noun; a noun into a verb; a verb into a noun, etc.):
1. Distinguished students have been honored at the end of this academic year.
2. The innocent man was beaten to death.
3. Our new house will be furnished soon, God willing.
4. Nobody is allowed in after 12 O’clock when the lecture starts.
5. The patient will be rewarded whereas the impatient will be punished in the Hereafter.
81
2. All children’s stories have happy endings.
3. The woman who forced the girl to get married early was her step mother.
4. Really good books are available in bookshops, but quite expensive.
5. Many T.V. channels are useless and frustrating, neither more nor less.
9. Translate the following sentences into verses from the Holy Quran:
10. Provide the missing connectors at the beginning of sentences in the following
passage, and then translate it into Arabic:
“Makkah Al-Mukarramah is a holy city for Muslims all over the world. ……….. non-Muslims
are not allowed to enter it. ………. Ka'ba, the Venerable House of Allah, is the center of earth.
………., it is the direction of prayer for Muslims anywhere in the world. ………., it is the House
that gathers all Muslims together at least five times a day toward the same direction.”
Chapter Two
LEXICAL PROBLEMS
Introduction:
The greater number of translation problems for the students are lexical problems. Words
are usually given the first importance in translation to the point of overexaggeration.
Moreover, most of the students’ mistakes are their superficial, word-for-word translations of
the SL texts, and ignorance of Arabic equivalence. More seriously, they understand
translation as the translation of individual words only, which is very much to the contrast of
reality in translation practice.
82
The central lexical problem for the students of translation is their direct, literal
translation of almost all words. They dedicate themselves to it wholeheartedly and in an
unusual way in all texts and contexts, in regard to all words, phrases and expressions.
Although any language is words in isolation, it cannot be understood as such. Words are
used together in special combinations, texts and contexts. Furthermore, there are: (1)
grammatical words which have no meaning, but used for a specific grammatical function
(such as the use of verb ‘do’ to make questions and negation in English, ‘have’ to form the
present perfect tense, etc. ); and (2) lexical words which have meanings and make up
language.
The relation between language and words is exactly like the relation between the human
body and its constituent parts. The body exists and works perfectly only when body parts
exist and work perfectly together. Likewise, the parts do not, and cannot work in isolation.
Each part works in relation to, and in connection with other parts.
Yet, the interconnection among words does not always result in a new combination and
a different, indirect meaning of them. In fact, words can keep their direct literal meanings,
even when they occur with one another. This means that direct literal translation is
sometimes possible and acceptable.
A common mistake is committed by the students when they take literal translation to be
applicable to everything in language.
The comparison between the following three groups of examples illustrates the point
here:
Group A:
Group B:
83
3. “A can of worms”: ()عويصةحفنة مشاكل(مشكلة/ ديدانb)علبة
4. “Fabrication”: (تلفيق/)حبك
5. “Ugly person”: () بشع(التصرفbشخص/))شخص قبيح (املنظر
Group C:
By comparing these three groups with one another, we notice that in ‘A’ a direct
translation is quite feasible, in ‘C’ literal translation is not possible by any means. The
following literal translation of the five examples of ‘C’ into Arabic confirms the point:
All these literal, word-for-word translations are strange and not understandable.
Moreover ‘3’ and ‘5’ are funny. More seriously, ‘5’ can be described as a dangerous
translation because it is insulting and could put an end to a translator’s career. Such
translations are, therefore, unacceptable.
As regards group ‘B’,both literal and non-literal translations are possible, but not at the
same time. That is, the types of text and context are essential to decide which translation to
choose. For instance, in a sentence describing a day in winter, ‘rainy day’ has one translation
only :e.g.
84
Only ’ماطر ‘يومis applicable here, whereas ‘ ’يوم أسودis not. On the other hand, only ‘ ودbوم أسb’ي
is acceptable in the translation of the English proverb:
“Save for a rainy day”: (للشدة وفِّر/)خبئ قرشك األبيض ليومك األسود
Hence, the text and/or the context can be helpful in deciding whether a literal translation
is feasible or not, and the possibility or not of the grouping of certain words together. That is,
we cannot describe ‘ ’أمرas ‘ ( ’طويلlong), or ‘( ’قصريshort). Therefore, we conclude that such a
translation is wrong, and we have to look for the right one (i.e. شاقة )مهمة.
The same argument applies to ‘ مسني ‘ راتبas a literal translation of ‘fat salary’. Only a
person or an animal can be described as ‘fat’( )مسنيin Arabic, but not a thing or an inanimate
word like ‘salary’ ()راتب. However, we can say .(زbٍ جم/متخم/)راتب ضخم
Likewise, can anyone ‘bite the dust’ in the same way he bites a sandwich, an apple, or a
hand? Certainly not. Therefore ()يعض الرتابis nonesense, whereas ( يلقى حتفه/ًيُردى قتيال/ً)خير صريعا
is quite expressive. (See the translation of collocations later)
The discussion of these three groups of examples shows that literal translation is
possible in a few cases, whereas in many other cases it is not. This means that literal
translation is sometimes possible and applicable, sometimes not, which is still debatable,
anyway.
The problem for students is that they think that everything in language can be translated
literally. This is very serious indeed, because it results in many silly mistakes committed by
them.
The solution to this problem is, first and foremost, the warning of the students strongly
and permanently against the literal translation of everything, by means of:
85
4. Concentrating for some time on fixed, special expressions in English such as proverbs,
idioms, phrasal verbs and many collocations, which count in tens of thousands, and resist
literal translation.
Word-for-word translation is to translate each word in an English sentence into its common
equivalent in Arabic in the same word order. (See also Introd.) e.g.
Here, each word in English is translated into its Arabic meaning literally and in the same
order, as illustrated by the use of numbers.
Although word-for-word translation and literal translation are the same in these and
other similar examples, they are not so in many others. Consider the following comparative
examples where the first Arabic translation is literal, but the second is word-for-word
translation:
Obviously, the second version of '2' is unacceptable in Arabic grammar. Beside that, (
ونbb )تكis not needed. However, the second versions of translation of the rest of the examples
86
are poor translations. That is, ( ًاb b مريض قطbb b )هو سmight be misunderstood at least by some
students to mean that perhaps he is now bed-ridden because of his illness,, which is not
necessarily so. In addition, the use of ( )هوis not required. The use of 'fell' before 'ill' is simply
due to a language fact that English has no verb for illness like the Arabic(رضbb)م. As for the
third example, (يبكي
ونbbيع يكbb )الرضdoes not have a clear reference to the time of the action of
crying, which is important here. In ‘4’, however, ( ًاb bون ميتbb )الرجل يكis a wrong translation
because it means that the man has already died, whereas ‘dying’ means he is not dead yet,
and possibly he will get well again. The second translation of ‘5’ is unacceptable in Arabic
with regard to both meaning and grammar, as it is not comprehensible, and confusing. Thuse,
we may say that such word-for-word translations are wrong and should be avoided.
Literal translation is, therefore, acceptable, but only when possible and on one
condition: When it is a literal translation of the meaning of English words in context and in
an Arabic word order , and not a literal translation of words in isolation nor in an English
word order. Here is another short example which illustrates the point further (see also the
examples and argument in the Introduction: 4.2):
(األمن )جملس
“Security Council”: } (اجمللس )أمن
(احلرب )جملس
87
2.2.Translation of SYNONYMY: ()الرتادف
Synonymy is the sameness, or the similarity of meaning between two or more words.
Such words are described as synonymous, or synonyms. For example, ‘big’, ‘large’ and
‘huge’ are synonyms. Usually synonyms are divided into two major types:
88
Parallel to that is the fact that near synonyms are commonplace in any language, spoken
or written. They are even indispensable to cover all shades of difference within one and the
same range of meaning. The main problem for the students is that in most cases they
understand all synonymous words as absolute synonyms only. That is, all the English words
similar in meaning have the same identical meaning in Arabic. The following is a discussion
of four major problems of translating synonymy.
(1) The first problem is the translation of synonyms of emotive charge: eg.
Here are sixteen synonyms for one and the same meaning of ‘anger’ ( )غضب. They are
not exhaustive. They form together what is called a ‘lexical set’ or a ‘lexical field’ of anger.
We have sixteen different words in English and fourteen words equivalent to them in Arabic.
This can be described as the precision of translation. However, the problem for the students is
that it is a hard task for them to find the precise synonymous word in Arabic.
The solution to this problem can be traced in the following discussion: On a grading
scale, this lexical set can be divided into three main levels of meaning: ANGRY the middle,
89
A LITTLE ANGRY below, and VERY ANGRY above, as illustrated by the following
diagram:
ANGRY غاضب
In this scale, ‘ANGRY’ is considered as the central level of meaning, and the other two
levels are drawn in comparison to it. Applying this to the whole set of synonyms, we may
have the following reclassification under the below (A LITTLE ANGRY) and the above
(VERY ANGRY) levels:
Similarly, ( )ممتعضis the precise Arabic word for ‘discomforted’. Yet, when the students
are -for some reason- unable to find it, they can use the general translation of this level ( غاضب
90
The important thing for students is to know that the meaning of any word in this lexical
family of anger is within the general scope of ( )غضبin Arabic. The next stage is to
distinguish the level of this emotion, anger. Is it normal? below normal? or above normal?
This distinction is required because ‘bothered’( )متنغص, for instance, is quite different from
‘raged’ (ًباbbأجج غضbb)مت. That is, a bothered person is normal and controls himself, whereas an
outraged person is abnormal, for he does not control himself and loses his senses. That is why
a divorce by a raged husband is pardoned in Islam, whereas an inconvenient, discomforted
man’s divorce is not.
The solution: When the students are unable to make such a distinction, they should
resort to the general name of the whole set, i.e. anger ()غضب.
It must be stressed that all the students’ efforts should concentrate on number one, so
that they can achieve precision of translation, which is the ultimate aim of the translator. Yet,
when the students are unable -for good reasons- to take up ‘1’, they can go for ‘2’ and then
for ‘3’ as their last resort.
(2) The second problem of translating synonymy concerns the synonyms which can be
described as absolute in a certain context only, because it is extremely difficult to
differentiate among them as much in English as in Arabic translation:
e.g:
1. start
2. begin
3. commence
In English, there is no difference in the meaning of these three words as verbs. However,
they differ in other respects:
1.Their combination with other words (i.e. collocations and idioms). For example, only
‘start’ can be used in the following expression:
91
(See collocations and idioms later).
2. The use of ‘start’ only as a phrasal verb (i.e. verb+a preposition or an adverb) to form
new meanings(e.g. start off, start on, start out, etc. ), whereas ‘begin’ and ‘commence’ are
usually not used as phrasal verbs.
3. Only ‘start’ is used both as a noun and a verb , while ‘begin’ has ‘beginning’, and
‘commence’ has ‘commencing/commencement’ as nouns.
4. Commence’ is of Latin origin and, therefore, formal, whereas ‘start’ and ‘begin’ are Old
English and German and, hence, less formal, or informal.
Yet at translating these words into Arabic, they have one translation only (i.e. دأbb )ب.
Students, therefore, do not need to think of three different words in Arabic, such as, say, ( )بدأ,
()دأbb(ابت
،تهلbb اسbecause they look artificial. That is, the three words are the same, with ( دأbb )بas
the commonest in use. On the other hand, other synonyms like ()افتتح, ( )دشنand (رعbb )شare
unnecessary and confusing, because they are further dimensions for the original meaning (
دأbb b b)ب. Thus they have different words in English (‘open’, ‘inaugurate’ and ‘incept’
respectively).
Thus the problem here has an easy solution for students. In the following examples, the
same translation applies.
Another common example is the translation of the English words of obligation: ‘must,
ought to, should, have to, has to, am to, is to, are to’. All these words have one meaning in
Arabic (i.e.)جيب أن. Other variations like (من/البد أن/)ينبغي أن/(رتتب علىbb b ي/b)ك(أنbb b )عليare also
equally acceptable, with (أن )جيبas the most frequent in use.
The Arabic translation is not affected by the formality or informality of the English
words. That is, ‘must, ought to, should, have/has/had to’ are more formal than
‘am/is/are/was/were to’, which are classified as informal in English. However, we can have a
similar classification in Arabic for ( )ينبغي أنand( )جيب أنas formal, and ()ك(أنbb )عليand (ال بد
من/ ))أنas informal. But this classification is not always acceptable in Arabic, as the former is
92
used in the Holy Quran, whose language is all in all formal. Here is an example:(له وعلى املولود
املعروفbbوهتن بbb( )رزقهن وكسthe father of the child should bear responsibility for the cost of the
mother’s food and clothing) (The Cow, 233). The latter, on the other hand, is used frequently
in Arabic classical poetry which is also a formal variety: e.g.:
للقيد أن ينكسرbوالبد لليل أن ينجليbوالبد
(and darkness ought to clear up and handcuffs ought to break down)
So, any of these Arabic words can be used to translate any of the English words of
obligation mentioned above, regardless of its formality or informality: e.g.
1. All the translations in Arabic express the meaning of contrast. Therefore, anyone can be
used to translate all the words in English, in case other synonyms are not within reach, for
some reason.
2. Three more translations are available in Arabic and can equally translate all the English
synonyms: (إال أن/بيد أن/)غري أن.
3. The more frequent translation for ‘however’, (الbbح )على كلis dropped because it is
informal, or even colloquial, and, therefore, not advisable to use.
93
The problem of synonymy here lies only in the students’ ability to understand these
words of contrast, especially confusing ones like ‘having said that’, which would be
translated wrongly by many as: (ومبا أننا ذكرنا(قلنا) هذا/)وبقولنا هذا.
Then, the solution is to choose any word of contrast in Arabic to translate them e.g.
“Snakes are harmful. Yet they can be useful”: (ومع/(ذلك )ومع/لكنها/ إال إهنا(بيد أهنا.األفاعي مؤذية
ذلك)ميكن أن تكون مفيدةbورغم/)هذا
(Multiple technical terms can also be subsumed under absolute synonymy (see pp.169-70
below)
(3) The third problem of translating synonymy, which is difficult for many students to work
out, is the possible multiplicity of synonymous versions in the TL which can be acceptable,
but only in general terms. This is a common practice in everyday use of language, be it
written or spoken. We frequently express ourselves in different synonymous ways and in
other words, with the same meaning in general being kept. More frequent than this is the
habit of explaining difficult words by means of using synonymous common, easy words.
This is fairly recurrent with almost all words and phrases in language except for most
technical, scientific terms which cannot accept but one recognized translation to avoid
ambiguity or being confused with other close terms. The following example illustrates the
point.
This English statement: “The soldiers stood to their guns in the battle” can be translated
into the following versions in Arabic, which I venture to call "the Language of Synonymy":
1. صمد اجلنود يف املعركة
2. املعركة استبسل اجلنود يف ساحة
3. ثبت اجلنود يف امليدان
4. تشبث اجلنود مبواقعهم يف ساحة احلرب
5. أظهر اجلنود شجاعة نادرة يف املعركة
6. تصدى اجلنود ببسالة للعدو يف ساحة الوغى
7. تفاىن اجلنود يف ساحة الشرف
8. ذاد اجلنود عن حياضهم يف املعركة
9. استمات اجلنود يف قتاهلم يف املعركة
10. اسرتخص اجلنود أرواحهم يف القتال
94
All these versions render the SL message in broad terms and within the same range of
meaning of steadfastedness (الثبات/)الصمود. They are good translations that anyone can be used
to translate the English origin satisfyingly. Having said that, we have to admit that there are
considerable stylistic differences of lexical choice and grammatical structure among them.
That is, for stylistic reasons, and when specification and high degree of accuracy are
required, they have to be reconsidered in translation. Stylistic differences of these types are
discussed exhaustively in the next chapter, which is wholly assigned to stylistic problems of
translation.
(4) The fourth problem of translating synonymy is the translation of the so-called ‘familiar
alternative terms’ (Newmark, 1988: 201-4. See also Ghazala’s translation of the book, 2004:
330-336). Familiar alternatives (دائل املألوفةbb b b )البare informal, local, intimate and cordial
nicknames, words or phrases used as substitutions for other formal ones. Here are examples:
8. “The Boot” (for : Italy, after its map which looks like the boot)
( إليطاليا ألن خارطتها تبدو كاجلزمة:)اجلزمة
9. “The Red Devils” (for: the English Manchester United Football Club)
95
(القدم لفريق مانشسرت يونايتد اإلجنليزي لكرة:)الشياطني احلمر
10. “The Boss” (for: the Saudi Football Club, Al-Hilal);
“The Chief/Leader” (for: Al-Ittihad Football Club)
( لنادي االحتاد:b لنادي اهلالل السعودي لكرة القدم؛ والعميد:) الزعيم
Implied in all these major problems of translating synonymy is the disturbing problem of
hesitancy as to which synonym is more appropriate to use in a certain text and context when
several options are available in the TL, especially when accuracy is demanded. 'The Great
Theatre', to take an example, can be translated into (اهلائل/خمbbالض/العظيم/ريbbرح الكبbb)املس. However,
and perhaps surprisingly, only (الكبري )املسرحis acceptable because it is the habitual collocation
in Arabic. Such hesitation is mainly due to monosemous, literal undertanding of words,
native language interference and poor skills of collocability and word combination, and
habitual use of language on the part of students and translators. The solution to this problem
is to beware of understanding words as monosemous, having one common meaning in all
texts and contexts, and check and double-check word combinations and collocation in the TL
that are nowadys available in good general bilingual dictionaries( e.g. Al-Mawred Al-Akbar
(English-Arabic)(2005), Atlas Ensyclopedic Dictionary(English-Arabic) (2003)) and
specialist dictionaries of collocations (a case in point is Ghazala's two Dictionaries of
Collocations (English-Arabic) (2007), and (Arabic-English) (forthcoming 2009).
To sum up, the translation of synonymy is sometimes difficult and complicated. Some
synonymous words, especially those with emotive charge (e.g. anger, fear, love, hatred, etc.)
may have a meaning of different levels each. The students of translation as well as translators
are, therefore, required to take them into consideration in their Arabic translation.
Nevertheless, synonymy can be translated easily when the distinction between the levels
of meaning is unnecessary and unimportant. Only a term of general nature (e.g. expressing
consent, contrast, surprise, courage, etc.) is needed instead.
96
Also, the possibility of having several synonymous, equally acceptable versions of
translation is very often available, but with some restrictions, though, as will be demonstrated
in the third chapter below.
The tricky, but interesting problem of translating familiar alternatives should be handled
with care in translation into Arabic for its sensitive, cultural and local flavour and nature in
language.
Polysemy is a word that has more than one meaning. It is in contrast to monosemy which
describes a word with one single meaning only. For example, ‘stage’ is a polysemous word,
among whose main meanings are: (1) ‘step’(ورbb b bَط/مرحلة/ وةbb b b( ;)خط2) a ‘platform in the
theatre/theatre’ (رحbb مس/رحbb مس
بةbb b)خش. On the other hand, ‘telephone’ and ‘sleep’ have one
meaning each: ( )هاتفand(نوم/ )ينامrespectively.Therefore, they are monosemous.
Monosemous words and terms create no serious problem of translation on the condition
that they are standardized and available in the TL. Most of these words and terms are of
specific, technical and scientific nature and reference. Hence, their translation into Arabic
(i.e. Arabization) is their major problem of translation.. That is why Arabization is assigned a
long section in this chapter (see 2.7. below).
As regards polysemy, which is the point of focus of this section, it is one of the major
distinguishing characteristics of both English and Arabic.(and may be English more than
Arabic). Moreover, many polysemous words have a common meaning each, which is more
popular and known than other meanings. It is called ‘core’ or central meaning. For example,
‘sound’ has the core meaning of ()صوت. At the same time, it has other less popular meanings
of ‘firm’, ‘solid’, ‘wise’, ‘valid’, ‘narrow channel’, and ‘inlet on the sea’, to be discussed
below in this section.
The Problem: The students of translation may know only the common meaning of the
polysemic word, and are usually used to translate it into Arabic, regardless of any of its other
97
possible meanings. This means that they understand it as a monosemic word, having one
meaning only.In effect, they might commit serious mistakes. The following is a discussion of
two major examples, illustrating some potential problems of translating polysemous lexical
items, alongside suggested solutions to them:
The students know the common meaning of ‘break’ as ( )كسر, when used as a verb and (
سر
ْ َك/ )تكسريas a noun :e.g.
It is still within the range of this meaning of ( )كسرto translate ‘break’ into synonyms like
(دمر/حطَّم/هشم
َّ ). e.g.
Yet, the meaning of ( )كسرis not the only one for ‘break’. Rather, other meanings are
assigned to it: e.g.
98
3. “The storming weather has broken at last”: ((ًالعاصف أخريا نتهى اجلو/انقشع
4. “Some people break the law:” (خيالف بعض الناس القانون/ينتهك/)خيرق
5. “Please, do not break your promise”: ( ال ختلف وعدك،)من فضلك
6. “The crowd broke when the match had ended”:(انصرف اجلمهور عند انتهاء املباراة/تفرق/)انفض
7. “ The dawn breaks at 5 O’clock today”: ()يبزغ الفجر عند الساعة اخلامسة اليوم
8. “She will break the news soon”: (ًتبوح باألخبار قريباً جدا/)سوف تفشي(تكشف) األخبار
9. “Let us break bread together”: (ً)لنأكل خبزاً وملحاً معا
10 “We must break for lunch”: ()علينا التوقف من أجل الغداء
11 “The prisoner broke jail”: ()فر السجني من السجن
12 “Sand will break the player’s fall”: ()سوف خيفف الرمل من سقطة الالعب
13 “He got angry and broke camp”: ()غضب وقوض خيمته(لكي يرحل
14 “They are determined to break the back of their task”:
(bعلى قصم ظهر مهمتهم/bعلى إجناز القدر األكرب من مهمتهم )إهنم مصممون
15 “The referee broke between the two boxers twenty times”:
(املالكمْين عشرين مرة
َ باعد احلكم بني/)فصل
(The Collins English Dictionary (1986) cites(76) meanings for ‘break’ -phrasal verbs are not
included).
Certainly, the students are not required to memorize all these meanings for 'break'. They
only need to be bear in mind that it has many meanings, not one meaning only.
Before suggesting the solutions to the problems of distinguishing the intended meaning
of a polysemous word, here is another example:
99
4. “Radio frequencies are sound waves”: (موجات صوتية )الرتددات اإلذاعية
In these examples, ‘sound’ is used and translated into its common meaning (i.e. )صوت.
The students, therefore, have no problem here. However, their problems start when ‘sound’ is
used with its less common, or unknown meanings on the part of the students: e.g.
1. “Your suggestion sounds reasonable”: (ً)يبدو اقرتاحك معقوال
2. “It is a sound basis”: (صلب
ُ أساس )إنه
3. “She had a sound recovery”: (ًمتاثلت للشفاء متاما/ًشفيت شفاء تاما ُ)
4. “Thank you for your sound advice”: ()أشكرك على نصيحتك احلكيمة
5. “Muslims have sound beliefs”: ()عند املسلمني معتقدات راسخة
6. “Children sleep a sound sleep”: (ً)ينام األطفال نوماً عميقا
7. “That sound between the two seas is quite narrow”: (ً)ذاك الربزخ بني البحرين ضيق جدا
8. “Fish has a sound”: (bحوصلة/حويصلة/)للسمك مثانة هوائية
Undoubtedly, these meanings of ‘sound’ are mostly unfamiliar to students, and, hence,
cause a problem of translation to them.
The Solution: To overcome the difficulty of translating a polysemic word used in its
uncommon meaning, the following solutions can be suggested:
1. A huge number of English words are polysemous, some of which have several
meanings. Students are required to bear this in mind when translating a word which seems
strange if translated into its common meaning. This means that it has another meaning, which
is different from that known to them. For example, ‘he broke jail’ will seem strange, if
translated into (جنbb )كسر السbecause nobody can break prison in the sense of cutting it into
pieces. Besides, this translation is unclear: Does it mean he smashed prison to escape, just
smashed the window, or the door, or iron barriers, or what? In all cases none of these
meanings is clearcut, or convincing.
Here students should look for another equivalent which can be more reasonable and
more convincing. With the aid of the teacher, or a good dictionary, they will realize that
‘broke’ here means ‘escaped’ (هرب من/)فر.
2. The type of text is another good guide to students. For instance, in a text about birds,
‘sound’ is likely to have its common meaning (i.e. وتb)ص. Also in a passage about phonetics,
100
‘sound’ is expected to be used in the meaning of ( وتbb)ص. Yet, in a geographical text talking
about rivers, seas, straits and inlets, ‘sound’ is not expected to have the meaning of ( وتbb)ص,
but something geographical rather(i.e.a water passage رزخbب/ائيb))ممر م. In the same way, a text
about the anatomy of fish will not use ‘sound’ in its common sense but rather in a special
meaning (i.e.bladder حويصلة/) مثانة, as we usually do not have what we can really call the sound
( )صوتof fish.
3. The context is decisive in guessing the more likely meaning of a polysemous word. The
context means that: (1) we must look at the preceding and following sentences, or clauses;
and (2) the general context of the whole text should also be taken into consideration when (1)
does not help. e.g.
1.“The runner fell down in the race. He broke his leg. So he was immediately taken to
hospital”: (( لذا ُأخذ(نُقل) مباشرة إىل املستشفى.سقط العداء أرضاً يف السباق(؟)ساقه
To decide the meaning of the polysemous word ‘broke’, we look at the preceding
sentence to find out that a runner ‘fell down’ in a"race". Then we consider the following
sentence to discover that a hospital is mentioned. Beside that, ‘broke his leg’ is another help
to be quite sure that ‘broke’ is used in its common meaning of ( )كسر, which replaces the
question mark in the Arabic translation.
Now we consider the following example: How do we translate? :
2.“Go break a leg?”.
-“Are you nervous because of the exam? Do not worry, go break a leg!”:
())هل أنت متوتر بسبب االمتحان؟ ال تقلق (؟
The statements before ‘go break a leg’ are about nervousness and the exam. It is
unacceptable to understand ‘break’ here in its common sense ( )يكسر, because it is nonsense
(is it to break the teacher’s leg, for instance?!). So students are invited to think it over for a
short time to guess its meaning, taking into account the previous context of the examination
and its atmosphere, and what people wish one another in the exam. Everybody wishes
everybody else ‘good luck’ in the exam. Thus, ‘go break a leg’ can be a synonym for ‘good
luck’ (i.e. ً(أمتىن لك)حظاً سعيدا/أمتىن لك التوفيق/)وفقك اهلل.
101
As to the greater context (i.e.the text), the previous point about the type of text illustrates
it.
4. The direct translation of the polysemous word into its common meaning and then finding
out whether it makes sense in Arabic or not. Let us retranslate the following sentences from
the first example:
1. “This medicine will break you of smoking”: (من التدخني )!سوف يكسرك هذا الدواء
2. “The storming weather has broken at last”: (ً)! انكسر اجلو العاصف أخريا
3. “She will break the news soon”: (ً)!سوف تكسر األخبار قريباً جدا
All these translations do not make sense in Arabic. ( )يكسرcannot be expected in such
uses: neither a medicine can break someone, nor the weather breaks down, nor someone can
break the news down. However, a medicine can make someone dispose of smoking; the
windy weather, for instance, comes to an end; and the news can be reported. Therefore, the
sensible translations of ‘break’ are:(1) ( ( ;)خيلصك2) (( ;)انتهى3)(تبوح بـ/ )تفشيrespectively.
The first and most important step for students is to realize that the Arabic translation
does not make sense. Then, they start thinking about more correct, sensible translation.
Besides, the type of text and context are quite useful to them.
5. The grammatical class of the word (i.e. verb, noun, adjective, etc. ) can be a guide to its
polysemy. ‘Sound’, for instance, is known to students as a noun. When it is used as a verb, or
an adjective, it can have a different meaning: In the examples earlier, ‘sound’ is used as a
verb in:
The students must suspect that it can have another meaning,, then,which is equivalent to
‘seem’ ( )يبدوhere.
Also, when used as an adjective, it has different meanings, as several examples above
show: (e.g. ‘sound beliefs’ ( bخةbbدات راسbb )معتقetc. ‘Sound waves’ is not included here, because
‘sound’ is a noun used as an adjective (i.e. adjectival noun).
102
On the other hand, ‘break’ is commonly used as a verb. So, when used as a noun, it can
have a new meaning: e.g.
As a noun, ‘break’ has the meaning of ( bفرصة/اسرتاحة/ )راحةwhich is obviously different from its
common, well-known meaning as a verb (i.e. )يكسر.
6. The expected combination (or collocation)of a polysemous word with other words is also
helpful in guessing its meaning. ‘Break’, for example is expected by the students to combine
with physical objects like: ‘window, door, hand, leg, head, car, wood, etc.’ So when it occurs
together with abstract, nonphysical words like: ‘promise, law , lunch, dawn, weather, etc.’, it
has different meanings that need some efforts by them to spot (see the examples above).
‘Sound’ is likely to collocate with physical words which indicate the objects that
produce them (i.e. a bird, a machine, an animal, etc). However, when as an adjctive it
collocates with abstract words like ‘argument, basis, belief, examination, etc.’, it must have
other meanings which are different from its common physical meaning of ( وتbb b( )صsee
examples about ‘sound’ above, and collocations below for further discussion).
7. The use of the word as a phrasal verb is an indication of its polysemic nature, as phrasal
verbs have completely new meanings. Therefore, students must be extremely careful at
translating a verb followed by an adverb or a preposition. Let us take ‘break’ again as an
example:
There are thousands of phrasal verbs in English. They are so popular both in written as
well as spoken language, although they are classified as informal. In translation, however,
103
they pose a considerable translation problem to students, because they are so many and
unpredictable. In addition, they can be confused with prepositional verbs(i.e. a.verb+a
preposition each), which, unlike them, do not have new meanings (i.e. they are
monosemous) e.g.
1. “The boy broke the window with a hammer”: (مبطرقة)كسر الصيب النافذة
2. “The boy broke with his mates yesterday”: ()انفصل الصيب عن رفاقه أمس
Students can distinguish between these two types of verb by looking at the context to
find out whether a verb makes sense if translated into its common meaning, check it in a
dictionary, and/or seek help from any kind of available reference or authority. (See the
section on Idioms: Phrasal verb, below).
104
2.4. Translation of COLLOCATIONS:
Drawing a comparison between a text and the human body, Newmark (op.cit.: 125)
likens grammar to the skeleton, words to flesh, and collocations are the tendons that connect
them to one another. Indeed, collocations play a vital role in language. They are its beautiful
part, and inject a refreshing spirit in it. They are present and inevitable in any kind of text
with no exception. Hence their importance in translation. Students need to attend to them
fully in Arabic to lend the Arabic version the same beauty of the English text. This means
that undermining the concern with the translation of the English collocations in Arabic -
which has been the case until very recently - results in a poor, despirited Arabic text.
Types of Collocations :
105
There are several types of collocations. However, the concentration here is on the most
important ones only, which are extremely recurrent in language use, and interest students and
translators most. The classification of these types is purely grammatical, depending on the
grammatical groupings of word classes according to their occurrence together in the use of
language. The adoption of grammatical description makes the structure of collocations easier
to follow, understand and, hence, translate into Arabic.
Many examples can be foud in both languages for this most popular type of
collocations. Usually, these collocations are translated into identical Arabic ones (i.e.
noun+adjective). As the examples show, this is possible in most cases, and students are
encouraged to do their best to find the equivalent collocation in Arabic, because an English
collocation is better translated into a collocation in Arabic.
However, there are English collocatio ns which do not have identical Arabic
equivalent collocations: e.g.
1 .“peaceful death”: (هادئ )موت
2 .“great pleasure”: (سعادة غامرة/)سعادة عظيمة
106
3. “bad news”: (سارة غري/b)أخبار سيئة
4. “ good day”: ()يوم سعيد
5. “standstill situation”: ()وضع مشلول
The Arabic versions are not widely recognized collocations. They can be called semi-
collocations, or just translations. The last one can exceptionally have a popular, informal
ِ )مكانك راوح.
Arabic equivalent as ()(س ْر ْ
The main problem for students is to find the proper Arabic equivalent collocation. The
solution, however, is not difficult to bring about if they are prepared to exert personal efforts,
looking it up in monolingual and bilingual dictionaries, general and specialist(see 2.2.
earlier), grammar and reference books, including the Holy Quran, the Prophet's Tradition
(Sunnah), Islamic books, classic poetry and literature (these arethe major sources of Arabic
collocations). When they cannot find a way out, they just translate the meaning of the
collocation at hand correctly and suitably into Arabic. This second choice is acceptable, but
poorer than the first. In all cases, there are more guidelines to the translation of collocations
into Arabic at the end of this section.
For the students of translation to appreciate these and other collocations in Arabic, they
can draw a comparison between proper collocations (as in the first group of examples) and
ordinary, different translations: e.g.
Compare:
1. ()أشغال شاقة to (ُمضنية
)أعمال
2. ()عاصفة هوجاء to (غاضبة/)عاصفة هائجة
3. ()استقبال حار to ()استقبال ساخن
4. ()غنم قاصية to ()غنم شاردة
5. ()سوق سوداء to ()سوق داكنة
The comparison between each pair of these examples indicates that the group on the left
is more familiar, habitual and formal than the second one on the right
Special adjective-noun collocations are used to describe bad, inedible food. e.g.
1. “addled eggs ”: (()بيض فاسد(خرب
2. “bad milk”: (()فاسد(خرب حليب
107
3. “putrid meat/fish”: (فاسد مسك/ )حلم
4 .“rancid butter”: ())زبدة زخنة(فاسدة
5. “rotten fruit”: ((b)فاكهة فاسدة(عفنة
6. “spoiled/bad meat”: ((خام/
ّ حلم فاسد
At first sight, these collocations cause some problems to the students of translation into
Arabic, because it is difficult to find Arabic equivalents for the English adjectives. Perhaps
they will not find them at all, for there are no adjectives like these in Arabic, apart from those
in the examples.
The problem here is easy to overcome. The solution is simply to use the adjective (
bفاسدة/ )فاسدwith all kinds of bad food.
2 Verb+ noun collocations: e.g.
The problem for students with these collocations is to find the suitable verb in Arabic.
However, when it is difficult to do that, they can translate them into sense (i.e.literal, surface
meaning): For example, ( ًاbدر قانونbb)يصinstead of (ًاbوز(;)يسن قانونbb )يفinstead of (ًاراbb)ينتبه( ;)حيرز انتص
instead of (االنتباه )يسحب سيفاً( ;)يعريinstead of (ً)يستل سيفا.
108
Concerning the grammatical structure of these collocations in Arabic, it
is mostly a verb+ noun (or a verb+an object). Yet few exceptions can occur:
e.g.
1. “pay a visit”: (يزور/)يقوم بزيارة
2. “recognize a state”: ()يعرتف بدولة
3 .“shake hands”: (يتصافح/)يصافح
In ‘1’ and ‘2’, the grammatical construction in Arabic is: ‘verb+ preposition+noun(i.e. a
prepositional phrase)’, whereas in ‘3’, the collocation disappears in Arabic. However, these
exceptions do not break the rule of translating the English verb-noun collocations into Arabic
equivalents of correspodent structure.
109
)دماغيةfor ‘1’; ( )شهر عسليfor ‘9’; or ( )أمري شاعريfor ‘10’. The students should try to remember
the fixed structure of these collocations in both languages, for back-translation test (i.e.
translating the Arabic collocations back into English) will fail to get the proper English
combinations. The result would look like this: ‘cerebral immigration’ (for ‘brain drain’);
‘honey month’ (for ‘honey moon’); ‘poetic prince’ (for ‘poet laureate’). The suggested back-
translated versions are not a part of English lexicon. Hence, students are warned against
undertaking such literal understanding or translation of words, disregarding standard
collocability of language in general.
The big problem for the students here is to know the proper equivalent collocation in
Arabic, especially for difficult English collocations like ‘brain drain’, ‘attorney general’ and
‘essay bank’. The solution is they have to be careful with literal understanding as much as
they can, and do their best to understand the English collocation properly and translate it into
its Arabic proper equivalent, using all available resources.
All these collocations are translated into equivalent Arabic collocations of identical
grammatical structure: ‘of-genitive’. Although direct translation applies to such collocations,
the students must be careful that some of them have different words in Arabic (i.e ( تنفس
عداءbb b )الصand not (زوغ الفجر( ;)تنهد الراحةbb b )ب, not ()كسر الفجر, (but we can say: ()انبالج الفجر
especially in formal and literary texts); ()ساعة احلسم, not ( ;)ساعة القرارetc.).
On the other hand, most of these collocations are translated into collocations in Arabic.
Yet , a number of them can be translated into meaning only (e.g. ‘4 , 9, 10’).
110
5.Noun+and +noun(addition( ) )العطفcollocations: e.g.
Seemingly, these collocations of addition are easy to translate directly into ‘noun
+and+noun’ collocations in Arabic. However, few of these collocations can be different in
grammatical form. The ninth example has the grammatical function of an adverb, as in:
Other English collocations of addition are not collocations in Arabic, such as ‘8’ which
is a translation of sense. On the other hand, ‘10’ is a well-known collocation both in English
and Arabic laws, and should be rendered in this form into Arabic. Students need to consult a
specialized dictionary, or a good English-Arabic dictionary.
Direct translation should always be watched in collocations like ‘3’ and ‘7’. In ‘3’, we
do not have the collocation (دةbb )اخلبز والزبbut (لقمة العيش/ورد رزقbb)م, which is a fixed phrase of
some kind in Arabic.
In ‘7’, the word order in Arabic is the opposite of that in English: ‘vice’ ( )الرذيلةis before
‘virtue’ ()الفضيلة. Therefore, literal translation of the English word order does not work.
111
1. “hale and hearty”: (جيدة )بصحة
2. “healthy and well”: (صحيح معاىف/)بصحة وعافية
3. “alive and kicking”: ()حي يرزق
4. “well and good”: ()على خري ما يرام
5. “right and proper”: (متام التمام/كامل مكمل/)يف أحسن حال
The problem of translating such everyday collocations into Arabic is that, first, the
grammatical structure is different and unpredictable. That is , ‘ 1,2,4,5’ can be translated into:
‘preposition+noun+noun’, whereas ‘3’ is: “noun+verb”; yet ‘3+5’ have further possible
‘noun+adjective’ variations. Although the Arabic translations are collocations, numbers ‘1
and 5’ can be translated into one and the same collocation: either ( )بصحة جيدة, ))على خري ما يرام
or (الbbح )يف أحسن. Beside that, one word can be enough to translate them: ( اىفbb)مع,(حيحbb )صor (
b)سليم. But one word is not a collocation, and is regarded as weaker than the former version as
well as the English original: These collocations can also be translated into two words each
(adj.+adj.) as : ( )صحيح معاىفor()كامل مكمل, which are not bad.
The three Arabic translations are collocations, but have different grammatical structures.
They are grammatically different from the English collocations. Therefore, like those of ‘6’
above, they create a problem to students. However, they are not difficult to understand and
translate for they are not unusual nor idiomatic.
The collocations of types ‘6’ and ‘7’ can be described as redundant. That is, the two
words of the collocation are synonymous and explain each other ( ‘2’ in ‘7’ is an exception):
‘hale=hearty’; healthy=well’; wholly=heartedly’, etc. Also, they are rare and, therefore,
should not bother the students.
112
2. “bells ring /toll”: (األجراس )رنني
3. “cats mew”: ()مواء القطط
4. “dogs bark”: ()نباح الكالب
5. “donkeys bray”: ()هنيق احلمري
6. “doors creak”: ()صرير األبواب
7. “flies buzz”: ()طنني الذباب
8. “lions roar”: ()زئري األسود
9. “snakes hiss”: ()فحيح األفاعي
10.“sparrows chirp”: ()زقزقة العصافري
11.“trees rustle”: ()حفيف الشجر
12.“wolves howl”: ()عواء الذئاب
These collocations are not difficult to translate into collocations in Arabic. The only
problem for the students is to be able to recognize in Arabic the sound of the animal, insect or
thing required.
The solution is to know the name of the sound in question in the target language, which is
possible for students. No better solution is available. For example, using the word ( وتb )صas a
general word to describe the sound of anything is poor and, therefore, not advisable (e.g.( صوت
;)صوت القطط( ;)صوت اجلرس( ;)النحلetc). However, it is better than nothing.
On the other hand, the grammatical structure in Arabic is noun+noun’ (i.e. genitive), not
noun+ verb’ as in English. Yet, a noun-and-a-verb construction is possible in Arabic if the
context requires that: e.g.
“I heard the dogs bark last night”: (أمس )مسعت الكالب تنبح ليلة
9. Prepositional collocations:
113
3. “A protest against”: ()احتجاح على
4. “A burst at”: ()رمي على
5. “A pride in”: ()تفاخر بـ
6. “Ignorance of (something)”: ()ما اجلهل بـ(شيء
(Predictable examples are not included :e.g. ‘conversation about’ ( ولbb b b bح/عن ‘ ;)حمادثةa
suggestion concerning”( خبصوص/“ ; )اقرتاح يتعلق بـthe escape of” (the prisoner) جني )هروبb )السand
‘of-genitive’ constructions; etc.).
The students should beware of the direct translation of the preposition. We do not say (
اظbbاء لـ( ;)تالعب على األلفbbاج ضد( ;)ادعbbاخر يف(;)قذيفة إىل( ;)احتجbb ;)تفor (()يء ماbbل(شbb جهin Arabic. The
problem here, then, is to find the suitable preposition after the noun in Arabic. This needs to
be done apart from the English preposition. The solution is the students’ increasing interest in
Arabic prepositions and their unusual use in context.
114
These English collocations are fixed phrases and cannot be translated literally. Although
many of them are translated into identical Arabic prepositional phrases (i.e. preposition+on);
others are quite unpredictable, like ‘3’. Some of the translations in Arabic are well-known
collocations (‘1’, ‘5’, and ‘10’ in particular).
The problem for the students at translating these collocations is to understand them
rightly as fixed expressions in Arabic. The solution is to work harder in order to produce
good translation in Arabic, bearing in mind the risks of literal translation of words. Usually,
good dictionaries include such collocations.
(Expected combinations like ‘adjacent to (لـ ‘ ;)جماورinclined to’ ( ;)ميال لـetc. are not included).
The problem of translation here lies in the meaning of the preposition which should be
translated with extra care by the students. Literal translation of words is again risky here. The
solution is to be on the alert that some of these collocations can be fixed phrases with fixed
meanings. In any case, the grammatical construction in Arabic is the same as in English (i.e.
‘adjective+preposition’).
115
2. “wait for(somebody)”: ()ً)ينتظر(فالنا
3. “call at”: ()ينادي على
4. “protest against”: ()حيتج على
5. “dream of/with”: (بـ )حيلم
Prepositional verbs like these resist direct translation. We cannot say ( ألجل ينتظر( ;)يشتاق
)من أجل,()ينادي إىل, ()حيتج ضد, ( )حيلم منconsecutively. A back translation of the correct versions
illustrates the point further:
These collocations are not acceptable in English. Equally, the Arabic literal translations
of words are unacceptable too. By comparing these English and Arabic versions with one
another, the students may find a solution of some kind.
116
10.“as bad as bad can be”: (السيئ )أسوأ من
11.“as slender as a thread”: (أرفع من اخليط/)أرفع من العود
12.“as slippery as an eel”: (مثل الزئبق/)أزلق من السمك
13.“as soft as a snake”: ()أملس(أنعم)من الحية
14.“as quick as lightning”: ()أسرع من الربق
These similes are fixed, cultural idiomatic collocations. They cannot be changed or
interrupted in the middle. Some are also specific to English culture and people. Yet, most of
them have identical similes in Arabic and are treated as proverbs. They are usually in the
comparative grammatical form of exaggeration (( )صيغة التفضيلi.e.‘better than’), rather than the
form of equalness (i.e. 'as much as'/‘something=something’). This form is too established to
be questioned. Indeed, it is one of the basic, common forms of hundreds of Arabic popular
proverbs. (For more confirmation and evidence, see Majmaa Al-Amthaal (الbb األمثb( )جممع4
vols.), Al-Maydaani, (1996), Al-Munjed fil- Lughati wal-Aalam: Arabic-Arabic Dictionary
(1987(29th edn): pp. 970-1014), Al-Ghalayeeni (1998: 195), Ghazala, (2007: 95-106), and
most established Arabic Language Dictionaries and reference books). Having said that, it is
acceptable to translate these collocations into equivalent forms of equality between the two
parts of the simile, as suggested below. This is the first important point that the students have
to take into account at translating these collocations.
The second important point is to consider the cultural aspects of some of these similes.
For example, the bird ‘lark’ ( ( )ال ُقرّب ة1)is a symbol of beauty in English culture, but not in
Arabic culture. The ‘hills’ ( ( )اهلضاب8) are also used to imply the meaning of oldness for the
English, not for the Arab people. This cultural problem can be beaten by searching for the
cultural equivalent simile in Arabic, regardless of the difference of wording. That is, ‘lark’ is
not used in Arabic in this context, but words like ( ورةbb )ص, ( )قمرor (درbb )بare used instead.
Therefore, we ignore ‘lark’ altogether and use one of these three words which are equally
favourable. The students are warned against direct translation, or looking for the equivalent
word in the same lexical family in Arabic. That is, they might think that ‘lark’ is a bird used
in English to symbolize beauty, so they have to search for the equivalent bird in Arabic that
may symbolize beauty like the ‘nightingale’ ( )العندليبor the ‘hoopoe’ ()اهلدهد, for example. In
117
a similar way, they may insist on translating ‘hills’ into its direct meaning of ( هضاب/)تالل, or a
similar word like ‘mountains’ ( الbb)جب, ‘plateau/highland’ ( )جند, etc. Such translations will not
be successful. The same applies to recent similes like ‘as fast as a bullet’ (Literally: رع منbأس
)الرصاصة/‘as quick as Concorde’ (literally: وردbb ائرة) الكونكbb رع من (طbb )أسwhich interchange with
‘14’ and ‘15’ above. They are translated into Arabic in the same way the two examples are
translated and into the same similes. The students and translators are not required to invent
new collocational similes to match the English recent ones. (See Ghazala, 2002, for more
details).
The solution is to ignore the individual words and take the whole simile as an expression
of a specific cultural meaning, which should be translated regardless of the words used in the
simile. That is the reason behind translating ‘lark’ into ( ورةbb )صand ‘hills’ into (اريخbb )تin the
examples above.
That said, most of these similes have identical Arabic ones, as illustrated by the
examples earlier. On the other hand, it is possible to translate them into the same grammatical
structure of equality between the two parts of each simile. Here they are respectively: (حلو مثل
ورةbb )الص, (مندرbb )أمحر كالش,(الكلبbb)ويف ك, (ارbbبور كاحلمbb )ص,(انbbمثل احلص/دbbوي كاألسbb)ق, ()عنيد كالبغل, (حلو
كرbb مثل الس/لbb )كالعس, (اريخbb دم التbb دمي قbb )ق, (الثعلبbb اكر كbb )م, (وءbb يئ كالسbb )س, (مثل اخليط/ودbb )رفيع مثل الع, (َزلِق
مكb)كالس, ( مثل احليةbاعمbن/)أملس, (ربقbمثل ال/الربقbريع كb)س, (ريع كالبصرbس/همbريع كالسb)س, etc . In fact, ( مثل
)الزئبقof ‘13’ has this form only, whereas ( )صرب أيوبof ‘14’ is an exception because :
1. It is a fixed, religious untouched phrase.
2. It has no comparative form of exaggeration (i.e. وبbb أي )أصرب من, for there is no ‘patience’
greater than the Prophet Job’s, or even like it !
The problem facing the students with these similes is their unawareness of their
equivalents in Arabic, especially the cultural ones. The solution is try to understand the
implied meaning of the simile, and translate it into Arabic in some way or another if and
when they do not know the proper equivalent simile in Arabic.
118
3. “a flock of sheep”: ( غنمbثَلة/من الغنم
)ثَلة
4. “a herd of buffalo”: ( جواميسbقطيع/)قطيع من اجلواميس
5. “a herd of cattle”: ( ماشيةbقطيع/)قطيع من املاشية
6. “a pack of dogs”: (فريق كالب/)فريق من الكالب
7. “a pride of lions”: (قطيع أسود/)قطيع من األسود
8. “a school of whales”: (قطيع حيتان/)قطيع من احليتان
9. “a set of glasses”: (طقم كؤوس/)طقم من الكؤوس
10.“a swarm (colony)of bees”: (سرب حنل/شرم(سرب)من النحل ْ ) َخ
11.“a shoal (school)of fish”: (قطيع من السمك/فوج/)سرب
These collocations are also fixed phrases. Each one is a part of a whole which can be
counted. For example, ‘flowers’ is a countable whole; and ‘bouquet’ is a small number of
flowers, and, therefore, one part of that whole.
In Arabic, there are equivalent collocations. The students should insist on finding them.
Perhaps they do not have a problem with words of daily use like ( )باقة وردand ( )حشد من الناس.
However, they come across a problem at finding ( غنم ) )َثلةit should be with ‘fat-hah’, for with
‘dammah’(i.e.(ثُلة, it refers to a group of people, as in the Holy Quran (Chapter of ‘The Event’
(( )الواقعة: 40,39 ,13)). (See also Ath-Thaalibi, 1983). The same applies to ( )فريق كالب, (قطيع
ودbb )أسand (انbb)قطيع حيت.The most problematic of all is ( رم من النحلbb)خش, as the word (رمbb )خشis
quite uncommon and highly specialized in Arabic. That is why ( )سربis preferred to it.
The solution that can be suggested here - in case that students do not distinguish the
proper word in Arabic - is to use the generic word ( b )جمموعةor ( ددbb )عto precede a group of
anything countable (i.e. people, animals, insects or things): (من عددb/ جمموعة،)جمموعة ورد (من الورد
))الناس(األغنام، etc. The generic word ( )قطيعcan be used with any group of animals, whereas (
119
)سربwith any group of insects. We may also limit the use of ( b )جمموعةto any group of people
or things. Thus, there is a choice between ‘1 ’ on the one hand, and ‘2, 3, 4’, on the
other, from the following:
1. The use of ( )جمموعةor ( )عددto describe a part of any countable noun .
2. The use of ( )قطيعwith any group of animals.
3. The use of ( )سربwith any group of insects and birds.
4. The use of ( )جمموعةor( )عددwith any group of people or things.
120
These collocations are used to refer to parts of nouns which cannot be counted in
English. There are similar collocations in Arabic. Yet, some nouns are uncountable in
English, but countable in Arabic: e.g.
1. ( معلومات←معلومة )
2. ( نصائح ←نصيحة )
3. ( أخبار←(خرب
Therefore, they are not translated into collocations, but into one word each only (see 3, 4,
6).
Some of these collocations are known to students, and, therefore, easy to translate into
Arabic (especially the examples from ‘11’ to ‘15’). Yet, they may find some difficulty at
translating the rest of the examples.
Unlike the collocations of ‘14’ above, there is no one general word that can be used with
all these collocations. Although the word ( )قطعةcan be used with ‘2, 5, 7, 8, 9’ and less
frequently with ‘10, 11 and 15’, other collocations need specific words (as in ‘1, 2, 3,7,10,
11, 12, 13, 14 and 15’).
The problem is, therefore, confined to the search for the appropriate word used to refer to
the part of a specific uncountable noun. The solution is, first, to make sure that the noun is
uncountable as English uncountable nouns are not the same in Arabic (e.g. ‘news’ ( خرب/;)أخبار
‘information’ (معلومة/ ;)معلوماتetc. Secondly, students have to try to locate the proper word for
the part of the uncountable noun, asking help from various sources including Arabic-Arabic
dictionaries. When unable to find it, a general word like ( )قطعةor ( )شيء منcan be used.
The translation of English collocations into Arabic has two main general problems
discussed below:
a. The difficulty of generalization: Some English words collocate with one and the same
word, but they are not necessarily so in Arabic. For example, ‘commit a mistake’ has an
identical collocation in Arabic as (ًأb رتكب خطbb)ي. Also, ‘commit a murder, is translated into (
121
)يرتكب جرمية, (but we use ( )يقرتف جرميةa great deal). Yet, we do not say in Arabic (ً)يرتكب انتحارا
for ‘commit suicide’, but ()ينتحر. Thus, ‘commit’ is not always ( )يرتكبor ()يقرتف.
In a similar way, ‘fat’ ( بدين/ )مسنيcollocates both in English and Arabic with ‘man/woman’
(امرأة/)رجل. Nevertheless, we say only in English: ‘fat salary’/’fat book’, but in Arabic we say
()ضخم(مسيك كتاب/))راتب ضخم (متخم, not (كتاب مسني/)راتب مسني.
Also, we say in Arabic ( رة ناعمةbb )بشfor ‘soft skin’, but we cannot say ( اه ناعمةb )ميfor ‘soft
water’, nor (روبات ناعمةbb )مشfor ‘soft drinks’, but ( زالل/راتbb bف/ذبbb bاء عbb b )مand (روبات خفيفةbb b)مش
consecutively. Likewise, ‘soft soil’ is( بةbb خص )تربة, not ()تربة ناعمة, while ‘soft ground’ can be
either (ملساء )أرضor ()أرض ناعمة.
Finally, here is a detailed example, showing the various words that collocate with one and
the same word: ‘bright’ ()مشرق, to produce different collocations of different meanings:
1. “bright beauty”:()أخاذ/
ّ متألق (فتان مجال
2. “bright child”: ()الذهن متّقد/
ُ طفل ذكي (بارع
3. “bright colours”: ()ألوان زاهية
4. “bright face’: (مشرق/وضاء )وجه
5. “bright future”: (b)باهر/)مستقبل زاهر (باسم
6. “bright idea”: (رائعة/)فكرة براقة
7. “bright light”: (منري
ضوء/)نور وضاء
8. “bright red”: (أمحر هبي/)أمحر براق
9. “bright remark”: ()مالحظة بارعة
10.“bright sky”: ()مساء صافية
11.“bright sun”: ( ساطعةbمشس/)مشس مشرقة
12.“bright victory”: ()انتصار باهر
13.“bright voice”: (عذب صوت/)صوت رخيم
14.“bright drink/wine”: (مخر رائق/)مشروب(شراب)صاف
122
This long example confirms that words like ‘bright’ which collocate with several
different words are problematic for the students. Extra caution is, therefore, demanded here.
Fortunately, these collocations can be found in good dictionaries(e.g. Al-Mawrid English-
Arabic Dictionary).
Thus, the students of translation cannot generalize about the meaning of a word that
collocates with several words. It can be different from one collocation to another, and from
one language to another.
b. Variability of collocations:
Different collocations for the same meaning can
exist in English, but they have one collocation and one single meaning in
Arabic: e.g.
1. “commit a mistake/make a mistake”: ()يرتكب(يقرتف)خطأ
2. “go on a visit/pay a visit”: ()يقوم بزيارة
3. “hard task/daunting task”: ()مهمة شاقة
4. “empty talk/idle talk”: (هراء/)كالم فارغ
Usually these equivalent collocations have one and the same translation in Arabic.
Students need not have different versions for equivalent English collocations, or else they
may commit mistakes. For example, they need not translate ‘make a mistake’ and ‘commit
a mistake’ into (يعمل خطأ/نعbb )يصand (رتكب خطأbb )يrespectively, for both mean ( رتفbbيق/رتكبbbي
)خطأ. Yet, if there are equivalent collocations in Arabic, they can give them,
bearing in mind that anyone is qualified to translate the synonymous English
collocations: e.g .
1. “deep sleep”: ()نوم عميق
2. “heavy sleep”: ()نوم ثقيل
3. “sound sleep”: ()سبات عميق
4. “fast sleep”: ()سبات عميق
123
“Black market” → “black illegal market”: (مشروعة )سوق سوداء غري
2.Verb + noun collocations : e.g.
“Exert an effort” → “exert a great effort”: (ًجهداً عظيما )يبذل
3.Noun + noun (the of–genitive)collocations : e. g.
“Association of ideas” → “association of some ideas”: (األفكار )تداعي بعض
4.Noun + verb collocations (names of sounds): e.g.
“Bees buzz” → “bees strongly buzz”: (ًقويا ًدويا/)يدوي النحل بقوة
5.Verb + preposition collocations : e. g.
“Long for” → “long so much for”: (جدا
ً ً)يشتاق كثريا
6.Parts of countable nouns’ collocations : e. g.
‘a bouquet of flowers” → “ a bouquet of red flowers”: (ورد محراء )باقة
7.Parts of uncountable nouns’ collocations : e. g.
“A pat of butter” → “ a pat of Danish butter”: (دمناركية )قالب صب زبدة
Yet, the remaining types of collocations are fixed, inflexible and cannot be interrupted
in the middle:
1. Noun+noun collocations.
2. Noun+and+noun collocations.
3. Adjective+adjective collocations.
4. Adverb+adverb collocations.
5. Noun+preposition collocations.
6. Preposition+noun collocations.
7. Adjective+noun collocations.
8. Collocations of similes (as … as)
124
The following is a summary of the suggested possible solutions to the translation
problems of English collocations into Arabic. They are introduced in order of preference (i.e.
the first is the best, then the second, then the third, etc).
1. Tracing the identical collocation in Arabic, if and when available. Usually a great
number of English collocations have equivalent ones in Arabic.
2. In case that an identical collocation is not found in Arabic, a close collocation can be
suggested. For example, ‘straying sheep’ is ( يةbb)غنم قاص, but when students fail to get it, they
can suggest a close alternative like(القطيع متخلفة عن/ضالة/ضائعة/تائهة/)غنم شاردة.
3. When ‘1’ and ‘2’ are not possible, a suitable collocation in Arabic can be suggested: two
words for two words, three for three, etc. ‘Shock enormity’, to take one example, is ( ولbb ه
)الصدمة. When students do not know that, they may suggest a two-word collocation of their own
such as(تأثري) الصدمة/ )ضخامة (قوة, or even ()صدمة قوية.
4. If none of the previous solutions is at the students’ disposal, a translation of the correct
meaning of the collocation is an acceptable resort. It does not matter whether it is translated
into one, two, three or more words. For example, ‘alive and kicking’ ( رزقbb b )حي يcan be
translated into: (اةbاحلي )على قيد, (ًاbزال حيbb )ما ي, (دةbحة جيb)بص, (رامbحته على ما يb)ص, etc. The grammatical
structure of the English collocation is ignored completely here.
5. A direct meaning should be translated into a direct meaning (as most of the examples
above), and an indirect meaning into an indirect meaning in Arabic (especially the collocations
of similes). For example, it is not advisable to translate ‘as swift as an arrow’ into a direct
meaning as (ً)سريع جدا, but into an indirect meaning as ( أسرع من/أسرع من الربق/أسرع من ملح البصر
)السهم.
7. By the same token, if the English collocation is formal, the Arabic equivalent should also
be formal (as the vast majority of the previous examples show). It is not advisable at all to
translate it into a colloquial Arabic collocation.
125
8. Fixed collocations like ‘as.….as’ similes, which cannot be interrupted in the middle, should
be translated into equivalent Arabic ones with extra care. We cannot say, for instance: ‘he is as
very stubborn as a mule’ in English, nor can we say ( )هو أعند جداً من البغل. We simply say: ‘he is
as stubborn as a mule’( من البغل هو أعند/لbb )هو عنيد كالبغ, as indicated earlier in connection with
these similes.
9.When unable to work out a better solution and as the last resort, students may escape with
a blind, literal translation of words. However, it is the poorest translation. It can also be quite
risky because it may result in a wrong, funny Arabic version. For example, ‘hard currency’ is (
عبةbb )عملة ص, but if it is translated into ( يةbb قاسb)عملة, it will sound strange and funny. Likewise,
‘brain drain’ cannot be translated into ( الدماغ )تصفيةbecause it is unclear and may bring to mind
irrelevant meanings and implications in Arabic
Nevertheless , some collocations can be translated in a direct way quite properly, as many
examples of this section confirm. After all, students should be cautious and refuse to surrender
from the first attempt to the direct, word-for-word translation of any collocation, or else they
would commit serious mistakes at times, as illustrated throughout this discussion of the
translation of collocations.
1. fixedness/flexibility
2. grammatical structure
3.directness/indirectness
4. clarity/unclarity
5. formal/colloquial style
6. simplicity/complexity
7. context
8. familiarity/strangeness
Yet, if students think that, for good reasons concerning the nature of Arabic (such as the
difference between the word order of adjective+noun), they cannot meet one or more of these
points, they may simply overcome them.
Finally, the rapidly growing interest in the translation of collocations in translation studies
is due to their special importance in language. They play a vital role in the coherence of the
structure of language. They are also the source of its attraction and special flavour that makes it
more beautiful, more rhetorical, more effective and more powerful. The translation of
collocations is an everlasting struggle to match the proper nouns with the proper verbs, the
proper verbs with the proper nouns, the proper nouns with the proper nouns, the proper
126
adjectives with the proper nouns, and so on and so forth. The students of translation are, thus,
required to exercise patience, caution and be extra sensitive to them in translation. They are
advised to do their best to find the proper collocation in Arabic, if and when available. Without
collocations, their Arabic translation would seem poorer, weaker, and less inspired than the
English original.
A special phrase is a phrase with a special meaning that cannot be understood from the
direct, surface meaning of its words, nor from their total meaning when taken together. A
fixed phrase, on the other hand, is a phrase which always has one single grammatical and
lexical form and word order that cannot be changed , interrupted or reversed. In this sense,
both idioms and proverbs are special and fixed phrases.
One of the major translation problems for students is the translation of special fixed
phrases: idioms, and proverbs in particular The following discussion tackles the problems of
translating them, starting with idioms.
An idiom is a fixed phrase whose form is usually unchangeable, and whose meaning is
always the same, inflexible, metaphorical and indirect. For example, ‘hard task’ can be
translated directly into (اقةbb b ;)مهمة شwhereas ‘tall order’ cannot because it should not be
translated into an unclear ( طويل امbbنظ/ )أمرin Arabic, but into ( اقةbb )مهمة شas a fixed, indirect
meaning. Therefore, the former is not an idiom whereas the latter is.
The discussion of the translation of English idioms into Arabic can be traced through the
following three groups:
1. “Passing the exam is not a bed of roses”: (بالورود ً)النجاح يف االمتحان ليس طريقاً مفروشا
127
2. “A true friend does not stab in the back”: (الظهر )الصديق احلقيقي ال يطعن يف
3. “You scratch my back and I scratch yours: ( ُك ْل وأ ِّكل/إمسكلي واقطعلك/حلكلكّ حكلّي/
أقدح لك ِ
ْ )أض ْئ يل
4. “He killed his neighbour in cold blood”: (دم)قتل جاره بربودة
5. “You make my blood boil by your bad manners”: (إنك جتعل الدم يغلي يف عروقي
)بسلوكك السيئ
6. “It was the straw that broke the camel’s back” (البعري )كانت القشة اليت قصمت ظهر
7. “High prices are a daylight robbery:” ((األسعار الباهظة سرقة يف وضح النهار
8. “Our dear aunt is at death’s door”: ()خالتنا العزيزة على أبواب املوت
9. “They needed the job, so they signed on the dotted line
(بياض كانوا حباجة إىل العمل لذا وقعوا على
10.“She cannot believe her eyes/ears”: (أذنيها/)ال تستطيع أن تصدق عينيها
11.“Their company is on the black list”: ()شركتهم على القائمة السوداء
12.“Why do you wash your dirty linen in public?” : ()ملاذا تنشر غسيلك الوسخ على املأل؟
13. “Some people put the cart before the horse”: ()يضع بعض الناس العربة أمام احلصان
14. “That man is rolling in money”: (الثراء
يتقلب ذاك الرجل يف/)ذاك الرجل يتقلب يف الثراء
15. “people were driven to war like lambs to the slaughter”; (سيق الناس إىل احلرب
()كما تساق النعاج إىل املذبح (املسلخ
16. “They apply the law of the jungle”: ()إهنم يطبقون شريعة الغاب
17. “ladies and gentlemen , lend me your ears”: (شنفوا آذانكم/)سادتي وسيدايت أعريوين انتباهكم
18. “He serves two masters”: (يلعب على احلبلني/)إنه (هو)خيدم سيدين
19. “Let us turn a new page”: ()لنفتح صفحة جديدة
20. “His name was on the tip of my tongue”: ()كان امسه على رأس لساني
Notably, these idioms are translated directly, but should be understood indirectly. That is,
they have metaphorical meanings. Therefore, they are all fixed metaphors, saying something to
mean something else. To illustrate this further, the intended, direct meanings of the previous
examples can be as follows:
128
2. “A true friend does not betray”: (احلقيقي ال خيون
)الصديق
3. “Serve me, so that I serve you”: ()اخدمين ألخدمك
4. “He killed his neighbour intentionally and insensitively”: ()قتل جاره عمداً من دون إحساس
5. “You agitate me": ()إنك تغيظين
6. “It was the light knockout stroke”: ()كانت الضربة اخلفيفة القاضية
7. “High prices are public, legal robbery”: ()األسعار الباهظة سرقة علنية شرعية
8. “Our dear aunt is dying”: (حتتضر/)خالتنا العزيزة متوت
9. “They signed unconditionally”: ()وقعوا من دون شروط
10.“She is astonished”: ()هي (إهنا) مذهولة
1 “Their company should not be dealt with/boycotted”:
( مقاطعةbشركتهم/)ممنوع التعامل مع شركتهم
12.“Why do you make your own secrets open”: (؟ )ملاذا تفشي أسرارك اخلاصة
13.“Some people do things the opposite way”: ()يعكس بعض الناس األمور
14.“That man is very rich”: (ً)ذاك الرجل ثري جدا
15.People were driven by force, unaware of the consequences”:
( دون إدراك للعواقب، ً)سيق الناس قسرا
16.“They apply the law of might is right”: (الضعيف )إهنم يطبقون قانون القوي يأكل
17.“Listen to me carefully”: (ً)أصغوا إيل جيدا
18.“He is a hypocrite”: ()إنه منافق
19.“Let us have a new start”: ()لنبدأ من جديد
20.“I was about to say his name”: ()كنت على وشك نطق امسه
These are direct explanations of the idioms under discussion. However, the students of
translation need to concentrate on translating, not explaining English idioms into Arabic
equivalents. Explanation is acceptable only when translation is not possible for a good reason.
The problem for the students is to have access to the equivalent idiom in Arabic. The
solution is possibly not difficult for two reasons:
1. Such idioms are favourable for the students as well as for some pedantic teachers.
Therefore, their translation is interesting for both of them.
129
2. The idioms of this group have direct, identical equivalents in Arabic. So, if the students
translate them directly, they may get many of them right.
Thus , students can rely on the literal translation of these idioms. However, when such
translation is not understood, funny or quite strange, they should realize that literal translation
is useless, as the idioms of group ‘B’ prove.
130
تنادي( ولكن ال حياة ملن )! إنك ال تُ ِ
سمع األموات/ال حياة ملن تنادي /لقد أمسعت لو ناديت حياً
17.“My brother does not stand a dog’s chance to pass” because he has not studied at all”:
)ليس ألخي وال حىت بصيص أمل يف النجاح/أس فرص للنجاح ،ألنه مل يدرس إطالقاً(
املوظف املرتشي أمس(18.“The bribed clerk was given the sack yesterday”: ) ُطرد/طوي قيدُ /كفت يد
19.“The retired manager of the company received a golden handshake”:
)تلقى مدير الشركة املتقاعد مكافأة ضخمة(تكرمياً عظيماً)(
20.“The soldiers are sitting ducks, since they do not hide behind anything”:
)اجلنود فريسة سهلة (لقمة سائغة/هدف مكشوف)ألهنم ال خيتبؤون خلف أي شيء(
The examples of this group are quite problematic for the students of translation, because
they are entirely indirect and cannot be understood from the literal, common meaning of the
words. The problem will be clearer for the students when these idioms are translated literally
and directly, proving to be wrong, strange, nonsensical and sometimes funny:
131
18.(ًاملوظف املرتشي كيسا )ُأعطي.
19.()تلقى مدير الشركة املتقاعد مصافحة ذهبية.
20.(اجلنود بطات جالسة ألهنم ال خيتبئون...)
These direct translations confirm beyond doubt that the meaning in Arabic is either
unclear, quite strange or unacceptable. Although ( )مبقدوره أن ميشي على املاءcan be understood, the
rest cannot. What is (ثانية ياريت يدbb )س, (bام النخيليةbb )األي, ()كلب يف املعلف, ()أمر طويل, (رديbb )عمل ق, (عمل
)محاري, (ًاb )أعطي كيس, or (افحة ذهبيةbb ?)مصWe usually do not have such idioms in Arabic. On the
other hand, translations like (ا؟bbون أمنbb )هل لك أن تكand (ات جالسةbbود بطbb )اجلنare strange and funny,
whereas (رمية كبرية/)هو قذفة, ()إنه كلب يف املعلف, ()عمل قردي, ( )عمل محاريand ( )فرصة كلبare not only
odd but insulting and, therefore, can be described as dangerous translations.
These translations are simply unacceptable, and students must avoid them completely.
Unfortunately, they resort to them every time they translate such idioms, committing serious,
silly mistakes, as pointed out above.
The solution to the translation of the idioms of Group ‘B’ is to understand them in context
only because they cannot be understood in isolation. That is the reason for having them in full
sentences. If the context does not help, literal translation of words can be suggested on the
condition that it is clearly understood. If not, it must be wrong, and the students have to resort
to a special English-English (monolingual) or an English-Arabic (bilingual) dictionary of
idioms, or to any other reference to help them.
In all cases, students must be careful at attempting direct translation of any idiom. Yet,
they can use it as a tester of wrong/right translation. That is, if it is understood as a possible,
used phrase in Arabic, it can be right; otherwise, it is likely to be wrong. Having said that,
experience shows that student are fond of idioms, probably for their strangeness, and some
teachers concentrate on them in an unusual way as ‘a show of muscles’. Therefore, they may
not find them as problematic as some might think.
Phrasal verbs are well-established, extremely popular idioms. As explained earlier (see
2.3.), a phrasal verb is a combination of a verb+an adverb/preposition, or both an adverb and a
preposition (such as: ‘up, down, on, off, in, out, over’, etc). It has a special, idiomatic meaning
that cannot be understood from the individual meaning of the verb and the adverb/preposition
taken together.
132
The students face a big problem at translating English phrasal verbs into Arabic, because
they are misleading and usually confused with prepositional verbs (i.e. a verb+a preposition)
which are not idiomatic and retain their normal, dire ct meaning. The criterion for
distinguishing between the two types of verb is to apply direct translation to
both of them to find out if meaning is altered. e.g.
1. “Please, put the book on the table”: ()من فضلك ضع الكتاب على الطاولة
2. “Please , put your coat on”: ()من فضلك ضع معطفك على
Clearly, (1) is possible and understood, whereas (2) is not because it is broken,
ungrammatical and something is missing after the preposition ‘on’ ( )على. So, the former is a
prepositional verb, but the latter is a phrasal verb that has a special, idiomatic, different
meaning (i.e. wear/dress ( )يلبسthat has no relation to the former, although both are ‘put on’
each.
Let us focus now on the translation of phrasal verbs, starting with giving examples under
group ‘C’:
1. “You always argue back every time I say something”: (ًأقول شيئا )أنت دائماً تعارض كلما
2. “When the guests come, ask them up, please”:
( لو مسحت، قل هلم أن يصعدوا إىل األعلى،الضيوف )حينما يأيت
3. “The mother barked out when her child had fallen down”:
(صرخة أمل عندما سقط طفلها/)صرخت األم بشدة
4. “Stop beating about the bush !” : (اللف والدوران )توقف عن
5. “Please, do not break in while I am talking”: ()من فضلك ال تقاطعين أثناء كالمي
6. “Try to bring the others around to your opinion”: ()حاول أن تقنع اآلخرين برأيك
7. “You are welcome any time you call in”: ()أهالً بك يف أي وقت تزورين
8. “We are obliged to carry out our promise”: ()حنن ملزومون بتنفيذ وعدنا
9. “Come forward, gentleman”: ()تقدم أيها الشاب
10.“The boy does not like his sister . She always digs at him”:
(ً إهنا تنهره دائما.)ال حيب الولد أخته
11.“My uncle found out that his illness was serious” : (خطري )اكتشف عمي أن مرضه
12.“What time do you usually get up in the morning ?”
(الصباح؟ ساعة عادة تنهض يف/)يف أي وقت
13.“My friend always says that he will give up smoking”:
133
(التدخني
)يقول صديقي دائماً إنه سوف يقلع عن
14.“Do not stop talking. Go on, please”: ( تابع لو مسحت.)ال تتوقف عن الكالم
15.“The defender played the ball back to the goal keeper”: ()أعاد املدافع الكرة حلارس املرمى
16.“I do not have enough time to read the book through”:
()ليس عندي الوقت الكايف ألدرس الكتاب بتمعن
17.“Will you see us to the door , we do not know the way”:
( إننا ال نعرف الطريق،)هلاّ رافقتنا إىل الباب
18.“Nobody spoke against the suggestion”: (االقرتاح )مل يعارض أحد
19.“Please, stand aside, the lady would like to enter”:
( فالسيدة تود أن تدخل، أفسح الطريق، )من فضلك
20.“The plane takes off at 9 O’clock a.m.”: (ً صباحا9 )تقلع الطائرة عند الساعة
21.“We try our best not to write any student off the final exam”:
()حناول جهدنا أال نستبعد أي طالب من االمتحان النهائي
22.“They will be on with the lectures very soon” (ًقريباً جدا )سوف يبدؤون احملاضرات
23.“You are lying ! Come down to brass tacks”:
(حقائق جوهرية/ حتدث عن حقائق األمور.تكذب )أنت
24.“Mary always likes to get in on preparing food”:
()حتب ماري دائماً أن تشارك يف إعداد الطعام
25.“Some people are unkind. Yet we can put up with them”:
( ومع ذلك ميكننا أن نتسامح معهم.)الناس غري لطفاء (غري ظرفاء )بعض
The meanings of English phrasal verbs are mostly unpredictable and unfamiliar to
students. Yet, the preposition ‘on’ implies the idea of doing something over a period of time
continuously when it combines with verbs (e.g. go on=continue; carry on=continue; drive
on=continue driving, etc. ). In a similar way, the adverb ‘off’ suggests the notion of finishing,
leaving or disposing of something (e.g. get off=leave; call off=cancel; take off=undress; etc).
Similar to ‘off’ is the adverb ‘away’ which usually means dispose, or take
something/somebody far from something/somebody (e.g. go away=leave; throw away=dispose
of; wipe away=remove; etc). The adverb ‘up’ can also have a general meaning of doing or
finishing something quickly and completely (e.g. drink up=drink completely and at one time;
eat up=finish eating, etc). (See also Carter, 1987: Chs. 3&6)
However, this does not lead to the conclusion that some adverbs and prepositions have
fixed, general meanings when combining with any verb, because of three reasons:
134
1. The combinations of the same preposition/adverb with different verbs may result in
different meanings: e.g.
2. The same combination of a preposition/adverb and a verb can have different meanings. e.g
‘COME OFF’:
135
‘LEAVE’: -go away
-get offLout
ㅅ -go out (غادِر/)يغادر
ㅇ -push off
ㅈ -buzz off
‘INVITE’: -ask in
ㅊ -ask over
ㅋ -ask to ()يدعو
ㅌ -ask up
‘VISIT’: -call at
-call by
ㅍ -call in
ㅎ -call into ()يزور
ㄱ -call on
ㄴ -call upon
ㄷ -go on(a visit)
What is the solution, then? It is by no means not possible for students to know the
meanings of all English phrasal verbs, nor all the combinations of the same verb, especially
common verbs like ‘come’, 'get', ‘drink’, ‘go’, ‘see’, 'set', ‘take’, etc. For example ‘take’ has
over three hundred meanings. ‘Come to’ has forty five entries of main meanings (see Longman
Dictionary of Phrasal Verbs, 1983). Nevertheless, they are able to know and memorize the
most important combinations of the common, widely used phrasal verbs (some examples are
provided above from 1–25). This is similar to irregular verbs; the students need to memorize
only the commonest, most important irregular verbs such as ‘bring’, ‘come’, ‘drink’, ‘eat’,
‘go’, ‘have’, ‘run’, ‘put’, ‘see’, ‘take’, ‘think’, ‘write’,above etc.
Moreover, students can concentrate on the main, core combination(s) of each of these
common phrasal verbs. For example, ‘come’ has about sixty eight phrasal combinations. The
commonest ones are seven. Here they are with their commonest meanings only:‘come to’ (يصل
‘)إىلcome in’ (‘ ;)يدخلcome across’ (‘ ;)يصادفcome on’ (هيا/يتقدم/‘ ;)تقدمcome off’ (‘ ;)يسقطcome
out’ (ربزbb ;)يand ‘come through” ( ًاملاbb b)خيرج س. Each of these combinations has a number of
meanings. At the same time it has a core, commonly used meaning (which is the one
mentioned here). Students can satisfy themselves with these common phrasal combinations of
136
‘come’, and with their core meanings only. This is hopefully possible for the students of
translation. After all, phrasal verbs have entries in good dictionaries now, and are assigned
special dictionaries (see above, op.cit.).
In fine, idioms are fixed phrases that need extra care from the students of translation.
Generally speaking, direct translation is dangerous here, and the students must consider the
context carefully and check the idiom in a good bilingual, or monolingual dictionary. The
teacher can also be a good guide to them.
2 5 2 Translation of PROVERBS:
Like idioms, proverbs are special, fixed, unchanged phrases which have special, fixed,
unchanged meanings. A proverb cannot be translated or understood as a collection of the
individual meanings of its words. Moreover, proverbs are metaphors that stand for something
else. Beside that, they are culture-specific. Therefore, they should not be translated or
understood directly.
The problems of translating English proverbs into Arabic and the suggested solutions to
them are discussed in detail through the following three main groups.
137
14.“Like mother like daughter”: ()البنت ألمها(عامية اقلب اجلرة على فمها تطلع/البنت طالعة ألمها
15.“No smoke without fire”: ()ال دخان من دون نار
The examples of this group are the easiest for students to translate, because most of them
can be translated directly. However, the problem remains for the students to know the full form
of the proverb in Arabic. The solution is not hard to attain anyway, for they are usually
fascinated by proverbs in both languages and know some of them beforehand. With the help of
an authority and the consultation of specialist references -which are available now - they can
find the solution to the problem of translating identical proverbs. Even with the students’
ignorance of the proverb altogether, they may recall it in Arabic at hearing one or two words of
it. Classroom tests can easily confirm this.
In all cases, when unable to guess the proverb in question, the students resort to
translating its meaning into ordinary language. For example, if they are unaware of the
corresponding Arabic proverb for: ‘like father like son’, they can translate it into ( بهbb االبن يش
الولد مثل أبيه/)األب, or into a colloquial version as above, which is usually avoided in standard
language translation.
On the other hand, there are more than one Arabic version for some English proverbs, all
of which are equally acceptable in general terms: e.g.
(1) “Like father like son”(1-4 are adopted from Al-Munjed Fi-L Aalam, 1987: 29th edn):
1.()من شابه (أشبهَ) أباه ما ظلم
2.((األسد)إن )هذا الشبل من ذاك
3.()الولد صورة من أبيه
4.()هذا الكعك من ذاك العجني
5.(عوام
ّ )فرخ البط
It should be pointed out that these synonymous versions of the same proverb would be
understood in a general context of synonymy, for there are significant stylistic differences
among them(e.g. colloquial(5)/formal(1-4); more agreeable(1-3)/less agreeable (4-5); more
positive(1-3)/less positive(4-5); more sublime(1-2)/less sublime (3-5); etc.). Moreover,
applying a back-translation test to these translations may produce slightly different versions in
English. Yet, the general meaning is retained in all cases.
138
املرء خبليله3.b
قرينه4.
وسل عن
تسل ْ
عن املرء ال ْ
الصاحب ساحب5.
Group “B”: Similar equivalence: e.g.
1. “Forbidden fruit is sweet”: مرغوب( )َأَحب شيء إىل اإلنسان ما ُمنعا/كل ممنوع
Literally : )الثمرة املمنوعة bحلوة(
2. “Blood is thicker than water”: الدم ال يصري ماء/الظفر ما يطلع من اللحم(عا)/ما حك(
جلدك مثل ظفرك )
Literally : املاء(
)الدم أمسك من
3. “A bird in hand is worth two in the bush”: )عصفور يف اليد خري من عشرة على الشجرة(
Literally : )طائر يف اليد خري من اثنني يف الشجرة(
4. “Birds of a feather flock together”: )إن الطيور على أشكاهلا تقع(
Literally: )الطري ذات الريش نفسه جتتمع سوية(b
5. “Two minds are better than one”: )رأيان خري من رأي واحد/املرء قليل بنفسه كثري بإخوانه(
Literally : )عقالن خري من عقل واحد(
6. “To make a dome out of a molehill”: يعمل من احلبة قبة(ومن البذرة شجرة)(
Literally: )يعمل من تلة اخللد قبة(
7. “A friend in need is a friend indeed”: )الصديق وقت الضيق(
Literally: )الصديق وقت احلاجة هو الصديق احلقيقي(
8. “Better to be safe than sorry”: )السالمة وال الندامة(
Literally : )من األفضل أن تكون ساملاً من أن تكون آسفاً(
9. “Diamond cut diamond”: )ال يفل احلديد إال احلديد/وداوها باليت هي الداء(
Literally: )األملاس يقطع األملاس(
10.“Familiarity breeds contempt”: )األلفة تولد الكره/األنس يُذهب املهابة(
Literally: )األلفة تولد االحتقار(
)ال يأس مع احلياة/ال حياة من دون أمل/إن مع العسر يسرا( 11.“where there is life there is hope”:
Literally: )حيث توجد احلياة يوجد األمل(
139
12.“charity begins at home”: (باملعروف )األقربون أوىل
Literally: ()تبدأ الصدقة يف البيت
13.“Poverty is no sin”: (ً)الفقر ليس عيبا
Literally: ()الفقر ليس خطيئة
14.“Let bygones be bygones”: (ما فات مات/)عفا اهلل عما سلف
Literally: ()دع أحداث املاضي أحداثاً ماضية
15.“A fox is not taken twice in the same snare”: ( املؤمن من جحر مرتنيb))ال ُيلدغ(اليُلسع
Literally: (مرتني )ال يوقَع الثعلب يف الشرك نفسه
The proverbs of this group are harder to translate than those of the first one .Yet, this does
not mean that they are very difficult to translate. Presumably the knowledge of a part of the
proverb in Arabic is enough for students to guess it in full. When it is not possible for them to
find a proper version of a proverb for one reason or another, they can translate its sense: e.g.
1. To show the similarities and the differences between each pair in both English and
Arabic.
2. To point out the possibility or the strangeness of the Arabic literal versions of English
proverbs. For example, ‘12’ is strange and unclear if translated directly into:
()تبدأ الصدقة يف البيت.
1.“To lock the stable door after the horse has bolted out”:
(ال ينفع الرتياق إذا بلغت الروح الرتاقي/)سبق السيف الع َذل
Literally: (احلصان )يقفل باب اإلسطبل بعد أن هرب
2.“A stitch in time saves nine”:
140
وقوعه/تدار ِك األمر قبل أن تقع الفاس يف
الراس(عا)( َ
ِ
استدرك اخلطر قبل إن دواء الشق أن حتوصه(ترتقه)/
Literally : )درزة يف وقت توفر تسعاً(
3. “One man’s meat is another man’s poison”: )مصائب قوم عند قوم فوائد(
Literally: )حلمة زيد قد تكون سُماً لعمرو(
4. “The grass is greener on the other side
of the hill/fence”: طرب(
احلي ال ُي ِ )النيب يف غري أهله كرمي /مزمار
Literally: )العشب أكثر خضرة يف اجلانب اآلخر للتلة/للسياج(
5. “Love me love my dog”: مداين( ناقتها بعريي/ألجل مدينة تكرم
حب َ وَي ُ /وأحبها وتُحبين
)كرماً لعني تكرم مرجعيون
Literally: َحب كليب(
فأ َّ أحَّبين وأحبَّ كليب/إذا كنت حتبين
) ِ
6. “Enough is as good as a feast”: )القناعة كنز ال يفىن/القناعة غىن(
Literally : ) َمثَل االكتفاء َمثَل الوليمة(
7. “He who pays the piper calls the tune”: )القرش يُلَعب القرد(
Literally : )من يدفع لعازف الناي يحدد اللحن(
8. “To separate the grain (wheat)from the chaff”:
من الطيب /مييز الغث من السمني/مييز الصاحل من الطاحل( )َيميز اخلبيث
Literally: )يفصل احلب (القمح)عن القش(
9. “Half a loaf is better than no bread”: )الرمد خري من العمى(
Literally: خبز( )نصف رغيف خري من ال
10.“To add insult to injury”: الطني بلة( )يزيد
Literally : إصابة( )يضيف إهانة إىل
11.“Don’t count your chickens before they’re hatched”:
تقل فول حىت يصبح يف املكيول(عا)(/ال تقل عنب حىت( لكل مقام مقال/لكل حادث حديث /ال
)يصري يف السلة(عا)/ال تقل كمون حىت تصر عليه(عا)
Literally: أن تفقس( )ال تعَُّد فراخك قبل
12.“A leopard never changes its spots”:
شبَّ على شيء شاب عليه /ذنب الكلب أعوج( )الطبع يغلب التطبع/من
Literally: أبداً( )ال يغري الفهد بقعه
13.“Beauty is in the eyes of the beholder”:
141
ِ وي
(صم حبك للشيء يعمي/سن يف كل عني ما تود
ٌ ح/
َ ))القرد بعني أمه غزال(عا
ُ
Literally: ()اجلمال يف عيين ناظره
14.“Between Scylla and Charybdis”:
(بني نارين/مر
ّ أمران أحالمها/بالنار
)كاملستجري من الرمضاء
Literally: (b)بني الوحشني األسطورين سيالً وشاربديس
15.“Like a bull in a china shop”: ٍ )أخرق من
()من ناطح الصخر(املاء/أمحق من نعامة/ناكثة غزهلا
Literally: (من اخلزف )مثل ثور يف حانوت آنية
16.“When in Rome, do as the Romans do”
(أربعني يوماً صار منهم من عاشر القوم/)إذا كنت يف قوم فاحلب يف إنائهم
Literally:()إذا كنت يف روما فافعل كما يفعل أهلها
17.“All roads lead to Rome”( كل الدروب إىل الطاحون/)كل الطرق تؤدي إىل مكة
Literally: ()كل الطرق تؤدي إىل روما
This group is the greatest in number in both languages. Moreover, it is the most difficult to
translate because its proverbs have no straightforward, literal relation to their equivalents in
Arabic. The literal translations given for the above examples confirm this. That is, if we follow
them, we will not understand the original.
Therefore, the problem here is not easy to overcome. However, a solution of some kind
should be suggested by:
(1) consulting good specialist monolingual as well as bilingual references (e.g. A Dictionary of
Proverbs: English-Arabic, 1991; Al-Mounged English-Arabic Dictionary, 1986; Al-Mawrid
Dictionary: English-Arabic);
(2) consulting an authority;
(3) resorting to colloquial Arabic (as in 7, 11, and 15 in particular):
(4) or, as a last resort, translating the sense( or intended meaning of the proverb) with extra
care and full concentration.
Literal translation is not advisable in any way and should be avoided by all means because
it is harmful, not understood and might distort meaning.
It is worth noting again that some English proverbs have more than one Arabic equivalent
(e.g. 2, 8, 11, 14 ). Likewise, the same English proverb may have another version. For
example, ‘2’, ‘10’ and ‘11’ can be rendered in two different ways:
“Prevention is better than cure”: (قنطار عالج درهم وقاية خري من/)الوقاية خري من العالج
142
“To add fuel to the fire”:(النار يصب الزيت علىb/)يزيد الطني بلة
“Do not cross the bridge before you come to it”:
( حلوb)كل شيء بأوانه(بوقته/مقام مقال لكل/))لكل حادث حديث
It remains to say that idioms and proverbs are a part of figurative language. They are not
meant to be taken literally and directly, but non-literally and indirectly. More details about
figurative language are provided in the next section about the translation of metaphors.
143
2.6. FIGURATIVE LANGUAGE: Translation of METAPHORS:
Introduction:
In ‘1’, language is clear and direct, describing a person as ‘cunning’ ( اكرbb )مin a
straightforward way, whereas ‘2’ is figurative language because it describes the same person in
an indirect way as a ‘fox’ ( )ثعلب. Of course , it goes without saying that the said person is not
the animal ‘fox’, but he is cunning ( )ماكر, for the fox is famous for being cunning. Thus, both
examples say the same thing, but in two different ways and two different types of language.
In translation, we have to take this difference between the two language types into
consideration, because they are not the same. That is, direct language is:
Thus, although ‘cunning’ and ‘fox’ have the same meaning, they cannot be translated into
the same word ( )ماكرin Arabic, but into two words: ( )ماكرand ()ثعلب.
144
1. Simile ()تشبيه
2. Metaphor ()استعارة
3. Pun ()تورية
4 .Metonymy ()كناية
5. Personification ()تشخيص
6. Word play (باأللفاظ
)تالعب
7. Irony (سخرية/)هتكم
etc.
The most popular, recurrent and comprehensive figure is the metaphor. It covers most of
these figures, which is why figurative language is also called metaphorical language, and
discussed in translation books under the translation of ‘METAPHOR’. Therefore, the
concentration in the following pages is on the translation of metaphors, which stands as an
equivalent to the translation of figurative language in general.
Translation of METAPHORS:
As demonstated in the previous section, idioms (including phrasal verbs) and proverbs are
all in all metaphorical. Added to them are metaphors of different types, which are sometimes
quite problematic for students. Therefore, the discussion of their translation is useful to them.
But first, what is a ‘metaphor’? and what are its components?
1. What is a “metaphor”?:
2. Components of a metaphor:
Each metaphor has the following components (the metaphor ‘sunny smile’ is cited as an
example):
a.) Image (به ;)املشبهthe source of the metaphor (i.e. the ‘sun’).
b.) Object ()املشبه: the idea, thing, or person described (i.e. ‘smile’).
145
c.) Sense (الشبه )وجه: the direct meaning of the metaphor (i.e. the brilliance of the
smile which resembles the brilliance of the shining sun).
d.) Metaphor ()االستعارة: The figurative word used in the expression (i.e. sunny).
These components are inseparable in practice. Yet, the first step in the translation of the
metaphor for the students is to be able to distinguish these components. That ability facilitates
their understanding, analysing and, hence, translating of metaphors in general.
3. Types of Metaphor:
Metaphors are different kinds. They are all discussed below in detail with regard to the
problems of translating them, and the solutions put forward for them.They are adopted from
Newmark (1988: ch. 10).
(Plenty of examples can be found in both languages). Usually, the problem of translating
dead metaphors is not difficult to solve. They are close to direct language for the students, and
146
may be translated unconsciously by them as such, especially when they can find equivalent
dead metaphors in Arabic, as the above examples confirm:
1.hands →(اربbb ;)عق2.field →( ;)حقل3.foot →( ;)ذيل4.chain →(لةbb b ;)سلس5.series →(;)مسلسل
6.hand→( ;)جهة7.hand→( العونbيد/ ;)يد8.warm→( ;)حار9.lukewarme →( ;)فاتر10.kill → ()يقتل.
In case the students have no knowledge of the exact equivalent in Arabic, the solution
becomes more difficult with those dead metaphors which resist literal translation in particular.
For example, although we say in Arabic( ال( ;)حقل معرفةbbلة جبbbداث( ;)سلسbbدك( ;)مسلسل أحbb( ;)أعطين ي
اترbb تقبال فbb )اسand (وقتbb ( )يقتل ال2,4,5,7,9,10 respectively), we cannot say: (اعةbb دي السbb دم( ;)أيbb ق
فحةbbرى( ;)الصbb على اليد األخ... ;)على اليد األوىلor (تقبال دافئbb( )اس1,3,6,8 successively). Unfortunately,
some students commit silly mistakes by applying such translations to these metaphors. They
are advised to dispose of such funny, inaccurate versions. Instead, they have to try their best to
find the Arabic equivalent which is not hard to find.
Furthermore, these metaphors can be sensed by realizing the normal, direct contexts of the
metaphor-word in each example. That is, usually the words ‘hand’, ‘foot’, and ‘kill’ are used
with people or animals only, not with things; whereas ‘chains’ and ‘series’ are used with the
metal ‘iron’; ‘field’ with land and agriculture; ‘warm’ and ‘lukewarm’ with water and
temperature (of water and the weather in particular). This applies to the equivalent words in
Arabic:
(( )عقاربscorpions) is normally not used with ‘clock’; nor (( )ذيلtail) with ‘page’; ()يد,
()يقتل, ( )حارand ( )فاترare used in contexts similar to their English counterparts.
147
Like dead metaphors, cliché metaphors usually have Arabic equivalents, as the examples
show. Yet, sometimes the case is not exactly so for the English metaphors may not have
equivalent ones in the TL, as the following examples illustrate:
1. “I always carry the can!”: ()كاهلي دائماً تقع املسؤولية على عاتقي(على/b! املسؤوليةb)أنا دائماً أحتمل
2. “The heart of the matter is that you are a failure!()جوهر األمر(هو) أنك فاشل
3. “Please, give us a piece of your mind”: ()من فضلك أعطنا رأيك الصريح
4. “Catch the thief by hook or by crook”: (ًحياً أو ميتا/))اقبضوا على اللص بأي وسيلة كانت
5. “The soldiers stood to their guns”: (صمد اجلنود يف امليدان/)ثبت
(The second translation of the first example is metaphorical)
The English metaphors are translated into ordinary, direct Arabic words as follows:
1. “can” (literally: )وعاء → ()مسؤولية
2. “the heart of the matter” (literally: (→ قلب األمر
)(جوهر
3. “piece of mind” (literally:من العقل→ )قطعة (صريح )رأي
4. “hook or crook” (Literally: → )كُالّب أو خطاف (( كانتbأي وسيلة
5. “stand to guns” (Literally: → ) )يقف إىل سالحه (يصمد يف امليدان/)يثبت
The best translation is possibly to translate a metaphor into a metaphor, or else the sense.
The students have always to beware of the literal translations of cliché metaphors because they
may result in funny expressions in Arabic. Here are the full word-for-word translations of these
five examples, which illustrate the point:
These are funny, strange or unclear Arabic statements to say the least. Therefore, they are
unacceptable, and students should avoid them completely.
148
3. Standard Metaphors (معيارية )استعارات:
These are the most established metaphors in language. They are mostly formal, respected
and frequently used in standard language in particular. e. g.
These metaphors are a collection of proverbs (3,8,9); formal metaphors (1,2,7); informal
sayings (5,6) and collocations (4,10). Mostly, they have Arabic equivalents. However, some
may not and are translated into direct, non-metaphorical language (such as the first versions of
6&9). Direct translation sometimes works (e.g. 4 and 10) in particular, sometimes it does not:
e.g. We do not say:
(1. (أمل
عاعbb b )ش، اةbb b b دي تلك الفتbb b b (ترت.5 ،)اء يغليbb b b (أبق على الوع.3 ،)وء علىbb b b رمي الضbb b b (ي.2
) (ذاك البناء الشاهق فيل أبيض.9 ،) (يوسع اخلليج بينهما.7 ،))البنطال
Having said that, although ‘6’ and ‘8’ are usually not translated directly, the students
may try literal translations when they do not have a better solution: ‘6’ as ( ;)إنه زوج منقورand
‘8’ as ( إليهم انضم،)إن مل تستطع أن هتزمهم. Although ‘6’ is strange, it is expressive, understood and
has the sense of humour of the English original.
149
If the problem sustains, the students may resort cautiously to informal expressions, as in
‘5’ and ‘8’ in particular (especially the Syrian ( )حسن صيب, the Saudi ( )حامد ولدand the Libyan (
)عيشة راجل. However, standard expressions are the rule, whereas informal ones are the
exception in translation (and these three versions are among the exceptions for their extreme
acceptability, expressivity and humorous nature like that of the English original), especially at
this stage (for further details about formal and informal language, see Chapter 3 below).
Direct translation is usually the case here. Yet, the students must be careful to understand
words in their proper sense. For example, ‘court’ may be translated by many students into(
)حمكمة, instead of ()ملعب, taking it to be a monosemous word. In fact, ‘court’ is a polysemous
word that has more than one meaning. Here, it is ()ملعب, taken from ‘tennis court’ (تنس )ملعب.
By the way, this metaphor means that it is their turn to take action. The second version of ‘2’, (ف
دb )ِّرق ت ُسis identical with the translation suggested for the well-established English saying;
‘divide and rule’, for both have the same implication of division(فرقة/قاقbb )ش, but the latter is
non-metaphorical, whereas the former is a good metaphor. Both, however , are borrowed and
adapted from English.
The metaphors which belong to the English specific culture are called cultural metaphors.
The following examples are taken from the English cultural game of ‘cricket’ ()الكريكت.
1. “To field a question”: (البحث يطرح مسألة على بساط/)يعاجل مسألة
150
2. “To keep a straight bat”: (شريف/ًطريقاً شريفا )يسلك
3. “To knock for six”: (bيذهل/)يبهر
4. “This is not fair play”: (bً)هذا ليس عدال
5. “He stirs his stumps”: (ينشط/تدب احليوية فيه/)جيري الدم يف عروقه
The metaphor-words are underlined. These are special terms used in the originally British
game of cricket and are understood fully by the English people only for they are a part of their
culture. They create a tremendous problem in the translation of metaphors because they cannot
be translated or understood directly by foreign students in particular. Their meanings are
culture-specific and have no relation to their individual words. Even some bilingual
dictionaries do not have entries for them.
In fact, they are puns, rather than metaphors, meant to have meaning beyond their
individual words taken together.
The only possible solution a vailable for students who know little about the English
culture, is to consult specialist dictionaries such as English idioms dictionaries, or good general
monolingual dictionaries like Collins, Oxford, Longman, Chambers’ Twentieth Century, and
Webster’s English language Dictionaries. Fortunately for them, cultural metaphors are not
many, except in cultural texts.
These metaphors are neologisms (or new words) in English and may, therefore, be
translated directly even when they are unclear (like ‘3’ ( رؤوسbb يد الbb )صto retain their images.
However, they can be translated into their direct meanings as follows:
151
1.(اخلشب لغة/كالم فارغ/)لغة روتينية
2.()وضوح
3.(من اخلصوم )التخلص
4.(ال درهم معه وال دينار/)إنه مفلس
5.(مطارد للنساء/)مزواج
Although these translations are explanations rather than translations, and the images of
the original have disappeared, they are acceptable as a solution of some kind to the problem
of translating such recent, sometimes unclear metaphors into their sense. On the other hand,
these metaphors are recent in English, yet their translations into Arabic can sometimes be
into long-established metaphors(cf. 4&5).
These are perhaps the best type of metaphors and at the same time and unexpectedly the
easiest to translate. That is, they can be translated directly so that they seem surprising in
Arabic as they are in English. Original metaphors are not only newly created for the first time,
and not heard of before, but also surprising, sublime and respectful, especially in literature and
political speeches. e.g. (The metaphor-words are underlined):
152
(The examples from ‘4’ to ‘10’ are taken from the poem, Fern Hill: ( ري ْنbb )تلة فby the
Twentieth century English poet Dylan Thomas. The first three examples are from political
speeches, quoted in Newmark, 1988: 112-13 ). Arabic translations have retained the same
images of the original, which is quite feasible and permissible because the unusual, astonishing
and unexpected metaphorical combinations of English have been equally matched in Arabic by
unusual, astonishing.and unexpected metaphors. When failing to render the English metaphors,
students can give their sense:e.g.
As regards the first question, the distinction between the types of metaphor can be made
according to the following criteria:
1. Frequency and informality indicate dead or cliché metaphors.
2. The use of the parts of the body (like: ‘hand, head, face, shoulder, mouth, foot,
etc.');.terms of space, time and environment (e.g. field, top, bottom, time, space,
etc. ), is indicative of dead metaphors in particular.
3. A borrowed , or a foreign word reflects an adapted metaphor.
4. A cultural term occurs in a cultural metaphor.
5. A new word suggests a recent metaphor.
6. An astonishing, unusual, and unexpected image is an original metaphor.
Having said that, although the distinction is important, it is not crucial to translation when
the students cannot make it. The essential point for them is to render the meaning of the
metaphor in one way or another.
With regard to the third question, each type of metaphor can be translated into the same
equivalent type in Arabic, only when possible. Otherwise, it is unimportant to translate English
metaphors into Arabic in this strict way.
153
The following is a summary of the translation procedures of the metaphors, given in order
of preference:
1. Look for an Arabic equivalent for the English metaphors, regardless of whether it is a
metaphor or not: e.g.
ii “By hook or (by) crook”: (كانت )بأي وسيلة. It is not a metaphor in Arabic.
iii “Big shot”: ()رجل عظيم الشأن. It is not a metaphor in Arabic either.
i. “He is a henpecked husband”: ((تسيطر عليه) زوجته تتحكم به/)إنه زوج مقهور
ii. “A window of opportunity”: ()كبرية/فرصة (ساحنة
In any case, direct translation here is the translation of the meaning we understand from
any metaphorical expression, not of the meaning of its individual words in isolation.
Finally, metaphors are the beautiful, enjoyable and lively part of language. Therefore,
students are advised to remember that the best translation of a metaphor is to translate it into an
equivalent one in Arabic when available, so that it matches the English original in this respect
154
as well. More importantly, the point of focus in the translation of any type of metaphor is to
convey its proper meaning into Arabic, whether metaphorical or not.
Introduction:
Arabic is one of the oldest and the most highly organized languages in the world. With
its preserver and protector, the Holy Quran(رميbbرآن الكbb )القalongside the Prophet's Tradition(
bنة النبويةbb )الس, it has continued to survive and revive over time, resisting all pressures by
different cultures and nations. Its linguistic potentials are great and flexible enough to
embrace new terms of any type, including technical/scientific terms, especially in the new
Millennium and age of technology and sunshine industries. Therefore, and since it is the
native language of the Arab Nation, and the second language of hundreds of millions of
Muslims all over the world, its new foreign terminology requires to be urgently focused on
and extended daily, with the aim to meet the urgent demands for Arabic technical terms in
particular. Hence this section on technical translation: Arabization.
155
The translation of technical terms will be tackled through the discussion of the
methods of Arabization in an ascending order, from the poorest to the best.
Methods of Arabization:
These words increase in number by the day in Arabic, because of the daily invasion of
foreign technology, scientific knowledge and discoveries of the Arab Countries and, hence,
Arabic Language.
156
1 When the foreign term has is yet to be given an acceptable Arabic equivalent (e.g. فيتامني
). In such a case, it can be used provisionally until a recognized Arabic term is suggested.
This is what should have happened to terms like; ( b،يتbb كاس،ونbb تلف،وbb رادي،ونbb تلفزي،بيوترbb كم،كbbبن
موبايل أنيميا،رتنتbb إن،اكسbb ف،اbb بكرتي،ريوسbb ف،اتياليتbb س،ونbb ميكروف،ينماbb س، فيلم،ديوbbفي،). They have the
following standardized Arabic equivalents:
1. Bank ()مصرف
2. Computer (حسوب/آيل عقل/حاسوب/)حاسب آيل
3. Television (تلفزة/تلفاز/صغرية
شاشة/)إذاعة مرئية
4. Radio (إذاعة مسموعة/)مذياع
5. Telephone ()هاتف
6. Cassette (شريط/)شريط تسجيل
7. Video ())جهاز عرض (وتسجيل
8. Film ()شريط مرئي
9. Cinema (دار عرض/)خيالة
10.Microphone (ناقل صوت/صوت )مكرب
11.Satellite ()قمر اصطناعي(صناعي
12.Virus ()جرثومة ُمعدية
13.Bacteria ()جراثيم
14.Fax (براق/مصور
ّ بريد/)ناسوخ
15.Anemia ()فقر دم
16.Internet ()شبكة املعلومات
17.Mobile (املتحرك/ اخلِْليَوي، احملمول، النقال،)اجلوال
18.Pager ()النداء
There are two main reasons for taking up this method of Arabization :
1. The translators' laziness to exert any effort to search for an Arabic term of some kind
to translate the meaning of the foreign term into Arabic.
2. The easiness of transcription which is merely the transference of Latin letters into
Arabic letters.
157
The problem worsens when ordinary words are transcribed, even though they have
well-established, age-old equivalents in Arabic: e.g.
This reflects the serious influence of English in particular, and foreign terms in
general on Arabic language users. But this is no good reason for overusing this method,
which remains unacceptable by all standards, and the exceptions made for using it are
transitional until standardized Arabized terms are suggested formally.
2. Naturalization ()التطبيع:
1. Technology ()تكنولوجيا
1. Technological (adj.) (تكنولوجيّة/ّ)تكنولوجي
2. Technologist (n.) ()تكنولوجيّة(متخصصة/)التكنولوجيا
تكنولوجي (متخصص يف
ّ
3. Technologists (n./plural) (تكنولوجيات-)تكنولوجيون
4. Technologies(n./plural) ()تكنولوجيات
5. Technologically (adv.) (ً)تكنولوجيا
2. Magnet(n.) ()مغناطيس
158
1. Magnetic (adj.) (مغناطيسية/)مغناطيسي
2. Magnetism/magnetization(n.) ()مغنطة
3. Magnetize(v.) ()ميغنط
3. Oxide(n.) ()أكسيد
1. Oxidate/oxidize(v.) (b)يؤكسد
2. Oxidation/oxidization(n.) (تأكسد/)أكسدة
3. Oxidant/oxidizer(n.) ِ )
(مؤكسد
4. Oxidated/oxidized(adj.) (مؤكسد
َ )
4. Hydrogen (n.) ()هيدروجني
1. Hydrogenate/hydrogenize(v.) ()ُيَهْدرِج
2. Hydrogenation/hydrogenization(n.) ()هدرجة
3. Hydrogenator(n) ()مهدرِج
4. Hydrogenated(adj.) (مهدرج
َ )
5. Biology ()بيولوجيا
1. Biological(adj.) (بيولوجيّة/)بيولوجي
2. Biologist (n.) (بيولوجيّة-)البيولوجيا
)بيولوجي(متخصص يف
3. Biologists (n./plural) بيولوجيات) –(بيولوجيون
4. Biologically (adv.) (ً)بيولوجيّا
6. Mechanics (ميكانيكا/)ميكانيك
1. Mechanism(n.) ()ميكانيكية
2. Mechanisms(n.) (plural) ()ميكانيكيات
3. Mechanical (adj.) ((ميكانيكيي
ميكانيكية/
(e.g. mechanical engineering) ( هندسة ميكانيكية:)مثال
4. Mechanic(n.) (ميكانيكية/))ميكانيكي(متخصص يف ميكانيك
159
5. Mechanize(v.) (ميكِنن
ْ )
6. Mechanization(n.)()مكننة
7. Mechanically(adv.) (ميكانيكيا
ً )
7. Topography ()طبوغرافيا
1. Topographic (adj.) (طبوغرافية/)طبوغرايف
2. Topographer(n.) (طبوغرافية/)الطبوغرافيا)طبوغرايف (متخصص يف
3. Topographers(pl.) طبوغرافيات)–(طبوغرافيون
4. Topographically (adv.) (ً)طبوغرافيا
The Arabic naturalized terms are inflected according to Arabic grammar with regard to
nouns, adjectives, verbs, adverbs, singular, plural, masculine and feminine, as the examples
illustrate. The last example has another feature of naturalization in accordance with the
Arabic alphabet, namely, the use of the two letters ‘ ’طand ‘ ’غwhich are of course not a
part of the English alphabet.
3. Translation:
1. Geology ( األرضb)علم
2. Geometry ()هندسة
3. Valve (صمام
ِ)
4. Radiation ()إشعاع
5. Vibrations ()ذبذبات
160
6. Chemical substance ()مادة كيميائية
7. Blood pressure ()ضغط الدم
8. Blood group (الدم )زمرة
9. Yellow fever ()احلمى الصفراء
10.Cold ()زكام
11.Anaesthetic ()خمدر
12.Cells ()خاليا
13.Refrigiration (b)تربيد
14.Capacity ()سعة
15.Mathematical power ()قوة رياضية
16.Mathematical problem ()مسألة رياضية
17.Pathology ( األمراضb)علم
18.Hospitalization ()استشفاء
19.Arid land ()أرض بعلية
20.Arable land ()أرض صاحلة للزراعة
etc.
The list is very long. These and other examples serve as evidence for the undoubted
possibility of the translation of any foreign term into an Arabic equivalent.
4. Coinage (السك/)النقش:
This is the best method of Arabization. It is the introduction of new terms that have
not been in use in Arabic language beforehand. New Arabic terms are coined in three main
ways:
161
Revival (also called ‘engendering’ ( ))التوليدis the use of an old, dead word with a new
meaning. This means that the old word is given a new meaning, with its old meaning being
usually ignored: e.g.
a).Train: (ارbb )قطis an old word used to mean ‘a line of camels’. Now, it is used to
Arabize the well-known word ‘train’, whose compartments look like a line of camels in
shape.
b).Newspaper: (دةbb)جريis another old word used to mean ‘a small palm stick used to
write on patches' ()ُرقع. Nowadays, it is used as an Arabic equivalent to ‘newspaper’.
c).Car: ( )سيارةwas used in classical Arabic to mean ‘long distance desert travelers’ (as
mentioned in the Holy Koran, Chapter of Yusuf, verse 10). Today, it is used to mean car,
any kind of car in general (with its old meaning being retained through the Quran).
d).Telephone: ( )هاتفwas usually used to mean ‘a person whose voice is heard, but not
seen’. Recently , however, it has been reused to Arabize ‘telephone’.
These and other examples were introduced by ‘Arabic Language Academies’ ( جمامع
)اللغة العربية. Revival is a successful, but difficult, way of Arabization. The Arabized terms are
purely Arabic. It was a reaction to the invasion of Arabic by foreign words. Unfortunately,
this method is no longer applied these days because it is considered as both purist and
difficult to apply. Moreover, many terms suggested according to this method have remained
on the shelves of the 'Language Academies’ offices with no opportunity given to them to be
made public in use.
On the other hand, some introduced terms were not agreeable to language users, such
as ( )إرزيزfor ‘telephone’, and (جمّاز
َ ) for ‘train’. Therefore they died down.
Indeed, had revival been invested well by these Academies, specialists and translators,
it would have been quite productive and effective, and could have suggested good solutions
to the many problems of Arabization.
162
(ِمفعالةbََِ ), (الbb )مفعin particular. A good number of new technical terms have been derived
through these measures: e.g.
ii).() َمِفعلة
1. Butchery (bملحمة/)جمزرة
2. Dye works ()مصبغة
3. Guillotine () ِمقصلة
4. Grease box ()مشحمة
5. Postmortem room ()مشرحة
iii). ( َِمفعالة/فعالة
ّ)
163
iv). () ِمفعال
c).Neologisms (املستجدات
َ ):
They are the new words, ideas and expressions which were not known in Classical
Arabic. They comprise the major number of Arabized technical terms. Their door is always
open to receive newly Arabized words to match the rapid development of technological,
computer and internet sciences the world over. The examples are in thousands. Here are
some of them:
1. Psychology ()علم النفس
2. Physiology (وظائف األعضاء )علم
3. Metaphysics ()علم ما وراء الطبيعة
4. Computer (حسوب/حاسوب/)حاسب آيل
5. Data processing ()معاجلة املعلومات
6. Computer programming ()برجمة احلاسب
7. Command file ()ملف األوامر
8. Software ( برامج احلاسبbجمموعة/برجميات/)برجمات
9. Hardware (معدات احلاسب/)أجهزة
10.Keyboard ()لوحة مفاتيح احلاسب
11.Typewriter ()آلة كاتبة
164
12.Calulator (حاسبة )آلة
13.Inflation ()تضخم
14.Stock market (bالبورصة/)سوق العمالت
15.Hard currency ( صعبةb)عملة
16.Spaceship ()سفينة فضاء
17.Missile ()صاروخ
18.Sunshine industries (bالصناعات التقنية واحلاسوبية/)صناعات رائدة
19.Star war ()حرب النجوم
20.AIDS ())نقص املناعة(املكتسبة
21.Heart transplant ()زرع القلب
22.Stethoscope ()مساعة الطبيب
23.Electricity ()كهرباء
24.Astronaut (رجل فضاء/عالم فضاء ِ )
25.Chemical weapons ( كيميائيةb)أسلحة
etc.
The list is almost endless. Acceptable transcribed words (like the names of medicines),
naturalized terms (see‘2’ earlier) and derivations based on instrument names, can all be
considered as neologisms.
This method of Arabization is the best and the most successful one. It is what
Arabization exactly and perfectly means. All the terms suggested under this method are
either completely new (e.g.: وبbb b حس،وبbb b حاس،اروخbb b ص،اءbb b )كهرب, or new expressions and
concepts that appear in Arabic language of today. These consist of known words in Arabic,
but their combinations are new. For example, (b )علمand ( )نفسare both well-established
words in Arabic, but combining them together to mean a new branch of science is a new
concept that was not known before in Arabic. The same applies to the examples: ‘2’, ‘3’,
‘4’, ‘7’, ‘10’, ‘13’, ‘14’, ‘1’, ‘16’, ‘19’, ‘21’, ‘22’, and ‘25’. Both kinds of terms are
neologisms.
Conclusions:
The following important points can be concluded from the previous discussion:
165
1. Arabization of foreign technical terms is so vital to help us match the modern sciences
and technologies which develop by the day –if not by the hour-, and require great efforts to
Arabize them as quickly, efficiently, effectively and precisely as possible.
4. Some technical terms have now two, or more recognized versions in Arabic:
Transcription and Arabization: e.g.
1. Computer (حاسوب/bحاسب+)كمبيوتر
2. AIDS (املناعة
نقص+)اإليدز
3. Technology(تقنية+)تكنولوجيا
4. Mechanical(آيل+)ميكانيكي
5. Bank (مصرف+)بنك
6. Telephone (هاتف+)تليفون
7. Radio (إذاعة/مذياع+)راديو
8. Television (مرئية إذاعة/تلفاز+)تلفزيون
9. Cassette (شريط تسجيل+)كاسيت
10.Electron( َك ْهَرب+)إليكرتون
11.Fax(مصور
َّ بريد+)فاكس
12.Film(شريط مرئي+)فيلم
13.Cinema(خيالة/دار عرض+)سينما
166
14.Photocopy(تصوير/نسخ+)فوتوكويب
15.Freezer (جممدة+)فريزر
16.Internet (العنكبوتية الشبكة/شبكة املعلومات+)اإلنرتنت
The first transcribed version is more common and wider in use in spoken and
written Arabic than the second Arabized one. Yet, the latter remains the Arabic,
preferable version despite its less popularity than the former. However, the degree of
acceptability of foreign terms to Arabic Language users in comparison to Arabic ones, is
due to their frequent use by the public long before coining the latter. Yet, this does not
change their foreign nature.
If, for one reason or another, the duality of these terms can be accepted, another type
of duality cannot: e. g.
1. Recorder ( تسجيلbآلة/مسجل+)ريكوردر
2. (Air)conditioner ()مكيف(هواء+)كنديشن
3. Physics (فيزياء+)فيزيكس
4. Psychology ( نفسbعلم+))سيكولوجي (سيكولوجيا
5. Technician (فين+)تكنيشن
6. Group (bجمموعة+)جروب
7. Statistics () اإلحصاءb(علم إحصاء+)ستاتيستيكس
8. Antibiotic ()أنتيبيوتك+))مضاد حيوي
9. Ecology (علم البيئة+)إيكولوجيا
10. Schizophrenia (انفصام الشخصية+)شيزوفرينيا
etc.
The transcribed versions of these and similar examples are rejected in standard, written
Arabic. However, in colloquial, everyday spoken Arabic, they are more popular than the
Arabic terms. Since standard language is used in translation, we should not worry about
such popularity. The students are urged to be cautious, anyway.
167
6. Some technical terms have been Arabized into more than one term because unity of
Arabized terms among Arab Countries has not been achieved yet. It is true that a single
Arabic term for each foreign one is favourable to attain the accuracy required in technical
language, two or more Arabic terms for it would be more useful than harmful, compared to
those terms that have no Arabic equivalents of any kind. In other words, two or three
Arabic words for one foreign term are far much better than having none for it. This recalls
the problem of synonymy discussed earlier in this chapter (see 2.2.). Usually, synonyms are
different from one another, however slightly, except when they are absolute synonyms. It
has been argued then that absolute synonymy is almost absent from language for it is
unnecessary to have two signifiers (or words) for one and the same signified (or
object/idea/thing). Yet, in Arabization, all terms introduced for one and the same foreign
term are absolute synonyms in the sense that they equally refer to exactly the same object or
idea: e. g.
The difference between two or more synonyms of the same term is in the degree of
popularity. For instance, ( حاسب آيل/وبbb )حاسare the two most popular terms for ‘computer’
all over the Arab world. For the second term, ( ازbb b )تلفis a relatively popular term for
‘television’, yet (غريةbbص )شاشةis a general term used recurrently in some Arab countries; (
)تلفزةin others, and ( )إذاعة مرئيةin one or two countries. Likewise, ( براد
ّ ) and ( )دوالبare used
and heard in few Arab countries, whereas ( )ثالجةand ( )عجلةare popular in most of them. (
)كفرةis used in the Arab Gulf States (especially in Saudi Arabia).
What is common among these terms is their Arabic origin and nature. The sad
common point about them is that their transcribed foreign counterparts, (especially ()كمبيوتر
and ((ونbb )تلفزيare more popular than them in spoken Arabic in particular, and in some
written texts. Hopefully, this bad habit will not last for long, and will cease to exist one day,
and, instead, a strong, jealous ‘comeback’ to our lovely mother tongue, the language of the
Holy Quran and the Prophet's Tradition will take place very soon in connection with all
foreign terms, technical and non-technical.
168
On the other hand, multiplicity (or synonymy) of technical terms is common not only
in Arabic but also in English in two respects. First, the difference of terminology between
British English and American English in regard to some technical terms that refer to the
same thing: e. g.
Secondly, some technical terms have non-technical, popular synonyms which are
absolutely identical with them: e.g.:
Technical Non-technical
name name
169
Both versions of these terms are equally acceptable standard English. Thus, and by the
same token, in Arabization, duplicity (i.e. two) or multiplicity(i.e. over two) of terms is
normal and not harmful synonymy.
The terms ( )حوسبة, ( )حموسبand ( )حيوسبconform to Arabic measures, after words like:
(قولبة ،علكةbb صetc.); (ولَبbbمق-علَكbb )مصand (ولبbbيق-علكbb)يص. Several similar terms have been and
are being newly suggested for new English technical terms. Indeed, they strongly stress the
ability and flexibility of Arabic Language to live up to the challenge put forward daily by
new technical terminology.
Finally, great efforts have been exerted to Arabize thousands of foreign technical
terms by Arab League Educational, Cultural and Scientific Organization (ALECSO),
especially the Co-ordination Bureau of Arabization (CBA) ( ريبbb يق التعbb )مكتب تنسin Rabat,
Morocco; by Arab universities and other official institutions, and by individuals. Yet, still
greater efforts and more courage are instantly, constantly and urgently needed to
accompany the rapid advance of technology and computer and Internet sciences in
particular. All the means are available to achieve this: translators, specialists in all scientific
fields, specialist institutions, universities and institutes, financial support and above all
specialist references and dictionaries of all types and sizes in three main languages: Arabic,
English and French. These are the material tools for the solution to the problems of
Arabization. The only remaining, but essential condition is the honest willingness of men in
power and academics to Arabize.
170
2 8 Translation of PROPER NAMES, TITLES, GEOGRAPHICAL TERMS,
(POLITICAL) INSTITUTIONAL TERMS and U.N. ACRONYMS:
171
Ivan ()إيفان Verona ()فريونا
Jim (جيم ) Walter ()وولرت
Johnson ()جونسون Watson () واتسون
etc.
There seems to be no problem here, apart from the alphabetical letters: ‘G , P, Ch’,
which have no equivalents in the Arabic alphabet. The general rule for transcribing these
and other letters and sounds in Arabic is as follows:
1). ‘G’ →either ( )ج, ( )غor ()ك. This is imposed by habit, or by the phonetic combination of
letters: e. g.
‘A’, ‘S’ and ‘T’ may occasionally be transcribed in few names as ( )ع,( )صand ()ط
respectively, when they are well-known in Arabic: e.g.
1). Names with unpronounced letters could be transcribed wrongly and literally by the
students: e. g.
172
Usually the first American president’s name, ‘Abraham Lincoln’ is transcribed
wrongly as (ولنbb)لنك, but it is the acceptable version because of its old standardization and
frequency in Arabic.
B). Transcription/Naturalization: English and Arabic share certain names in religion and
history only. Therefore, the English names are naturalized when they refer to the same
person, especially the prophets and the Virgin Mary’s names:
1. Aaron ()هارون
2. Abraham ()إبراهيم
3. David ()داود
4. Isaac ()إسحاق
5. Ishmael ()إمساعيل
6. Jacob ()يعقوب
7. Jesus ()عيسى
8. Job ()أيوب
9. John (يوحنا/)حيىي =)يوحناGospel ((
)قديس
10.Jonah ()يونس
11.Joseph ()يوسُف
12.Luke ()لوقا Gospel
13.(The Virgin) Mary ()(العذراء )مرمي
173
14.Michael (ميخائيل/ميكال/)ميكائيل Angel: () َملَك
15.Moses ()موسى
16.Noah ()نوح
17.Paul ()بولس Gospel
18.Peter ()بطرس Gospel
19.Solomon ()سليمان
Nevertheless, when these names are used in other contexts to refer to ordinary people,
they are transcribed because they become mere Christian names with different nature and
culture. Thus, they no longer receive special treatment in Arabic. Rather, they turn to be
like any other names in English: e.g.
1. Aaron (إيرون/ ;)أرون2. Abraham ( ;)أبراهام3. David ( ;)ديفيد4. Issac (أيساك/ ;)إيساك5. Ishmael (
;)إمشيل6. Jacob (اكوبbb ;)ج7. Jesus (اسbb ;)جيس8. Job.(وبbb ;)ج9. John (ونbb ;)ج10. Jonah (
جوناه/ ;)جونا11. Joseph ( ;)جوزيف12. Luke ( ;)لوك13. Mary ( ;)ماري14. Michael ( ;)مايكل1
5. Moses (وزيزbb ;)م16. Noah (َواb bُ ;)ن17. Paul (ولbb ;)ب18. Peter ( ;)بيرت19. Solomon (
سولومون/)سوملون.
174
11.Homer (a poet) ()هومريوس
There are famous names in English that were originally naturalized from Arabic.
Therefore, students should not mistake them for English names when transferring them
back into Arabic: e.g.
1. Avempace: ( )ابن باجة2. Avenzoar ()ابن زهر
3. Averroes: (رشد )ابن 4. Avicenna ()ابن سينا
5. Saladin: ( )صالح الدين األيويب 6. Alhazen (اهليثم )ابن
etc.
In short, proper names are mostly transcribed, exceptionally naturalized, but never
translated into Arabic. When students are unable to pronounce a name properly, they
transcribe it wrongly, but this is not a serious mistake anyway. On the other hand, if a
famous name is transcribed wrongly, but has become standardized (e.g. ‘Lincoln’ is
transcribed as ( )لنكولنnot as ())ِلْنكن, they can retain it as such, because another transcription
might seem a different name to some people.
2.8.2. TITLES:
Titles can pose problems in translation. However, the solution is available and not so
difficult to understand. It can be sought for through three main procedures:
a.Transcription: Cultural titles which have no equivalents in Arabic are usually transcribed:
e.g.
1. Marquis/Marquess ()ماركيز
2. Earl ()إيرل
3. Viscount (فيسكاونت/)فايكانت
4. Baron ()بارون
5. Sir (Walter Scott) ()سكوت )السري(وولرت
6. Lord (Byron) ())اللورد(بايرون
7. Dr. ()دكتور
8. Prof. (أستاذ كرسي/أستاذ دكتور/أستاذ/) بروفسور
These and similar titles (except 7&8) are for the aristocratic class in English tradition
and culture. Since there is no such thing in Arabic culture, we had better transcribe them,
not simply as a sign of respect, but to bear no responsibility for translating them into Arabic
175
and make them look as a part of its culture. Having said that, the problem of understanding
some uncommon titles like ( )إيرلand ( )فايكاونتremains to be solved. The solution can be to
explain between two brackets what such titles mean in general terms: e.g.
1. Duke ()دوق
2. Duchess ()دوقة
The naturalization of the first title is only alphabetical (i.e. K → ;)قwhereas the
second is both alphabetical as well as grammatical: ( )دوقةis the feminine form of ()دوق.
Such naturalized titles are quite rare because of the cultural differences between the
two languages. Therefore, there is no serious problem here.
1. Mr. ()سيد
2. Miss ()آنسة
3. Mrs. ()سيدة
4. Lady (ليدي/)سيدة
5. Madam (bزوجة/)سيدة
6. Prince ()أمري
7. Princess ()أمرية
8. Knight ()فارس
Lady (4) can be transcribed as ( ديb )ليwhen used as an aristocratic title. On the other
hand, although ‘Miss’ and ‘Mr.’ do not pose a problem in Arabic, the title ‘Ms’ [miz]which
refers to both ‘Miss’ and ‘Mrs.’ and used when we do not know whether a woman is
176
married (i.e. Mrs.), or unmarried (i.e. Miss) to avoid embarrassment, could be problematic.
A possible solution is to translate it into ()أخت, or as follows:
“Ms”: (bسيدة/)آنسة
‘Madam’ is still transcribed on many occasions as ( دامb )مand equally understood as (
bزوجة/يدةbb b)س, especially in informal Arabic. Also, ‘prince’ and ‘princess’ are informally
transcribed as. ( رينسbb )بand ()برنسيسة: respectively. But they are confined to bad colloquial
uses and are, therefore, dismissed as completely inappropriate.
Formal titles for leaders, diplomats, politicians, judges and lords are translated
precisely as follows (British): e.g.
1).His/Her majesty, The King/The Queen (امللكة/)جاللة امللك
2).His Excellency, The President (اجلمهوريةسيادة رئيس/)فخامة
3).His Excellency, The Ambassador (معايل السفري/سيادة/دولة/)سعادة
4).His Excellency, The High Commissioner (الباب العالي/)معايل املفوض العام
5).His (Royal) Highness, The Prince (صاحب السمو امللكي األمري/)مسو األمري
177
8). His Grace, The Duke (الدوق/الباشا )سعادة دولة
9). The Honorable: to: (حضرة/عطوفة/عناية/دولة/سعادة/لـ)سيادة:
1. The speaker of parliament ()رئيس الربملان
2. Judges of high courts ()قضاة احملاكم العليا
10). His Honour: to (سيادة/لـ)حضرة:
1. Circuit Judges ()القضاة اجلوالني
11). Sir: to: (اآلغا/األفندي/)سعادة البيك(البيه/سعادة الباشا/لـ)السري:
1. Knight ()الفارس
I hasten to point out here that these are strictly Christian titles and have no relation
whatsoever to the titles of Muslim scholars, which are confined to them only. These titles
are mainly three:
)Sheikh 1.(شيخ:
)His Grace 2.(الشيخ فضيلة: )
His Holiness/Eminence: (3.املفيت/الشيخ مساحة
178
The first two titles are general, whereas the third is used for the officially highest
religious authority in every Muslim Country, (Mufti). On the other hand, the first title,
‘Sheikh’, is used as an unreligious title to interchange with ‘Prince’ in the Gulf States,
except Saudi Arabia, ‘University teacher’ in some Arab countries, a millionaire and ‘old
man’ as a sign of respect.
Other well-established and unanimously agreed upon titles are those which are used
especially for the best of the best Muslim scholars in the history of Islam. They are: (حجة
المbb الم( ;)اإلسbb يخ اإلسbb البحر( ;)ش/ربbb َدث( ;)العالّمة( ;)احلافظ( ;)احلbbل)( )امل َحbb امل (اجلليbb )الفقيه( ;)العand (امbb )اإلم.
ُ
Local titles and those which have not gathered consensus or full recognition by reliable
Muslim authorities are not included.
Obviously, these titles pose considerable problems not only for students, but also for
many professional translators. In addition, some people are sensitive to most of the
Christian titles.
As to the complexity of all titles here, three main translations can be used as a good
solution in Arabic:
2. (يادةbb )سfor leaders, diplomats, politicians, judges, and lords (except ( )جاللةfor ‘king
/queen’; ( )مسوfor ‘prince/duke’; and ( )حضرةwhich interchanges with ( )سيادةfor ‘judge’.
3. ( )أبfor all Christian religious titles and personalities (except ( البابا قداسة/ )الباباfor ‘the
Pope’(the highest Christian authority in the State of the Vatican in Rome), because it is
well-known).
179
2.8.3. GEOGRAPHICAL TERMS:
1.Transcriptions:
1. Brazil ()الربازيل
2. Denmark ()الدمنرك
3. Mali ()مايل
4. Canada ()كندا
5. Pakistan ()الباكستان
etc.
2. Naturalizations:
1. England (bانكلرتا/)إجنلرتا
2. Britain ()بريطانيا
3. France ()فرنسا
4. Italy ()إيطاليا
5. India ()اهلند
6. Belgium ()بلجيكا
7. Mexico ()املكسيك
8. Japan ()اليابان
9. Sweden ()السويد
10.Switzerland ()سويسرة
etc.
3. Translations:
180
1. The United Kingdom(UK) (املتحدة )اململكة
2. The United States of America (USA) ()الواليات املتحدة األمريكية
3. The Ivory Coast ()ساحل العاج
4. South Africa (أفريقيا اجلنوبية/)جنوب إفريقيا
5. The Central Republic of Africa ()مجهورية أفريقيا الوسطى
etc.
4. Transcriptions&Translations;
Transcriptions and naturalizations are the rule, whereas translations are the exception,
for it is a matter of respect and outright right for other peoples, countries and cultures to
have their local flavour of names of countries, cities, streets, etc., retained in translation.
Usually, there are recognized translations for foreign countries in Arabic, which are used to
translate them either from English or any other foreign language. The problem here is not
difficult to solve, then.
181
5. Washington ()واشنطن
etc.
A very limited number of names of cities are translated (sometimes alongside
transcription or translation): e.g.
3. Seas and oceans: These are mostly translated, and occasionally transcribed: e.g.
Except for (ارييبbb )كand (فيكيbb )باسof ‘7’ and ‘11’ respectively, all these are well-
established translations. The problem for students here is also not too difficult to solve.
182
Generally speaking, geographical terms and names do not pose many problems as
most of them are transcribed and/or have recognized translations in Arabic. The translation
of geographical terms of rivers, mountains, plains, etc. is not included, for they are usually
transcribed in Arabic. Therefore, they are perhaps not so problematic.
2.8.4. (POLITICAL) INSTITUTIONAL TERMS:
The following types of political institutions are the most important and recurrent in
translation.
a(.Parliaments: Parliamental terms are either transcribed or translated, or both.
1. The US Congress: ( النواب األمريكيbجملس/)الكوجنرس األمريكي
2. The US Senate : ( األعيانbجملس/األمريكي
)جملس الشيوخ
3. The House of Commons : (الربملان الربيطاين/)جملس العموم
4. The House of Lords: ()األعيان (الربيطاين/)جملس اللوردات
5. The Westminster : ( العموم) الربيطاينbالربملان(جملس/مبىن الربملان الربيطاين/)الويست مينيسرت
6. The French National Assembly : ()اجلمعية الوطنية الفرنسية
7. The People’s Assembly : ( األمةbجملس/)جملس الشعب
8. The National Assembly : (جملس األمة/)اجمللس الوطني
9. The House of Representatives : (األعيان/)جملس النواب
Arabic translations vary from one Arab Country to another. However, the naturalized
word ( )برملانis the most popular in use throughout the whole Arab world.
b(.Ministries: Usually, ministries are translated into recognized Arabic equivalents
now: e.g.
1. Finance Ministry ()وزارة املالية
2. Defence Ministry (الدفاع)وزارة
3. Foreign Ministry ()وزارة اخلارجية
4. Ministry of the Interior ()وزارة الداخلية
5. Energy ministry ()وزارة الطاقة
6. Health Ministry ()وزارة الصحة
There are few specific ministry terms for the United Kingdom and the United States.
They need special care from the students: e.g.
1. Foreign Secretary (UK) ()وزير اخلارجية الربيطاين
2. Secretary of State (USA) (األمريكي )وزير اخلارجية
3. Secretary of the Exchequer (UK) ()(الربيطاين وزير املالية/)وزير اخلزانة
183
4. Home Secretary (UK) (الربيطاين
)وزير الداخلية
5. Plenipotentiary (UK) ())وزير مفوض(يف بريطانيا
Other translations are also used for ‘1’ and ‘2’ as follows: (كرتري اخلارجيةbb )سand (
bاتب الدولةbbك/كرتريbb)س, which are not successful literal translations of words, as they prefer the
use of the notorious transcription of ‘secretary’ into (كرتريbb)س, disregarding completely the
standard Arabic translation, pointed to above. Moreover, ( )سكرتريhas a different meaning in
Arabic that is not particularly related to ‘minister’ and is well below it in terms of position
and rank. In fact it is the kind of literal translation which is common in one or two Maghribi
Countries in particular (especially Morocco). Also, the word ‘secretary’ is used in both the
UK and the US instead of ‘minister’. On the other hand, ‘minister’ is used in the UK to
refer to an official of high position in the ministry, next to the 'secretary'. Yet, in Arabic,
both ‘ministry’ and ‘secretary’ can have the same translation (i.e. )وزير. When ‘minister’ is
used in the other sense , it is translated into (وزير )نائب, ( )وكيل وزارةor()وزير يف وزارة كذا.
c).Buildings: Buildings of political importance are generally transcribed and translated as
follows:
1. The Pentagon (وزارة الدفاع األمريكية/ مقر وزارة الدفاع األمريكية:)البنتاجون
2. The Westminster (الربيطاين الربملان/ مبىن الربملان الربيطاين:)الويست مينسرت
3. ‘10’ Downing Street (’10‘وزراء بريطانيا رئيس/ مقر رئيس وزراء بريطانيا:)داونينج سرتيت
4. The Whitehall (احلكومة الربيطانية/ مقر احلكومة الربيطانية:)الوايت هول
5. Kremlin ()ًالرئيس الروسي(حاليا/)ً مقر القيادة السوفيتية (سابقا:)الكرميلين
6. Elysee (رئيس فرنسا/ مقر رئيس فرنسا:قصر اإلليزية/)اإلليزية
Exception: Translation only:
“The White House”: (األمريكي الرئيس/مقر الرئيس األمريكي/)البيت األبيض
Other similar, non-political names of streets can be included here: e.g.
1. Fleet Street: ( شارع الصحافة يف لندن:bسرتيت )فليت
2. Wall Street: ( شارع املال األمريكي يف نيويورك:b)وول سرتيت
Students must be careful not to translate the names of the streets at all. They should
avoid translations like (طولbbارع األسb )شfor ‘1’; ( ارع احلائطbb )شfor ‘2’ or any similar translation
for streets. They can transcribe them only.
Clearly, the names of buildings and streets are used in English to refer to presidents ,
governments, parliaments, ministries or important activities. Therefore, in Arabic, they
need to be both transcribed and translated into political institutions and activities. Such
translations reflect the functions of these buildings . In case students have a problem in
184
recognizing the function of a term, they simply transcribe it, bearing in mind that the
readers may be well aware of it.
2.8.5. UN ACRONYMS (AND OTHER TERMS):
An acronym is the shortening of words into their first letters which are usually capital
(with few exceptions like 'aids' for 'AIDS'). For example, ‘UN’ is an acronym for United
Nations: ‘U’ stands for the first word; ‘N’ for the second. A distinction is made between an
‘acronym’(رbص
َ )خمتand an ‘abbreviation’(ارbb)اختص. An abbreviation is the first part of a word,
(sometimes with its last letter and usually a full stop at the end) whose first letter only is
capitalized (e.g. ‘Univ.’ for University, ‘Dept.’ for Department, ‘Prof.’ for professor, etc.).
Thus, it is not the same as ‘acronym’, our point of concentration here.
The United Nations’ acronyms are the most important and recurrent in English
language for the students of translation and translators in general. Here is a list with most
UN acronyms and their Arabic equivalents, followed by comments on them and their
translation problems into Arabic. These problems have good solutions which are in other
words the translation procedures of the acronyms in general. (The acronyms are arranged
alphabetically):
185
11. IMO(Inter-Governmental Maritime Organization).
اإلميو( :منظمة املالحة بني احلكومات)
الـ-آي-يت-سي( :مركز التجارة الدويل) )12. ITC(International Trade Centre
13. ITU(International Telecommunication Union).
الـ-آي-يت-يو( :االحتاد الدويل لالتصاالت)
14. UNAIDS(Joint United Nations Programme on HIV/AIDS
اليونيدز( :برنامج األمم املتحدة املشرتك ملكافحة اإليدز)
)15. UNCDF(United Nations Capital Development Fund
اليو-إن-سي-دي-إف( :صندوق bاألمم املتحدة لتنمية bرأس املال)
16. UNCTAD(United Nations Conference on Trade and Development:).
األنكتاد( :مؤمتر األمم املتحدة للتجارة والتنمية)b
)17. UNDCP(United Nations Drug Control Programme
الـ يو-إن-دي-سي-يب(:برنامج األمم املتحدة ملراقبة العقاقري)
18. UNDOF(United Nations Disengagement Observer Force ).
الـ يو-إن-دي-أو-إف( :-قوات املراقبة والفصل التابعة لألمم املتحدة)b
19. UNDP(United Nations Development Program).
الـ يو-إن-دي-بي( :برنامج األمم املتحدة للتنمية)b
)20. *UNEF(United Nations Emergency Force
اليونيف( :قوات الطوارئ الدولية(التابعة لألمم املتحدة))b
)21. *UNEFIL(United Nations Emergency Force in Lebanon
)اليونيفيل( :قوات الطوارئ الدولية(التابعة لألمم املتحدة))يف لبنان
22. UNEP(United Nations Environment Program).
اليونيب( :برنامج األمم املتحدة للبيئة)b
23.*UNESCO(United Nations Educational, Scientific and Cultural Organization).
اليونسكو (:منظمة bاألمم املتحدة للرتبية bوالعلوم والثقافة)
24. UNFICYT(United Nations Peace-Keeping Force in Cyprus).
الـ يو-إن-إف-آي-سي-واي-تي( :قوات حفظ السالم التابعة لألمم املتحدة يف قربص)
)25. UNFPA(United Nations Population Fund
الـ يو-إن—إف-يب-إيه( :صندوق األمم املتحدة للسكان)
)26. UN-HABITAT(United Nations Human Settlements Programme(UNHSP
الـ يو-إن-هابيتات( :برنامج األمم املتحدة للتجمعات السكانية اإلنسانية)
27. UNHCR(Office of the United Nations High Commissioner for Refugees ).
الـ يو-إن-إتش-سي-آر( :مكتب املفوض السامي لألمم املتحدة لالجئني)
186
28.*UNICEF(United Nations (International)Children’s (Emergency)Fund).
b) (صندوق رعاية الطفولة التابع لألمم املتحدة:اليونيسيف
29. UNIDIR(United Nations Institute for Disarmament Research)
) (معهد أحباث األمم املتحدة لنزع التسلح:اليونيدير
30.*UNIDO(United Nations Industrial Development Organization).
b) األمم املتحدة للتنمية الصناعيةb (منظمة:bاليونيدو
31. UNIFEM(United Nations Development Fund for Women)
) األمم املتحدة التنموي للمرأةb (صندوقb:اليونيفيم
32. UNITAR(United Nations Institute for Training and Research).
) والبحثb (معهد األمم املتحدة للتدريب:اليونيتار
33. UNMOGIP(United Nations Military Observer Group in India and Pakistan) .
(جمموعة األمم املتحدة للمراقبني العسكريني:يب-أي-جي-أو-إم-إن-الـ يو
(يف اهلند والباكستان
34. UNRWA(United Nations Relief and Works Agency).
) (وكالة األمم املتحدة للغوث والتشغيل:األونروا
35. UNSF(United Nations Special Fund).
) (صندوق األمم املتحدة اخلاص:إف-إس-إن-الـ يو
36. UNSSC(United Nations System Staff College)
) (كلية األمم املتحدة ملوظفي اجلهاز اإلداري:سي-إس-إس-إن-الـ يو
37. UNTSO(United Nations Truce Supervision Organization in Palestine).
) األمم املتحدة ملراقبة اهلدنة يف فلسطنيb (منظمة:أو- إس-تي-إن-الـ يو
38.*UNU(United Nations University). b) (جامعة األمم املتحدة:األونو/اليونو
39. UPU(Universal Postal Union).
b) (االحتاد الدويل للربيد:يو-بي-الـ يو
40. WFC(World Food Council).
) (جملس الغذاء العاملي:سي-إف-الـ واو
41. WFP(World Food Programme)) (برنامج الغذاء العاملي:يب-إف-الـ دبليو
42.*WHO(World Health Organization ) .
) (منظمة الصحة العاملية:اهلو
43. WIPO(World Intellectual Property Organization).
) (املنظمة العاملية للملكية الفكرية:الـ وايبو
44. WMO(World Meteorological Organization).
187
) (منظمة األرصاد العاملية:ُأو-إم- الـ دبليو
45. WTO(World Trade/Tourism Organization)
)السياحة العاملية/ التجارةb (منظمة:أُو-يت-دبليو-الـ
46.*OPEC(The Organization of Petrolium Exporting Countries).
)منظمة الدول املصدرة للنفط:)األوبيك
(N.B. The last one is not a UN acronym).
The following comments can be made on these acronyms and their translation
problems:
a) All UN and other acronyms are transcribed in Arabic. However, they can be followed or
preceded by their full meanings, as shown here.
b) Some acronyms are transcribed as words (e.g. ( )الفاو, ()اليونيدو, ()اليونيسيف, ()اليونيسكو, etc.);
others as letters such as (ف إ-إم-آي-)الـ, (يو-بي-)الـ يو, (يو-يت-آي-)الـ, etc. The criterion for this
is the possibility or not of pronouncing the acronym as an English word. That is, ‘IBRD’,
for example, cannot be naturalized either to English or to Arabic pronunciation and
alphabet, because three consonants cannot follow one another in this way in either
language. but ‘UNICEF’ can be pronounced perfectly and easily in both, for the
arrangement of vowels and consonants makes it flexible and possible in pronunciation.
c). These acronyms are not of equal importance and recurrence in language. Only eleven of
them are so: ‘FAO’, GATT’, ‘IMF’, ‘OPEC’, ‘UN’, ‘UNEF’, 'UNEFIL', ‘UNESCO’,
‘UNICEF’, ‘UNIDO’, and ‘WHO’(check the asteriked terms in the list). Students are
expected to memorize and know how to translate them perfectly. Yet, it is not advisable to
ignore the rest.
d) Well-known acronyms like those of ‘c’ can be transcribed without giving their meanings
in full, because they are understood as such.
e) Some of these acronyms are transcribed in Arabic according to French spelling and
pronunciation(e.g.‘UNRWA’ ()األونروا, ‘UNESCO’ ()األونيسكو.
188
1. Look for the recognized transcription of the acronym in Arabic e.g.(اليونيسيف ،b اليونيدو،)الفاو
اليونيسكو،, etc. If there is such a form, it is a mistake to ignore it. Consult good and specialist
dictionaries to make sure of that.
2. Popular acronyms like ‘UNICEF’, 'UNESCO’, OPEC’, have now become recognized,
well-established and widely known in the whole Arab world. Therefore, there is no need to
explain them.
4. It is not required to give the full version of the English acronym in the Arabic translation,
for it is not needed by the Arab reader. However, the acronym can only be supplied
between brackets after the Arabic transcription for information, as follows:(UNICEF)
اليونيسيف-
5. ‘UN’ are translated into one of the following versions the Arab World over:
(املتحدة )األمم/ ()هيئة األمم املتحدة/()املنظمة األممية/ ()املنظمة الدولية/()اجملموعة الدولية/()املنتظم األممي
The first two versions are the most widely used translations in Arabic, especially in
UN acronyms. Hence their preference in the examples here. The next three versions, ‘3, 4,
5’ are used in a context of general reference. The last one is confined to one or two
countries only, and are, therefore, the least popular.
5. The word (لـ التابع/ )التابعة لـcan be used before (األمم املتحدة/ )هيئة األمم املتحدةwhen they occur at
the end of the Arabic translation: e.g.
-UNRWA: ()األونروا
(املتحدة وكالة الغوث والتشغيل التابعة (هليئة األمم)لألمم/)وكالة األمم املتحدة للغوث والتشغيل
6. When the recognized Arabic acronym is adopted from a French origin, and transcribed
according to a French pronunciation, it should be used. e.g.
189
Having said that, the English transcription (i.e. )اليونسكوis far more frequent than the
French one.
7. Usually, the Arabic definite article ( )الـis used with all adapted acronyms, whether they
are words or letters, as confirmed by the examples earlier.
8. When unable to know the acronym and/or its meaning, or find it in references, resort to
the context of the SL text. If you are still incapable of understanding it, transcribe it as a
word, if readable, or else, as individual letters. We have to admit that this is a risky solution,
but what else can you do? No better escape is available!
9. As a good start, try to concentrate mainly on the most significant UN acronyms singled
out in ‘c’ earlier and marked by an asterisk in the list above.
In sum, UN acronyms are frequently used in a variety of texts. Hence the interest in
the problems of their translations.
It remains to point out that, in the United Nations system, the General Assembly
( )اجلمعية العامةis the central Organ of the UN from which five main Organs branch;
1. “The Security Council” (األمن )جملس
2. “The International Court of Justice” (b)حمكمة العدل الدولية
3. “The Secretariat” ()أمانة السر
4. “The Economic and Social Council” ()اجمللس االقتصادي واالجتماعي
5. “The Trusteeship Council” ()جملس األمانة
The first Organ is now the most important body of the United Nations, whereas the last
one is no longer in existence. On the other hand, the General Assembly, the Security
Council and the Economic and Social Council have several, multifunctional commissions
and committees, such as:
1. Main Committees ()جلان رئيسية
2. Standing Committees (دائمة )جلان
3. Sessional Committees ()جلان دورية
4. Ad hoc Committees ()جلان آنية خاصة
5. Regional Commissions ( مفوضةb)جلان إقليمية
190
6. Functional Commissions (مفوضة )جلان وظيفية
etc.
Regional Commissions include:
1. Economic Commission for Africa(ECA) االقتصادية لشؤون أفريقياbاللجنة
2. Economic Commission for Europe(ECE) االقتصادية لشؤون أورباbاللجنة
3. Economic Commission for Latin America and the Caribbean(ECLAC)
االقتصادية لشؤون أمريكا الالتينية والكارييبbاللجنة
4. Economic and Social Commission for Asia and the Pacific(ESCAP)
اللجنة االقتصادية واالجتماعية لشؤون آسيا والباسفيك
5. Economic and Social Commission for Western Asia(ESCWA)
اللجنة االقتصادية واالجتماعية لشؤون غرب آسيا
On the other hand, Functional Commissions include:
1. Human Rights Commission جلنة حقوق اإلنسان
2. Narcotic Drugs Commission جلنة املخدرات
3. Crime Prevention and Criminal Justice Commission
جلنة مكافحة اجلرمية والقانون اجلنائي
4. Science and Technology for Development Commission
bجلنة العلوم والتكنلوجيا للتنمية
5. Sustainable Development Commission جلنة التنمية الثابتة
6. Status of Women Commission جلنة وضع املرأة
7. Population and Development Commission bجلنة السكان والتنمية
8. Commission for Social Development االجتماعيةbجلنة التنمية
9. Statistical Commission جلنة اإلحصاء
It is likely that these terms do not pose a serious problem, for they can be translated
directly, generally with ‘committee’ as ( )جلنةand ‘commission’ as ( )جلنة مفوضة.
191
Chapter Three
STYLISTIC PROBLEMS
The third set of the problems of translation is stylistic problems. They are important to
discuss on the grounds that style is relevant to meaning. That is, in today's studies, style is
viewed as a part of meaning and affects it in different ways and to different degrees. So, a
change of style means a change of meaning of some kind. Style is no longer seen as irrelevant
to meaning, separeted from it, or the dress that has nothing to do with it. Meaning was claimed
to stand on its own, unaffected by that dress. Nowadays, style has been given special attention
and is regarded as a part and parcel of meaning. If we attend to it, we attend to meaning in full;
if we ignore it, we ignore at least one part of meaning. Hence, its significance in translation is
worth discussing. Here is an illustrative example to confirm the importance of style and how
relevant it is to meaning. The following statements express the same idea of death:
According to the traditional concept of style, all these statements from 'a-g' express the
same idea of the death of 'her father', and that is the important thing about it. Therefore, they
are all translated into one and the same version in Arabic (i.e.)مات والدها أمس. It does not matter,
then, whether 'her father' died naturally, unnaturally, honourably or dishonourably, got killed,
192
hanged, died in the battlefield or in bed, out of illness or in a car accident. What matters is that
he is dead now.
This argument cannot be accepted for the cause of death is extremely crucial to both the
dead person and to his family. That is, a natural death is quite normal and, hence, acceptable to
people, whereas an unnatural death caused by killing and premeditated murder is quite serious,
unacceptable and has dire consequences to people, dead and alive. It makes a big difference to
talk about a dead man with respect, or with no respect. By the same token, describing a dead
peson as a martyr is not the same like describing him as 'killed' or just 'dead'. Thus, it is not
acceptable to translate all the previous sentences into one and the same Arabic version of
translation, as above. Rather, each one has its own translation that is stylistically and
semantically different from the rest, as demonstrated below:
There are considerable stylistic differences among these versions: (a) is normal, natural
and neutral death; (b) is abnormal, unnatural and despicable crime; (c) is a murder from
behind; (d) is humorous, unfavourable and colloquial; (e) is agreeable and respectful of the
dead; (f) is religious and sublime; and (g) is informal and unagreeable. Consequently, these
differences are differences of meaning and effect and, therefore, have to be taken into account
in translation.
193
from the active voice. A difficult, ambiguous grammatical structure stands in contrast with an
easy, clear structure. On the other hand, colloquial words and formal words are not used for the
same reason, or to express the same meaning. Likewise, rhythmical language has different
effects and functions from those of ordinary language.This functional view to style stresses the
importance of style in language, being inseparable from meaning. Therefore, in translation, it
should be concentrated on, and its problems require solutions, as the negligence of the style of
SL results in an incomplete meaning in the TL. (More details on this functional concept of
style are provided by Hough (1969), Crystal and Davy (1969), Chatman. (1971), Enkvst
(1973), Widdowson (1975), Traugot and Pratt (1980), Freeman (ed.) (1981), Leech and Short
(1981), Carter (ed) (1982), Carter and Burton (eds.) (1987), Carter and Long (1987), Ghazala
(1987, 1994/ 1999, 2011, 2012a and 2012c); Fabb et al (eds.) (1987), Wales (1989), Carter and
Nash (1990), Durant et al (1990), Bradford (1997), Thornborrow et al (1998), Toolan (1998),
(Simpson (2004), (Boase-Beier (2006), Jeffries (2010) and many others.
The question now: Shall we retain the style of the English text? or change it into an
equivalent Arabic style? The answer is: Generally, we keep the English style in Arabic when
possible. However, when not possible, or when an equivalent Arabic style is available, we
translate the English style into it. In all cases, the style of the Arabic translation depends on,
and is derived from the style of the English original. This leads to suggest 'Stylistic
Equivalence', which is the proper choice of the style of the TL text (i.e. Arabic ), based on that
of the SL text (i.e. English), unless unavailable or unadvisable in the TL (e.g.
informal/colloquial style is not a part of written formal Arabic. See below). By this, emphasis
is laid on both styles of English and Arabic. How and when to apply that in translation will be
illustrated in the numerous examples given in the following discussion of the main stylistic
problems of translation, associated with their possible solutions, starting with the style of
formality and informality.
194
3.1. Style of FORMALITY VS. INFORMALITY:
In 1962, Joos suggested a scale of five ‘styles’ (or tones) of English language, which is
general but proved to be widely acceptable by most people.
Examples:
1. Frozen formal
1. FORMAL
2. Formal
3. Informal
195
4. Colloquial 2. INFORMAL
5. Vulgar (slang)
Such shortened classifications are come across in some language references (e.g.
Longman Dictionary of English Idioms, Collins and Websters English Dictionaries). Some of
these references use 'colloquial' or 'slang' instead of 'informal'.
(b) Sometimes it is difficult to draw a clear-cut line between the following four pairs:
‘frozen formal and formal’; ‘formal and informal’; ‘informal and colloquial’; ‘colloquial and
slang’. Some English words and grammatical constructions come at the borderline. For
example, ‘idioms and phrasal verbs’ are classified either as formal or informal, or both;
grammatical contractions like ‘can’t’, ‘don’t’, ‘haven’t’, etc. are considered by some as
informal, and by others as colloquial. The most widespread difficulty of distinction is that
between formal and informal styles of language.
Yet, despite the difficulty and personal nature of the distinction between these five styles
of English language, we can understand and apply them in general terms. Moreover they are
helpful, and sometimes decisive to meaning in translation, as demonstrated in ‘c’.
(c) Although the message of all the statements in the example is the same in Arabic (i.e. )اجلس,
each statement has different effects and, hence, meaning. ‘1’ is so official and/or impolite, said
by a harsh person, or a man of a high position (i.e. a king, a president, a minister, a manager, a
boss, etc.) to strangers and ordinary people; whereas ‘2’ is official, yet polite, used in a similar
context to that of ‘1’, but to friends and personal acquaintances . Moreover, it can imply that a
person is polite. ‘3’ is not official and more polite than ‘1’ and ‘2’ (the informal use in Arabic
is ( )لو مسحتwhich is between formal and colloquial), but ‘4’ is quite friendly, intimate and so
kind (in Arabic: (اسرَت يح/)اسرْت يح, ( )اسرْت يَّحand ( )ارتاحin particular reflect a colloquial tone) ‘5’ on
the other hand, is strong and rude in both languages (although in Arabic it can be said
humorously to a close friend).
Clearly, these five tones cannot be interchangeable in social relations among people. That
is, we do not say to a stranger ‘feel at home’ ()خذ راحتك, nor to a friend ‘be seated’ ( عليك/اجلس
)باجللوس, nor to a respected person ‘sit bloody down’ ()انقرب يف مكانك. Confusing these terms in
such a way will result in serious mistakes in translation, and serious situations among
individuals. Hence the importance of reserving them in translation into Arabic.
Having said that, the students are not advised to use the last two tones (i.e.colloquial and
slang) in Arabic. Instead, they resort to the so-called ‘Modern Standard Arabic (MSA)’, which
is the written Arabic of today (see below). That is, we may say ( )خذ راحتكonly for ‘4’, and (اقعد
)يف أرضكfor instance, for ‘5’.
196
The students, therefore, do not need to imitate all the English styles in Arabic. The main
reason is that there are usually four styles only in Arabic:
1. Classical Arabic (i.e. the language of the Holy Quran, the Prophet's Tradition and
classical literature ).
2. Modern Standard Arabic (MSA) (i.e. the formal written Arabic of today).
3. Colloquial Arabic (i.e. the language of conversation).
4. Vulgar (or slang) Arabic (i.e. the very local, unkind and/or bad language).
The English styles can be translated into these Arabic styles as follows:
(English) (Arabic)
2. Formal } → MSA
3. Informal
The most familiar styles/tones in Arabic are the formal and the colloquial ones, used in
general terms to cover the four styles above as follows:
There is a considerable problem for the students to distinguish between these styles,
especially in English and partly in Arabic, with regard to the differentiation between Classical
Arabic and MSA in particular. The good solution to this problem is to minimize the English
styles to one general style in Arabic, that is, Modern Standard Arabic, at early stages in
particular. The reason for choosing the MSA is that it is the middle ground among Arabic
styles: simple, easy, more acceptable, polite , known, popular,understandable and available to
the students at different levels of English. Thus, back to the example above, they can translate
the five statements into ()اجلس, which is the message in MSA, when it is difficult to imitate all
of these tones in Arabic. Although this translation ignores style, it is an acceptable solution to
such a problem of formality and informality of language and style.
197
The problem of formality scale appears in certain texts such as spoken English and texts of
general nature which are generally informal, whereas scientific, legal and most of literary texts,
for instance, are formal. Here are two examples for both types:
Example 1: A general text:
"You can’t paint watercolours without knowing how to lay a wash, though anyone can learn
the knack if they are willing to go to a bit of trouble. People have their own fads about the drill,
but my method seems to work as anyone’s." (Nash, 1980: 128-9)
a. The use of the second person pronoun style in words like ((ميكنك-ترسم-ك
ْ َمعر ْفت
ْ
b. The use of such words as (ك )دو ْن, ()الوقوع يف مشكل, ()شطارة, ( )مراقand ()كِيف
ْ َمعر ْفت
ْ
c.The disregard of the concord between singular ( )أي واحدand the plural of verb()كانوا يريدون.
d.The ignorance of standard word order .
e The vowelless stopping at the end of words by omitting vowelization / vocalization,
namely, stopping on ()سكون.
f.The use of singular form of ( )مراقهمinstead of the plural form ()مراقاهتم
It is not necessary to translate the English informal features into the same Arabic
equivalents, because it is not advisable nor possible to do so. Moreover, some of these features
(such as ‘can’t’) have no equivalents in Arabic. Rather, alternative features are used elsewhere
by way of compensation (e.g. ignorance of standard vocalization )تشكيل. After all, it is not
required to have the same number of the English informal features in Arabic, but to use some
informal expressions here and there in Arabic, if and when possible, that are suggestive of
informal style.
198
Another possible, easier version for the students in particular is the use of MSA as
follows:
(إذا
رغم أن أي واحد يستطيع أن يتعلم هذه الشطارة،ال ميكنك أن ترسم باأللوان املائية دون معرفتك كيف حتضر األلوان
للناس أمزجتهم اخلاصة يف التمرين ولكن مزاجي يبدو فعالًا كما هي أمزجة اآلخرينb.)كان يريد الوقوع يف مشكلة
Although this version can be safe and popular among the students, the previous informal
one is admittedly more precise and expressive of the important function of the English informal
style, which is intimate, direct, clear and simple.
“A great deal of interest has been generated recently in calcium mainly because of the role it
plays in the incidence of osteoporosis. At present some 35 to 40 per cent of women aged 65 in
the UK suffer from fractures of the forearm, femur or vertebrae as a result of osteoporosis”.
(From Health Express, July 1987)
(مرض نظراً للدور الذي يلعبه بشكل رئيسي يف حدوث،َتَوّلد يف اآلونة األخرية قدر كبري من االهتمام يف الكالسيوم
باملئة من النساء يف اململكة املتحدة من كسور يف الذراع أو عظم40 إىل35 هذا ويعاين اآلن حوايل.هشاشة العظام/لني
)الفخد أو الفقرات نتيجة هلشاشة العظام.
English scientific and technical texts are always formal in style, to imply seriousness,
conservatism and internationality. Consequently, the Arabic version should be formal, without
colloquial features being used, so that it reflects the same function of the original. Thus, a
translation using some informal features (like version 2 below) is rejected completely in
Arabic, because it seems strange and funny, giving the impression of a jocular, ironical
atmosphere of a serious English original:
Here are the underlined informal features with their formal equivalents:
199
1. (ٌتركيز كبري
ٌ حصل بري
ْ تركيز ْك
ْ حصل ْ )
َ
2. (الذي )اللي
3. (يعاين )بيعاين
4. (من النساء )من احلرمي
5. (الاليت )اللي
6. (جتاوزن )جتاوزوا
ِ ِب
7. (bنتيجة/سبب سبب
ْ ْ)ب
This version is a failure in style/tone, and affects the meaning of the whole text
negatively, making it abnormal. Therefore, the students are advised to ignore it and, instead,
concentrate on the first version, whose formal tone is the only acceptable one in Arabic. This
means that the informal version is problematic and should be avoided. Its only advantage is to
stand in contrast with the first one, which allows the students to notice the difference between
an acceptable, normal, formal and serious version (i.e. ‘1’) and an unacceptable, abnormal
informal and funny one (i.e. ‘2’).
On the other hand, it is not necessary to match every English informal feature with an
Arabic equivalent one. One or two token features of informal Arabic are sufficient to suggest
the informal tone of the English informal original, as shown in the previous examples.
However, some English texts (i.e. scientific)are formal only and, therefore, do not create a
problem of tone, because they have to be translated into MSA only. Any use of colloquial
Arabic in the translation of such texts will be poor, misplaced and, hence, unacceptable.
It is hoped that the discussion of the importance of the different stylistic tones in both
languages will invite the students to attend to them in some texts, and try to take them into
consideration as much as possible. However, the situation in English is different from that in
Arabic in this respect. That is, English allows more space for using informal features in writing
than Arabic which makes a clearcut distinction between formal written Arabic and informal
spoken Arabic. It remains to point out that these tones are marked either at the level of
grammar, or words , or at both levels.
3.2. Style of FRONTING:
200
Fronting (or 'foregrounding') is an important stylistic device , used widely at both the
sentence and text levels. It means to move a word, a phrase or a clause from its original place
in the middle or at the end of a sentence to the beginning (or the front position) of that
sentence. This can be understood by recognizing the normal word order in English language.
That is, a declarative sentence has the following normal order: ‘Subject-Verb-
Object/Complement’ When a sentence starts with an object, this object is fronted: e.g.: ‘Allah
she worshipped’, instead of: ‘She worshipped Allah’. Likewise, a complement is usually
positioned after the verb: e g ‘In my room he slept’, instead of: ‘he slept in my room’( نام يف
)غرفيت.
As to clauses, the normal clause order in English is the main clause, first, then the
subordinate clause: When the subordinate clause is put before the main clause, it is fronted: e.g.
“As he had been caught red-handed, the criminal was sentenced to death”.
(subordinate clause) (main clause)
Such frontings are not made by chance, but for good reasons. That is, the fronted words or
clauses have a more important function of emphasis, etc. than the other parts of the sentence.
This means that they play a vital role in understanding meaning. Therefore, they must be taken
into consideration in Arabic as follows:
Both the glorified ()اهلل, and ( )يف غرفيتare not in their normal positions in Arabic, yet they
have to be in such a position to reflect the same function of emphasis and surprise aimed at in
the English original.
201
4.“If you apologize, I will forgive you”: (أساحمك فسوف،)إذا اعتذرت
The second clause is conditioned by the first. This is a good reason for fronting the latter,
despite being subordinate. In Arabic, this order should be retained to convey the same
condition, as confirmed by the version here.
Fronting is used not only at the sentence level, but also at the text level. Consider the
following example:
“Round a centrally-placed coffee-table there are three armchairs. To the left of the fireplace is
an alcove with built-in bookshelves. To the right, a table carrying a television set. Against the
wall facing the fireplace stands an upright piano’.
(From Nash, op.cit.: 10)
The underlined adverbial phrases are moved from their back positions at the ends of
sentences to a fronted position at the beginning. By this, they are emphasised strongly.
Moreover, they are put at the head of sentences to replace first, second, etc., as and at the same
time direct attention to certain things in the room in order. These functions are important to
undertand the message, and, hence, should not be ignored in the Arabic version (the equivalent
fronted Arabic phrases are underlined):
( طاولة.املوقد فجوة فيها رفوف كتب إىل اجلهة اليسرى من.يوجد ثالثة كراسي حول طاولة صغرية متمركزة يف الوسط
ينتصب بيانو عمودي على احلائط مقابل املوقد.)عليها جهاز تلفاز إىل اجلهة اليمىن.
In this version, there is nothing unusual about the underlined phrases, which does not
reflect the spirit and the emphasis of the original. In other words, a part of the message and
style will be lost. Therefore, it is not a favorable version.
202
When two structures are identical to one another, they are described as parallel. Such
parallelism can be important to meaning, implying a balance between two or more messages: e
g.
The structures of these three short sentences are parallel, as shown below
These sentences are well-balanced, not only in structure but also in meaning. That is,
when my father fell ill, my mother felt sad for him, and my sister was worried about him, or
about both. In other words, at the time my father fell ill, my mother was sad and my sister
worried. Also it can imply that my father’s illness is in parallel with my mother’s sadness and
my sister’s worry. All these are good reasons to insist on reflecting the same style of
parallelism in the Arabic translation, without changing anything in the structures of the
sentences: ( أخيت قلقة. أمي حزينة.) والدي مريض
It should be noted that if there is a change of the parallel grammatical structure of the
English original in Arabic (as the case here), we have to produce parallelism in the new Arabic
grammatical structures of sentences.
2. “I always advise my brother not to get nervous when he is dejected. He usually wants me not
to be passive when he is angry. Both of us often ask our parents not to be worried when we are
different”.
203
not to be worried
3. when he is dejected
when he is angry adv.+S+V+C(adj.)
when we are different
Such parallelism has the function of balancing and counter-balancing the three
interconnected parts of the message. That is, the first sentence is the advice, the second is the
reaction to it, the third is the bringing of both closer to one another. Also, they are made equal
in weight; neither outweighs the other. Therefore, we have to reserve parallelism in Arabic as
follows (each clause is translated individually first, for clarification, followed by the whole
translation):
1. I always advise my brother (ً)أنصح أخي دائما
not to get nervous (ًعصبيا )أال يكون
when he is dejected (ً)عندما يكون مكتئبا
3. Both of us often ask our parents (ما يرجو والديه ً)كالنا غالبا
not to be worried ()أال يكونا قلقني
when we are different ()عندما نكون خمتلفَني
The difference in word order is unimportant. What is important is to retain the word class
(i e noun → noun, adjective → adjective, etc.) of the original in Arabic, and to use a
parallel Arabic word order. Here is the Arabic translation in full:
(.ًغاضبا يريدين عادة أال أكون سلبياً عندما يكون.ًأنصح أخي دائماً أال يكون عصبياً عندما يكون مكتئبا
)كالنا غالباً ما يرجو والديه أال يكونا قلقني.
204
Ambiguity is unclarity. It is a major stylistic device, used frequently in language to
achieve functions like: unclarity of message, complicating meaning, hiding the truth, avoiding
straightforward expression of opinion, reflecting the nature of a character, a person, an idea,
etc. and interconnecting style and meaning in such a compact, artistic way that they reflect one
another. These functions are vital to the message, and, hence, are extremely important to retain
in translation. Usually a clear message should be conveyed. Here are examples, starting with
the most famous ones of syntactic ambiguity:
Neither of these two meanings is clearly stated in the sentence. Therefore, the same
ambiguity should be kept in the Arabic translation, and the word ( )صيدgives the required sense
here.
Similarly, ‘flying’ has two senses here (as a noun) and as an adjective (2):
3. “I smell a rat in what you say” : (فيما تقول )يلعب الفار يف عيّب
‘Smell a rat’ is an idiom that means ‘doubtful’. But the latter is straightforward whereas
the former is not. Therefore, in Arabic we look for an indirect equivalent such as the translation
suggested above. However, when there is a problem finding the most suitable version, the
students can resort to other phrases which are equally unclear such as ( رائحة مكيدةb)أشتم. If the
problem persists, they may use direct phrases like ( )تساورين شكوك, ( )أشكetc. but with a loss of
effect, though.
4 “The teacher’s method of teaching is a show of muscles”:
(للعضالت )طريقة األستاذ يف التدريس استعراض.
205
‘A show of muscles’ may not be quite clear, and, hence, should be translated into an
unclear Arabic phrase such as that suggested here. Straightforward translations like( تظاهر
ُ ), (تفاخ
ُ
)ر, ()مباهاة, etc. are acceptable, but not favorable because they distort the ambiguous style of a
beautiful expression in both Languages, English Arabic.
5. “John went to the bar to bury his sorrows”: (أحزانه )ذهب جون إىل احلانة ليدفن
In western non-Muslim culture, a miserable person may go to the bar and drink wine to
get drunk in order to forget his distress and troubles. In Arabic, Muslim culture, however, a
distressed person does not do that, because drinking wine is a sin. Instead, he prays to God
either at home, or in the mosque. Therefore, the above translation can be ambiguous to many.
However, the students are advised to keep this cultural ambiguity to give the chance to Arab
readers to know about one aspect of western culture. Simultaneously, teachers may explain the
cultural differences between the two cultures, in the same way as done here.
To conclude, ambiguity is a main stylistic device used to play a decisive role in the
understanding of the message. It can be syntactic (examples 1+2), lexical (3+ 4)or cultural (5).
When finding it difficult to translate into Arabic, the students are recommended to consult a
good reference or authority to solve it by disambiguating it, or, more advisably, by preserving
it.
Complexity of style can be dominant in a text to achieve a function of some kind, which
has impact on meaning. The same kind of style can render the same function and effect in
Arabic translation. Otherwise, meaning will be incomplete. Here are examples:
206
1. “Knowing how popular Robin Hood was among the common people and how he could
always slip quietly away into Sherwood forest where his pursuers would be hampered by their
ignorance of the terrain and their inablility to adapt to the conditions of guerrilla warfare, the
sheriff decided to take no immediate action”.
(op.cit.: 113)
The complexity of style is because the whole text is one single sentence which is
composed of several interconnected fronted subordinate clauses, followed by the main clause
in a final position, as the following analysis shows:
Apart from lexical problems like the translation of ‘hampered’, ‘terrain’, ‘guerrilla
warfare’, the difficulty for the students is in how to follow up and understand the complexity of
the sentence in Arabic, considering the delayed main verb and subject ( )قرر الشريفto the last
position in the sentence. The solution is to analyse the sentence into its constituent clauses in
English -as done above- and then start translating a clause by clause, with concentration on the
right start of the sentence(i.e. مبا أنه كان (يدرك/ًعاملا/ًعارفا/ًمدركا... and the proper grammatical
connection among them(see 1.10-1.17 earlier). Each clause should be in Arabic in the same
position ordered in the English original, producing an identical complexity. Such complexity is
syntactic (or grammatical).
2. “A still new patient, a thin and quiet person, who had found a place with his fianceé at the
good Russian Table, proved, just when the meal was in full swing, to be epileptic, as he
suffered an extreme attack of that type, with a cry whose demonic and inhuman character has
often been described, fell heavily on the floor and struck around with his arms and legs next to
his chair with the most ghastly contortions”.
(From Newmark, 1988: 25)
This text is one single sentence with one a subject, a main verb and an object. The first
problem to be solved by the students of translation is to locate these three major grammatical
207
categories of the sentence. Then, and only then can they understand its grammatical
complication, and translate it correctly. A misunderstanding of grammar will lead to mistakes
in translation. The other point of complication is the use of three main verbs added to one
another and separated by insertions in between. Also, complexity is caused by insertions
among the subject, the main verb(s)and the object of the sentence. The whole sentence reads as
follows:
" على الطاولة الروسيةb، وجد مكاناً مع خطيبته اليت كانت باملثل هادئة هزيلة، شخص هادئ وهزيل،مريض صامت جديد
مع صرخة، حيث عاىن من نوبة حادة من ذاك النوع، أنه مصاب بالصرع، أثبت حني كانت الوجبة يف أوجها،المحرتمة
سقط بقوة على األرض وختبط بيديه ورجليه مبحاذاة، غالباً ما ُوصفت أهنا شيطانية وغري إنسانية
كرسيه مع تشنجات مروعة."
Complexity is retained in Arabic because it is important to reflect the message. That is,
the whole sentence is about an abnormal, epileptic, complicated person. This message is put in
a complicated style of grammar. A complex style matches a complex person, so to speak.
Therefore, changing the complex grammatical structure of the original into an easy one in
Arabic is unsuitable, and mismatches the message. In any case, it is quite difficult to change
the complexity of style into an easy style in Arabic. If we try hard, to do so, a considereble
proportion of meaning and stylistic functions would be distorted.
The same point can be said of the complexity of the following text (taken from James
Joyce’s short story, The Sisters):
3. “It may have been these constant showers of snuff which gave his ancient priestly garments
their green faded look for the red handkerchief, blackened, as it always was, with the snuff-
stains of a week, with which he tried to brush away the fallen grains, was quite inefficacious”.
The Sisters is a story about paralysis and paralysed people. The grammatical structure of
this sentence is not smooth; on the contrary, it is quite complex to follow. By this, it resembles
the paralysed priest who the sentence is about. It is as untidy as the blackened handkerchief of
the priest. Thus, a paralysed structure is parallel with the condition of the paralysed priest.
These functions are good reasons for us to reflect the same style of complexity of this
sentence in Arabic as follows:
208
"املنديل
... ألن،السَعط هي اليت صبغت ثيابه الكهنوتية بلون أخضر داكن
َّ رمبا كانت هذه الرزازات املستمرة من جراء
كان عدمي، والذي حاول أن يزيل به الحبيبات الساقطة، ببقع السعط ملدة أسبوع،ً كما كانت حاله دائما،األمحر املسَْوَّد
الفائدة على اإلطالق."
The complication is in the second half of the sentence (i.e. ‘for the red … inefficacious ‘(
على اإلطالق... )ألن املنديلas follows:
The point about complication here can be made clearer by comparing this complex part
of the sentence to a hypothetical easy one, where clauses follow one another normally and
fluently, as follows:
“ …for the handkerchief was quite inefficacious as it was blackened with the snuff-stains of a
week and was used by him trying to brush away the fallen grains”.
This version is easier to follow and understand than the complicated Joycean origin. Yet,
it is not what the writer writes, and does not fit with a message about paralysis. In other words,
an easy style does not replace a complicated style, as each one has different functions and
reflects different messages.
4. “It is the very first really reliable do-it-yourself fibreglass sailing dinghy with oars and a full
suit of sails”:
209
(Nash: 1980: 66)
The complexity of this sentence is in the difficulty of finding the head word of the very
long complement. It also lies in the complicated modification. However, solving the first
problem is more urgent and vital than the second which can be solved by consulting a
dictionary. When the students know that the head word of the complement is ‘dinghy’, they
can start translating and solving the problem of complexity here. Here is a suggestion:
(من األشرعة )إنه حقاً قارب اإلحبار الزجاجي الليفي األول املصنوع يدوياً املتني مبجاديف وطاقم كامل
The complexity of the Arabic version is clear, caused by the follow-up of adjectives and
adverbs in particular without a stop, using no commas or the conjunction of addition, ‘and’ ( )و
which makes the translation more comfortable and fluent:
(األشرعة مبجاديف وطاقم كامل من، واملتني،ً)إنه حقاً قارب اإلحبار الزجاجي الليفي األول واملصنوع يدويا
However, it is not advisable to make this long, complex sentence into simple short
sentences, because it provides an interconnected, compact description of one and the same
thing (i.e. ‘dinghy’), which should be considered and taken as one inseparable unit. Hence, it is
not preferable to have such a version as the following:
(كامل وهو مبجاديف وطاقم. فهو مصنوع يدوياً ومتني.إنه حقاً قارب اإلحبار الزجاجي الليفي األول
)من األشرعة
5. “Why do you think we make Nuttall’s Mintoes such a devilishly smooth cool creamy minty
chewy round slow velvety fresh clean solid buttery taste?”:
(From Crystal and Davy: 1969)
(بطيء خمملي بارد قشدي نعناعي مضغي دائريbملاذا تظن أننا جنعل مينتوز ناتال ذات مذاق شيطاين سلس
)طازج نظيف متني ُزْبدي؟
The Arabic version has exactly the same style of complexity of the original, including the
absence of commas among adjectives. Complexity is the result of thirteen successive adjectives
for one and the same noun (i.e. ‘taste’( )مذاق. The problem of translating them can be solved by
taking care of their meanings and proper grammatical forms in Arabic. Complexity should,
therefore, be retained because this long stretch of adjectives is inseparable in its description of
210
the ‘taste of Nuttal’s Mintoes ’(i.e. mint’s chewing gum النعناع علك/ لبان:) which has these
properties together and at the same time. Any separation between them would damage the
purpose of the whole advertisement.
The style of complexity, then, has to be reflected in Arabic, without any attempt to
simplify it, because it has specific functions which cannot be expressed by a simple or any
other style. These functions are relevant to meaning and, therefore, should not be ignored.
The normal, unmarked style of sentences is those of medium length. However, short and
long sentences are two marked styles that have different functions and implications in relation
to meaning.
The style of short sentences, to start with, can be dominant in the English text. If so, the
Arabic translation needs to be so. More than one reason can be behind that, as the next two
examples prove:
1. “The police heard a little noise inside the bank. The robber noticed that. He wanted to
escape. The police chased him. Pedestrians noticed the scene. One of them shouted at the
robber. Another blocked his way. Then, the police arrived and arrested him”:
The style of short sentences here has an important function. It heightens the tempo of
action in this text which is written in the form of a story. It accelerates events and arouses
211
suspense. Maybe it is the only type of style which reflects this function of acceleration that can
be sensed at reading the text aloud and quickly. Thus, this style has to be reproduced in the
Arabic translation to keep this function:
(.املشهد املارة
ّ الحظ. طاردته الشرطة. أراد أن يهرب. الحظ اللص ذلك.مسعت الشرطة جلبة خفيفة داخل املصرف
حينئذ وصلت الشرطة واعتقلته. قام آخر بسد طريقه. باللصbصاح أحدهم.)
No cohesive devices like ( و، )فare used in this version. This reflects the follow-up of
events a stage by stage. It is not advisable to write the text in one long sentence for it has a
different function, as the next section will confirm.
2. “Middle age is a time of despair. Few men like themselves when they are fifty. The young
are engaged with their own images. The old are rapt in selfhood. Only a middle-aged man
dislikes what he sees in the mirror. He sees failure. And he knows he has to live with it. Young
men hope, because they dare. Old men forgive themselves, because they must. But a middle-
aged man knows neither hope nor reconciliation. He knows only the burden of responsibility.
He is responsible for the life he has made. He cannot plead excuses or look for sympathy”.
(Nash, op.cit.: 96)
This text is intended not to be flowing, but to present a group of wisdoms in the form of
short sentences. Its hidden force is mainly personal and emotional. The exploitation of the
technique of short sentencing is the best way to impress the reader by these proverbial
statements. Therefore, disregarding sentence length means the loss of these stylistic functions
which support the message. That is why the following Arabic translation is laid out in form of
short sentences too:
(.هبم فالشباب منشغلون بصورهم اخلاصة. قلة من الناس حيبون أنفسهم حينما يبلغون اخلمسني.سن الكهولة مرحلة يأس
ويعلم أن عليه أن. إنه يرى الفشل. الكهل هو وحده الذي ال حيب ما يرى يف املرآة.والكبار غارقون يف حب الذات
أما. والكبار يساحمون أنفسهم ألن عليهم أن يفعلوا ذلك. الشباب حيذوهم األمل ألهنم جيرؤون على ذلك.يتعايش معه
وال يستطيع أن. فهو مسؤول عن احلياة اليت عاشها. يعرف عبء املسؤولية وحسب.الكهل فال يعرف األمل وال املهادنة
إىل الشفقةb األعذار و يتطلعb)يلتمس.
It is not wise, then, to change short sentencing into long sentencing , because the latter has
different stylistic functions, as the forthcoming point shows.
212
3.7. Style of LONG SENTENCES:
Long sentences are frequent in language, but they are not the norm. They represent a type
of style of sentences used to reflect certain functions pertaining to meaning or message.
Therefore, they are usually retained in translation. The SL text can be one long sentence, or a
group of long sentences, for several reasons: the strong unity of the topic; reflection of a boring
subject matter, emphasis or non-emphasis of a subject, a predicate, a phrase, or a clause;
portrayal of a scene of some kind; avoidance of any shade of ambiguity and addition of any
extra thing to the text - especially legal texts -; etc. Here are three examples, two general and
one legal:
1. “In an attempt to help his ill mother, who needed an operation in a specialist hospital in
London, which was quite expensive and demanded money to be paid in advance, the boy, who
was still very young and inexperienced, worked in a mechanical workshop day and night to
earn as much money as he could and as quickly as possible”.
213
This is a long, complicated sentence. Yet, it has to be taken as one unit and one idea. We
cannot separate between its clauses because they are interconnected, and would not be
understood unless they are taken together as one whole. On the other hand, the subject (the
boy), main verb (worked) and complement (in a car repairs workshop) of the sentence are near
the end and quite distant from the beginning. Therefore, grammatically we cannot have the
sentence in any other style in Arabic, as suggested by the following version:
( والذي كان باهظاً جداً وطلب، يف مستشفى متخصص يف لندنbيف حماولة ملساعدة أمه املريضة اليت كانت حباجة إىل عملية
يف ورشة تصليح سيارات ليل هنار ليكسب قدر ما، عمل الصيب الذي كان ما يزال صغرياً وعدمي اخلربة،ًدفع النقود مقدما
)يستطيع من النقود وبأسرع ما ميكن.
2. “The recent fall in the number of applications for arts degree courses, though not very
surprising in view of the diminished glamour of university life and the natural anxiety of young
people about the prospects of employment at the conclusion of their studies, is nevertheless
disturbing because it implies a reduction in the status of the university as a guardian of humane
values.” (From Nash, op.cit. 94)
The interruptive clause (i.e. ‘though…studies’) has a message which is emphasised for its
importance and relevance to the whole idea of the sentence. That is why it is inserted in the
middle of the main clause (viz. ‘the recent fall…is disturbing’). More importantly, this long,
complicated sentence stresses the strong unity of this view about arts degrees and the
university. Thus: One sentence, one text, one unit, one idea. The Arabic version should,
therefore, be so:
( مع أنه غري مفاجىء بالنظر الحنسار بريق احلياة اجلامعية،إن اهلبوط احلديث يف عدد طلبات االنتساب للتخصصات األدبية
هذا اهلبوط مع ذلك مثري للقلق ألنه يتضمن،والقلق الطبيعي عند الشباب عن آفاق العمل املستقبلية حني إهنائهم دراستهم
)إنقاصاً من منزلة اجلامعة كحارس أمني للقيم اإلنسانية.
Because of the long separation between the two parts of the main clause, the key word (
)هبوطis repeated for the convenience of cohesion and making the sentence easy to read and
understand. This is common in Arabic in a case like this. It is possible to break this long
sentence into two or three short sentences. Yet, it is not preferable to do that, or else the
compactness and wholeness of the sentence will be lost. Maybe the problem of translating this
sentence as such can be more easily solved than splitting it into short sentences, if the students
follow the same English grammatical order at translating it into Arabic; whereas short
sentences require them to add extra words which are not found in the original. Thus, reserving
the style of the original saves the students from creating more problems for themselves.
3. “ A deduction of tax may be claimed in respect of any person whom the individual maintains
at his own expense, and who is (i) a relative of his wife and incapacitated by old age or
infirmity from maintaining himself or herself (ii) his or his own wife’s widowed mother,
whether incapacitated or not or (iii) his daughter who is resident with him and upon whose
services he is compelled to depend by reasons of old age or infirmity.”
(from Newmark, 1988: 205)
214
This sentence is one legal article. It is unified and its clauses are interconnected and
interdependent. Consequently, breaking it down into short sentences is harmful to its meaning
which is intended to be taken as one unit. On the other hand, in legal English, such style of
long sentences is commonly used to avoid ambiguity, misinterpretation and addition of
anything extra to documents. For all these important functions, the same style requires to be
reflected in Arabic, as follows:
(ً) قريباً له أو لزوجته ومعاقا1( والذي يكون،ميكن املطالبة باقتطاع الضريبة بالنسبة ألي شخص يرعاه فرد ما على نفقته
)3( سواء أكانت معاقة أم غري ذلك أو،) والدته أو محاته األرملة2( بالشيخوخة أو العجز عن رعاية نفسه أو نفسها أو
)ابنته اليت تقطن معه واجملرب على االعتماد على خدماهتا ألسباب الشيخوخة واإلعاقة.
To sum up, the style of long sentences is preferably imitated in Arabic, because it has
important stylistic functions that are a part of the meaning of the text. On the other hand,
translating an English long sentence into an Arabic long one might be less problematic than
breaking it into short sentences. The major difficulty which is common to the previous
examples is the location of the main grammatical categories of the English sentence(i.e.
subject-verb-object/complement), to have a grammatical start for a proper Arabic sentence
type. The examples display three different possible sentence types: A prepositional phrase( يف
)حماولةfor (1); inna sentence( )إن اهلبوطfor(2); and a verbal sentence( )ميكن املطالبةfor (3) (see 1.7-
1.8 for more Arabic sentence types). Therefore, the students need not strain themselves
unnecessarily to change the style of sentencing. Rather, they look for the best possible start for
their sentences in Arabic.
Passive and active are two contrastive forms and styles. They have different functions.
Therefore, they should not be confused or ignored in the Arabic translation. There is a common
mistake of changing the passive into active by some Arab and Arabic speaking translators who
claim that Arabic is an active language, but English is passive. This is not confirmed about
Arabic language by any linguist/grammarian or language reference, as both passive and active
are used in all types of Arabic texts. This means that both styles have to be reflected in Arabic
translation for their important functions to the message. Here are examples:
At first sight, the two sentences have the same meaning. Yet, careful consideration shows
that they are different. That is, while the first is active, stating clearly the doer of the action of
killing (or the killers), the second is passive, hiding the killers. This makes a big difference in
that the active style aims at focusing on the murderers for human and political reasons, and is
215
expected to be used by Arab and anti-Jewish mass media, for instance. The passive style, on
the other hand, aims at concentrating on the result of the action and the action itself (i.e. the
five Palestinian children and killing them), hiding the identity of the killers, and at the same
time ignoring the killers as if they were unimportant, or suggesting that perhaps the murder was
committed by somebody else like, for instance, Palestinians killed Palestinians. Moreover, such
passive style is expected to be used by the Jews and pro-Jewish and zionist media.
These significant functions for each style require to be retained in Arabic in order that
meaning can be conveyed in full, as in the following versions:
The passive can be changed into active in one form which keeps the doer of the action
hidden: that is, the use of the verb of completion ()مت, followed by the noun of the main verbs of
the sentence, as follows:
This kind of passive active has the same functions of passive voice indicated above.
2. “You think perhaps that the university is a bastion of unshakable virtue? Tommyrot. We’re a
bit more civilized maybe, than the tribe at the gate. But like other communities, we have our
villains. What do you say to thieves in a university library? I mean people who steal purses,
wallets, watches, fountain pens. We have them”.
(op.cit: 141)
Obviously the tone is entirely and strongly active. It is used as a straightforward, sharp,
provocative, candid and aggressive style. It implies an invitation to some kind of action to be
taken. It is not advisable, then, to ignore these functions in the Arabic translation:
(كالتجمعات إال إننا.رمبا تظن أن اجلامعة معقل الفضيلة الراسخة؟ هراء! قد نكون أكثر حتضراً بقليل من رجل الشارع
وحمفظات، ماذا تقول عن لصوص مكتبة الجامعة؟ أقصد األشخاص الذين يسرقون أكياس النقود.األخرى لدينا أوغادنا
عندنا هؤالء. وأقالم احلبر، وساعات اليد،)اجليب.
The Arabic version is loyal to the active tone of the English text, which reflects the same
stylistic functions aimed at by the latter.
216
A version of the same text in the passive style will have different functions and at the
same time would give more illustrations about the previous active version:
3. “It might be thought, perhaps, that the university must be a bastion of unshakable virtue. The
supposition would be misguided. Academics may be considered a little more civilized than the
population at large. But wrongdoers are nonetheless to be found in the university as elsewhere.
Though theft from a university library might be judged quite inconceivable, valuables in the
form of purses, watches, wallets or fountain pens are stolen”:
(op.cit.)
The passive is dominant here, and, hence, the stylistic effects are not the same as those of
the active. That is, it charges the text with a kind of neutrality of attitude on the part of the
speaker. It helps him to be distant from being sharp and critical, which is typical of academic
dialogue. In other words, it is an indirect, polite style. These are good reasons for us to retain it
in Arabic as follows:
( قد ُيعتَرب األكادمييون أكثر حتضراً بقليل من عامة. لعل هذا االفرتاض مضلَّل.رمبا ُيظَن أن اجلامعة معقل الفضيلة الراسخة
فإن، فبرغم أن السرقة من مكتبة جامعية قد ال ٌتتَصور. لكن املخطئني مع ذلك موجودون يف اجلامعة ويف غريها.الناس
أو حمفظات جيب أو أقالم حبر، أو ساعات يد،سرق وتتمثل يف أكياس نقود َ ُ تb)األشياء الثمينة
(Passives are underlined).
By using passive style, the subjects (or the doers of the actions)are not mentioned, which
helps avoid embarrassing others or being embarrassed. This in turn supports the style of
indirectness aimed at by the passive here.
We may conclude that the two styles of passive and active are used in language to express
different stylistic functions and achieve different aims in relation to the message (Ghazala
(2007) points out thirteen functions for the active, and twenty seven functions for the passive in
language). If they are not two different styles, why are they used in language in the first place,
then? Therefore, the students of translation are recommended to insist on using the same
active/passive style of the English original in Arabic unless unavailable (e.g.
informal/colloquial written Arabic style).
217
3.9. Style of REPETITION AND VARIATION:
Many would think that repetition is a bad style and, therefore, has to be avoided in
translation. This is generally imprecise, for this style is a part of rhetoric, and can be used on
purpose to have important functions that affect the message considerably. The best examples
are available in abundance in the Holy Quran, the best language and style of any book on earth.
Hence, generalization about the style of repetition is unacceptable, as also illustrated in the
forthcoming discussion.
In a text where important words are repeated over and again, we are required to render
them fully into Arabic, however boring they might look to some. The writer of the English text
could be willing to repeat a word, or a phrase to reflect something important to the whole
message. The following examples illustrate the point:
1. “Football is the game my friend loves. Football is the sport he watches on the television.
Football is his favorite hobby. As a child, his dream was to play football as a professional
player. Here he is now a great football player”.
The key word of this passage is football. It is repeated in every sentence to be emphasised
and echoed in every part of the text. Also, it implies that football is everything in my friend’s
life, which is what the message of the whole text is about. For all these reasons, the Arabic
version has to produce the same repetition, as follows:
218
(b.املفضلة كرة القدم هي هوايته. كرة القدم هي الرياضة اليت يشاهدها على التلفاز.كرة القدم هي اللعبة اليت حيبها صديقي
ها هو ذا اآلن العب كرة قدم كبير. كان أمله أن يلعب كرة القدم كالعب حمرتف،)وكطفل.
It is not advisable to use variations on (القدم )كرة, because the text will lose its natural,
easy-going, fluent flow, and the important functions of ‘football’ will in effect disappear.
Instead, there would be a boring, awkward text and unclear stylistic functions, as the following
poor version may confirm:
(.املفضلة اللعبة األوىل يف العامل هي هوايته. إهنا الرياضة اليت يشاهدها على التلفاز.كرة القدم هي اللعبة اليت حيبها صديقي
ها هو ذا اآلن العب حمبوبة اجلماهري الكبير. كان أمله أن يلعب اللعبة الشعبية،)وكطفل.
The variations on (القدم )كرةare: the pronoun ( )هاin ()إهنا, ()اللعبة األوىل يف العامل, ()اللعبة الشعبية
and ( اجلماهريb)حمبوبة. Although they are favorable variations in Arabic, they do not have the same
effect of the repetitions of the head word (القدم )كرة.
2. “…It contained several large streets all very like one another, and many small streets still
more like one another, inhabited by people equally like one another, who all went in and out at
the same hour, with the same sound upon the same pavements, to do the same work, and to
whom everyday was the same as yesterday and tomorrow, and every year the counterpart of the
last and the next”.
(From Charles Dickens' Hard Times)
These repetitions (especially 2 and 3 )occur in the fifth chapter of the novel, Hard Times,
by the famous English novelist, Charles Dickens. It is about a town called ‘Coketown’ which is
described as lifeless, dead and unchangeable. These and other repetitions here are meant to
reflect the same atmosphere of lifeless, boring and hopeless town, people and everything else.
Everything and everybody in this town is the same as anything else and anybody else: no
difference, no change, no life. In other words, the style of repetition has the critical function of
reflecting as much as matching the contents of lifelessness and boredom of the chapter and
perhaps the whole novel. So it is unwise to ignore it in Arabic.
219
(أناس يقطنها،ً وشوارع صغرية كثرية يشبه الواحد منها اآلخر أيضا،تضمنت شوارع كبرية عدة يشبه الواحد منها اآلخر
ليقوموا بالعمل، على األرصفة نفسها، والصوت نفسه، دخلوا وخرجوا يف الساعة نفسهاb،يشبه الواحد منهم اآلخر كذلك
وكل سنة نفس الشيء كمثيلتيها املاضية واآلتية،ً وكل يوم بالنسبة هلم نفس الشيء كأمس وغدا،)نفسه.
It should be noted that every time the same word is repeated in the English text, the same
translation of it must be repeated in Arabic too. We need not use different translations for the
same word when used with the same meaning. The examples here and elsewhere in this work
illustrate this point. As for the last two informal translations of ‘same’ into ( )نفس الشيءin
Arabic, they are suggested to keep the word, 'same' in Arabc for its special importance. Yet,
they can be replaced by a variation(or a synonym) like ( )مثلor ( )يشبهas follows:
(...واآلتية وكل سنة تشبه مثيلتيها املاضية،ً)وكل يوم بالنسبة هلم مثل األمس وغدا.
So the students have two options. On the other hand, the last Arabic translation ( الشيء )نفس
is not mentioned in word in the original, but understood from ‘the counterpart’ ( )مثيل. All this
insistence on the use of ( )نفسwhenever possible in the passage is to reflect an effect in Arabic
that can be identical to that in English.
3. “Yes, yes, of course, I agree with you that we must cooperate, but on one condition, on one
condition: you work hard on the project. Otherwise, I I I work on my own, yes, on my own, do
you understand? on my own”.
In this text, which is a part of conversation, there are what might be described imprecisely
as ‘unnecessary repetitions’(underlined). That is, some words and phrases are repeated
unnecessarily, as the meaning is quite clear without repeating them. Yet, although such
repetitions are not required to help us understand the message, they are not used for no
purpose, but to achieve certain functions like:
1. Laying more emphasis on a word or a phrase (e.g. ‘yes’, ‘on one condition’,
‘on my own’).
2. Continuation of speech without stopping (e.g. ‘I’).
Even when the repetition is used for no good or special reasons, we are responsible for
transmitting it into Arabic. This makes the problem of translating it easy to tackle by the
students. Here is the Arabic translation:
( وإال.املشروع أن تعمل جبد يف: على شرط واحد، ولكن على شرط واحد، طبعاً أوافقك أننا جيب أن نتعاون، نعم،نعم
هل تفهم؟ مبفردي، مبفردي، نعم،)فأنا أنا أنا سوف أعمل مبفردي.
220
In fact, it is possible to dispose of all these repetitions with no great loss of meanimg, as
follows:
(املشروع أن تعمل جبد يف: ولكن على شرط واحد، طبعاً أوافقك أننا جيب أن نتعاون،نعم.
هل تفهم؟.)وإال فسوف أعمل بمفردي.
Yet, it is not a good suggestion to substitute repetitions for variations here, because they
may make the text unnatural and unfluent, as the following version shows:
( وإال.املشروع أن تعمل جبد يف: على أساس واحد، ولكن على شرط واحد، طبعاً أوافقك أننا جيب أن نتعاون، أجل،نعم
هل تفهم ؟ حلايل, لوحدي، بلى،)فأنا إنين إين سوف أعمل مبفردي.
This translation seems quite artificial, unconvincing and poor Arabic, in comparison to the
first version in particular. In fact, in natural conversation, such variations do not occur,
especially those on (()نعمi.e. أجل، )بلىand (( )أناi.e. إين،)إنين. Consequently, we'd better avoid
them in the Arabic translation.
The first version remains closer to the English original, then, as it reflects the same tone
and functions of the style of the latter.
In sum, the style of repetition would rather be rendered into Arabic, thus reflecting the
same effect of the original, and at the same time avoiding the problem of finding artificial
variations and synonyms, which might be awkward or hard to accept.
221
3.10. Style of REDUNDANCY:
1. “As a matter of fact to say the truth I have to say it frankly, I am not interested in
your offer”.
The underlined phrases have one and the same meaning. For convenience of easiness and
quickness of translation, such redundancy can be avoided in Arabic by translating only one of
the three expressions, as follows:
Yet, to reflect the function of politeness, hesitation and stammering of the redundant style
of the original, the students had better translate the three phrases into Arabic as follows:
222
2. “The economic policy of the new government is unacceptable completely, categorically and
in part and in toto”.
An acceptable, brief Arabic version is to use one word only for all the three underlined
ones as follows:
()السياسة االقتصادية للحكومة اجلديدة غري مقبولة برمتها.
However, the great emphasis intended by such redundancy in English is wasted in Arabic.
Therefore, an alternative, equally redundant Arabic version may reflect this important function
of emphasis, as the following version may point out:
(ً )مطلقاis stronger than ( )كليةwhereas (ًوتفصيال )مجلةis the strongest of all. (See the next
point for more details about this). Emphasis is well-expressed by these words in Arabic. We
may call this type of redundancy ‘emphatic redundancy’, which is important to reproduce in
translation.
3. “Ladies and gentlemen, first and foremost, I would like to thank the chairman for
giving me the floor at last, having been waiting for an hour or so”.
Redundancy here is the long, boring, undesirable way of starting a speech. The speaker
has chosen to begin with a long introduction instead of going directly to the point, namely,
being sharp and to the point. Therefore, one version of translation into Arabic could suggest the
disregard of redundancy completely:
This is the message here, but it does not reflect the insinuative, ironical and bad style of
the English original. A bad style should be transmitted as honestly as possible into a bad style,
not into a good style. There is no difference between the two styles to translators, for they
express the style of other people, not their own style. A back translation of this Arabic
translation into English will show how different it is from the original:
“Ladies and gentlemen , I thank the chairman for giving me the floor”.
This is a summary of the previous version. It is brief and written in a good style, whereas
the other is long, written in a bad style and has the function of irony. That is, the speaker is not
satisfied with the chairman because he ignored him for a long time. Thus, the retention of
redundancy in Arabic is required:
223
(ًأخريا أوالً وقبل كل شيء أود أن أشكر الرئيس على إعطائي الكلمة،ساديت وسيدايت،
ً)بعد انتظاري حوايل ساعة تقريبا.
(The underlined words and expressions imply irony).
4. “I am tired and fatigued. I spent last night studying and reading because I had to do a
difficult and hard assignment and homework, and was preparing myself for tests and
examinations”.
The five underlined phrases are redundant. Each is a pair of synonyms used unnecessarily
to reflect two main functions on the part of the speaker:
Redundancies here are for ‘self-correction’. That is, in each pair of words, the second
corrects the first and is, therefore, better, more expressive and more proper than it. In Arabic,
we may have two choices: one short, sharp and to the point, another long, redundant and
identical with the original:
1. (تدعى يف الربملانb فهو زعيم جمموعة. إنه دائماً يشن هجوماً شرساً على احلكومة وأتباعها.عضو الربملان ذاك متطرف
احلكومة إذ يعتربون أنفسهم مسؤولني عن الدفاع عن حقوق اجلماهير ضد مؤامرات.")"املدافعون عن احلقوق.
2. (ومؤيديها شرساً على احلكومة،ً يشن هجوماً شديدا، إنه دائماً يقود. متطرف،عضو الربملان ذاك متشدد،
224
، إذ يعتربون أنفسهم مسؤولني عن محاية." يف الربملان تدعى "املدافعون عن احلقوقb زعيم جمموعة، فهو رئيس.وأتباعها
مؤامرات احلكومة، اجلماهري ضد أالعيب،)الدفاع عن حقوق الشعب.
The former version concentrates on the second word of each pair, being stronger and
more expressive than the first. Also, it is fluent, good Arabic. Yet, it does not reflect the style
of redundancy of the original. The latter version, on the other hand, conveys all the
redundancies of the English text. It is an awkward, bad Arabic version. Nevertheless, it reflects
the style of redundancy of the original. Contrary to the former which is better than the original,
it is neither better nor worse than the original. It is as identical to it as possible. A little
improvement on the redundant version which makes it clearer and more acceptable in Arabic is
the addition of the correction word ( )بلbetween the two words of each of the redundant pairs,
as follows:
3. (احلكومة بل شرساً على،ً بل يشن هجوماً شديدا، فدائماً يقود. بل متطرف،عضو الربملان ذاك متشدد
إذ يعتربون أنفسهم." بل زعيم جمموعة يف الربملان تدعى "محاة احلقوق، فهو رئيس، بل وأتباعهاb،ومؤيديها
بل مؤامرات احلكومةb، بل اجلماهري ضد أالعيب، بل الدفاع عن حقوق الشعب،)مسؤولني عن محاية.
The use of ( )بلhas made the functions of self-correction, contrast and poweful meaning
clearer, and the whole version more readable than the second one. Having said that, there are
grammatical objections to the informality of the second and the third versions. That is, two
genitive nouns cannot follow one another in a row, as in ( مؤمراتb،أالعيب/ زعيم جمموعة،رئيس
الدفاع عن حقوق،محاية/)احلكومة. Formally ,they should be: ( احلكومةbأالعيب/رئيس جمموعة وزعيمها
محاية حقوق الشعب والدفاع عنها/)ومؤمراهتا.
Finally, the style of redundancy is regarded as a bad style of writing. Yet, in translation it
has to be reflected for two main reasons:
1. It may have an important function of emphasis, contrast, bad style, poor language, boring
text and/or speaker, or indirect, hesitant way of saying something.
225
3.11. EXPRESSIVITY , CONTEXT AND READERSHIP:
THE STYLE OF THE SHOW OF MUSCLES:
Sometimes, more than one equivalent can be available in Arabic for the same English
word, phrase or expression. But they may not fit equally in different linguistic/stylistic
contexts, because they have different degrees of expressivity. That is, one can be normal and,
therefore, is not suitable in a very formal and expressive context; whereas another may be too
strong and formal to be used in an ordinary text, or a text for children, for instance. In other
words, there can be a problem of confusing the use of the proper word in the proper context for
the proper readership.
The main reason behind such confusion of the context is the tendency towards using an
expressive, pompous translation, regardless of the style of the language of the text, context and
readership, in an attempt to show one's muscles ()استعراض عضالت, which is an artificial special,
pedantic skill in Arabic. The following examples illustrate this:
226
9. (الريح)ذهبت جهوده يف مهب.
10. () تبخرت جهوده يف اهلواء.
1. Normal language: (1, 2, 3): There is nothing special or metaphorical about the words
used. All of them are ordinary, common, easily understood and used by everyone.
2. Expressive language: (4, 5, 6)The words ()تثمر, ()تسفر, and ( )سدىgive more expressive
impetus to the translation than those of '1', because they are formal, rhetorical and
metaphorical.
3. Bombastic language: (7-10): This is indicated by the phrases: ()هباء منثورا, ()أدراج الريح, (
)يف مهب الريح, and (تبخرت يف اهلواء.). They are regarded as much more expressive and
pompous than those of '2' because they are:
Many students and translators prefer to use one of the last group, as a show of muscles.
This leads them to a misjudgement of types of readers, contexts and carelessness about
differences among these contexts. In other words, different contexts pose the problem of
choosing the more appropriate version for each one, as the same translation cannot fit in all
contexts. The following examples will illustrate the point:
2. “The new minister of economy did his best to improve the economic situation of the
country. But his efforts came to nothing”:
Here the first and perhaps the second groups only are suitable, because the context is
normal and language is ordinary Therefore, a pompous language of the third group does not fit
here. For example, to say ( )هباء منثوراis not expected in an economic text. It would be a
misplaced style, and no more than a show of muscles. Thus, a version like the following can be
what we expect:
1.(لكن/ لكنه مل يصل إىل نتيجة.عمل وزير االقتصاد اجلديد كل ما يف وسعه لتحسني الوضع االقتصادي للبلد
))جهوده مل تسفر عن شيء
227
3. “My fridge was faulty. The technician tried seven times to repair it. But, his efforts
came to nothing”.
Again, a technical text like this does not require a very strong, metaphorical language to
be used, because simple and/or technical language is usually difficult. Only group one of
ordinary, direct language can suit the context here. Any of the other two groups will look like a
big dress for a small thing:
(b) إال إن جهوده ضاعت دون نتيجة (إال إنه مل يصل إىل نتيجة. حاول الفين أن يصلحها سبع مراتb.)كانت ثالجيت معطلة.
4. “The peace mediator had three rounds of talks with officials from the two
neighbouring countries to stop war between them. Sadly, his efforts came
to nothing at the end”.
Here, the third group of bombastic language is quite plausible, for it is the best choice to
express the mediator’s great disappointment. The second group can also be acceptable.
However, the first is not advisable for it weakens the volume of the reaction of disappointment
implied. Thus, we may say the following in Arabic:
(جهوده هباء لألسف ضاعت. اجلارين إليقاف احلرب الدائرة بينهماbقام وسيط السالم بثالث جوالت حمادثات بني البلدين
باءت جهوده بالفشل) يف النهاية/)منثورا (تبخرت جهوده يف اهلواء.
5. “When she was a little child, she dreamed of a brilliant, bright future. She spent years
dreaming of blossoms and roses blooming her florescent future. To make this dream a
reality, she dedicated herself to story-writing to become a great novelist. But to her
surprise, she suffered utter failure at the very first attempt to publish her stories. She
was shocked at realizing that her painful efforts came to nothing”.
In such a metaphorical, literary text, we can use the most expressive and rhetorical words
and phrases possible in Arabic. Only group three above can fit here. The other two groups
would diminish expressivity in such a literary text. Hence this version:
(.الزاهر قضت السنوات حتلم باألزاهري والورود تنور مستقبلها. حلمت مبستقبل مشرق باهر،حني كانت طفلة صغرية
، ولدهشتها الشديدة، ولكنb. نذرت نفسها لكتابة القصص لتصبح روائية عظيمة،ولكي حُتَول هذا احللم إىل حقيقة واقعة
لقد صُعقت عند إدراكها أن جهودها املضنية تبخرت يف اهلواء.)أصيبت بفشل ذريع عند أول حماولة هلا لنشر قصصها.
Another remarkable show of muscles is in the translation of general texts for the public at
large. Here translators may use expressive, very formal words and expressions which are too
difficult for the laymen and not highly educated people to understand clearly and completely.
The best examples can be traced in the subtitled (or translated by writing) and doubled (or
translated orally) T.V. foreign series, films and programs. Translators tend to choose
228
ostentatious words at every possible opportunity in the text to show up their distinguished
knack in Arabic. This can be harmful to a translation forwarded to a public who mostly has an
average level of education and expects a simplified, easily understood and commonly used
standard Arabic (like the Arabic of good, quality newspapers). Here is a list of examples
illustrating the point, including the pompous words used and their ordinary, more appropriate
substitutes:
229
The list is very long indeed. (For more discussion of how to differentiate between
synonymous words like these, see 2.2. on ‘Synonymy’ above)
The problem becomes worse when the translated text is forwarded to children through
children’s T.V. programs and cartoons, for example. Children need a very simplified language.
Such a show of muscles’ translations are frequent and, therefore, spoil the original, do harm to
Arabic and create difficulties of understanding to children. Only with the aid of their educated
parents can they understand what they mean.
230
3.12. Style of NOMINALIZATION vs. VERBALIZATION:
The style of nominalization (or the use of nouns in preference to verbs) has the stylistic
function of injecting texts with abstraction, fixity and some kind of authority. On the other
hand, the style of verbalization (or the use of verbs in preference to nouns ) is an indication of
subjectivity, mobility and normality. The following examples give practical evidence for that
(each example is given in two versions: one nominalized, another verbalized to be compared
with one another):
1. “Registration at the university is the start of a long path into the unknown future. The
feeling of security in life is the main aim of many students. Also, the holding of a
university degree and the consideration of its holder among the highly educated, is a
valuable moral end for a great number of students”. (Nominalizations are
underlined)
Here is a suggested Arabic version, which reflects the style of nominalization of the
original:
1.(من فالشعور باألمان يف احلياة هدف رئيسي لكثري.التسجيل يف اجلامعة بداية طريق طويل يف املستقبل اجملهول
لعدد كبري غاية معنوية نفيسة، كما أن َحمْل شهادة جامعية واعتبار حاملها من بني األشخاص رفيعي الثقافة.الطلاب
)من الطلاب.
Obviously, the Arabic version has no one single verb; all sentences are nominal (i.e. topic
and comment each). This style gives the text a sense of formality, objectivity and
generalizations in the form of statements and axioms about facts of life, which accept no
argument or refusal. That means they are authoritative statements which are universal facts. A
verbalized version of the same text will have different functions and effects in both Languages,
English and Arabic, as follows:
2. “To register at the university is to start a long path into a future you do not know. To
feel secure in life is what many students mainly aim at. Also, to hold a university
degree and to consider its holder among the people who have high education is what a
great number of students take as a valuable, moral end”.
(The verbalized nominalizations of ‘1’ are underlined)
2. (ما يهدف فأن تشعر باألمان يف احلياة و.أن تسجل يف اجلامعة يعين أن تبدأ طريقاً طويالً يف مستقبل ال تعرفه
أن َتحمل شهادة جامعية وأنْ ُيعترب حاملها من بني األشخاص الذينْ كما،إليه بشكل رئيسي كثري من الطلاب
هو ما يتخذه عدد كبري من الطلاب كغاية معنوية نفيسة،)ميلكون ثقافة رفيعة.
231
Verbalizations in both languages have changed the tone of the message into some
informality, subjectivity and absence of authority. The text has become closer and more
intimate to the reader who would feel that the statements are directed to him personally in a
straightforward way. This makes his reaction different from that to the nominalized version.
This nominalized version is abstract and not quite vivid. It is written in a routine
philosophical style with the main aim of sending information to patients, but with no intention
to urge them to exert great efforts in the process. These are sufficient justifications for us to
render this nominalized style into Arabic as follows:
3.(النهائي يف واملؤدي إىل االكتشاف،نصح فرويد مرضاه بسبر منظم وشاق ألعماق الذاكرة
)الالشعور لألصول املعتمة لالضطراب العصيب.
The only verb used in this version is ( )نصحas a matching translation for ‘recommended’,
the only verb in the English origin too.
A verbalized version, on the other hand, has different reflections on the message. That is,
it is less abstract and more vivid than the nominalized version. It is written in an incitative
style, aiming at engaging patients directly and heavily in more than one process. That is, they
are urged to get through a process of four stages:
1. “to reach”
2. “to thread”
3. “to ransack”
4. “to discover”
On the other hand, whereas the nominalized version is direct and plain language, the
verbalized version is largely metaphorical with regard to verbs in particular, which are all
metaphors. Here is a verbalized version of the above nominalized one:
4. “ Freud encouraged his patients to reach into memory, thread with infinite care its
troubled maze, methodically ransack the cluttered chambers of the mind, and in that
groping fashion at last discover the corner from which neurosis darkly sprang”.
(op .cit.).
232
1.“profoundly painstaking and systemic investigation of the depths of the
memory”→ “reach into memory … thread with infinite care … methodically
ransack”.
2. “the eventual discovery in the unconscious”→ “in that groping fashion at last
discover” .
4. ( بشكل وأن يتمحصوا، وأن يشقُّوا بعناية فائقة متاهته املعقدة،حث فرويد مرضاه على أن يتوغلوا داخل الذاكرة
اليت انبثق منهاb وأن يكتشفوا كذلك بطريقة البحث هذه الزاوية املظلمة،منظم جتاويف العقل املتزامحة
)االضطراب العصيب.
Here are the two Arabic nominalized and verbalized versions juxtaposed:
1. (..."يشقوا وأن،بسرب منظم وشاق ألعماق الذاكرة" ← "أن يتوغلوا داخل الذاكرة...،
وأن يتمحصوا...")
2. ("واملؤدي إىل االكتشاف النهائي يف الالشعور" ← "وأن يكتشفوا كذلك...")
3. ("األصول املعتمة لالضطراب العصيب" ←"الزاوية املظلمة اليت انبثق منها...")
Clearly, both Arabic versions are identical with their English parallels, so that they reflect
identical stylistic functions. It does not matter whether the same number of nouns and verbs are
used in Arabic; what matters is to insist on reflecting the two styles of nominalization and
verblization in it.
In short, nominalization and verbalization are two different styles. Each implies specific
functions that do not have the same impact on, and relationship with the message as well as the
readers. Therefore, both styles need to be retained in Arabic. Ignoring them would render
meaning incomplete and the reaction to it different.
233
Chapter Three
STYLISTIC PROBLEMS
The third set of the problems of translation is stylistic problems. They are important to
discuss on the grounds that style is relevant to meaning. That is, in today's studies, style is
viewed as a part of meaning and affects it in different ways and to different degrees. So, a
change of style means a change of meaning of some kind. Style is no longer seen as irrelevant
to meaning, separeted from it, or the dress that has nothing to do with it. Meaning was claimed
to stand on its own, unaffected by that dress. Nowadays, style has been given special attention
and is regarded as a part and parcel of meaning. If we attend to it, we attend to meaning in full;
if we ignore it, we ignore at least one part of meaning. Hence, its significance in translation is
worth discussing. Here is an illustrative example to confirm the importance of style and how
relevant it is to meaning. The following statements express the same idea of death:
According to the traditional concept of style, all these statements from 'a-g' express the
same idea of the death of 'her father', and that is the important thing about it. Therefore, they
are all translated into one and the same version in Arabic (i.e.)مات والدها أمس. It does not matter,
then, whether 'her father' died naturally, unnaturally, honourably or dishonourably, got killed,
hanged, died in the battlefield or in bed, out of illness or in a car accident. What matters is that
he is dead now.
This argument cannot be accepted for the cause of death is extremely crucial to both the
dead person and to his family. That is, a natural death is quite normal and, hence, acceptable to
people, whereas an unnatural death caused by killing and premeditated murder is quite serious,
unacceptable and has dire consequences to people, dead and alive. It makes a big difference to
talk about a dead man with respect, or with no respect. By the same token, describing a dead
peson as a martyr is not the same like describing him as 'killed' or just 'dead'. Thus, it is not
234
acceptable to translate all the previous sentences into one and the same Arabic version of
translation, as above. Rather, each one has its own translation that is stylistically and
semantically different from the rest, as demonstrated below:
There are considerable stylistic differences among these versions: (a) is normal, natural
and neutral death; (b) is abnormal, unnatural and despicable crime; (c) is a murder from
behind; (d) is humorous, unfavourable and colloquial; (e) is agreeable and respectful of the
dead; (f) is religious and sublime; and (g) is informal and unagreeable. Consequently, these
differences are differences of meaning and effect and, therefore, have to be taken into account
in translation.
235
(1981), Carter (ed) (1982), Carter and Burton (eds.) (1987), Carter and Long (1987), Ghazala
(1987, 1994/ 1999, 2011, 2012a and 2012c); Fabb et al (eds.) (1987), Wales (1989), Carter and
Nash (1990), Durant et al (1990), Bradford (1997), Thornborrow et al (1998), Toolan (1998),
(Simpson (2004), (Boase-Beier (2006), Jeffries (2010) and many others.
The question now: Shall we retain the style of the English text? or change it into an
equivalent Arabic style? The answer is: Generally, we keep the English style in Arabic when
possible. However, when not possible, or when an equivalent Arabic style is available, we
translate the English style into it. In all cases, the style of the Arabic translation depends on,
and is derived from the style of the English original. This leads to suggest 'Stylistic
Equivalence', which is the proper choice of the style of the TL text (i.e. Arabic ), based on that
of the SL text (i.e. English), unless unavailable or unadvisable in the TL (e.g.
informal/colloquial style is not a part of written formal Arabic. See below). By this, emphasis
is laid on both styles of English and Arabic. How and when to apply that in translation will be
illustrated in the numerous examples given in the following discussion of the main stylistic
problems of translation, associated with their possible solutions, starting with the style of
formality and informality.
236
In 1962, Joos suggested a scale of five ‘styles’ (or tones) of English language, which is
general but proved to be widely acceptable by most people.
Examples:
1. Frozen formal
1. FORMAL
2. Formal
3. Informal
4. Colloquial 2. INFORMAL
5. Vulgar (slang)
Such shortened classifications are come across in some language references (e.g.
Longman Dictionary of English Idioms, Collins and Websters English Dictionaries). Some of
these references use 'colloquial' or 'slang' instead of 'informal'.
(b) Sometimes it is difficult to draw a clear-cut line between the following four pairs:
237
‘frozen formal and formal’; ‘formal and informal’; ‘informal and colloquial’; ‘colloquial and
slang’. Some English words and grammatical constructions come at the borderline. For
example, ‘idioms and phrasal verbs’ are classified either as formal or informal, or both;
grammatical contractions like ‘can’t’, ‘don’t’, ‘haven’t’, etc. are considered by some as
informal, and by others as colloquial. The most widespread difficulty of distinction is that
between formal and informal styles of language.
Yet, despite the difficulty and personal nature of the distinction between these five styles
of English language, we can understand and apply them in general terms. Moreover they are
helpful, and sometimes decisive to meaning in translation, as demonstrated in ‘c’.
(c) Although the message of all the statements in the example is the same in Arabic (i.e. )اجلس,
each statement has different effects and, hence, meaning. ‘1’ is so official and/or impolite, said
by a harsh person, or a man of a high position (i.e. a king, a president, a minister, a manager, a
boss, etc.) to strangers and ordinary people; whereas ‘2’ is official, yet polite, used in a similar
context to that of ‘1’, but to friends and personal acquaintances . Moreover, it can imply that a
person is polite. ‘3’ is not official and more polite than ‘1’ and ‘2’ (the informal use in Arabic
is ( )لو مسحتwhich is between formal and colloquial), but ‘4’ is quite friendly, intimate and so
kind (in Arabic: (اسرَت يح/)اسرْت يح, ( )اسرْت يَّحand ( )ارتاحin particular reflect a colloquial tone) ‘5’ on
the other hand, is strong and rude in both languages (although in Arabic it can be said
humorously to a close friend).
Clearly, these five tones cannot be interchangeable in social relations among people. That
is, we do not say to a stranger ‘feel at home’ ()خذ راحتك, nor to a friend ‘be seated’ ( عليك/اجلس
)باجللوس, nor to a respected person ‘sit bloody down’ ()انقرب يف مكانك. Confusing these terms in
such a way will result in serious mistakes in translation, and serious situations among
individuals. Hence the importance of reserving them in translation into Arabic.
Having said that, the students are not advised to use the last two tones (i.e.colloquial and
slang) in Arabic. Instead, they resort to the so-called ‘Modern Standard Arabic (MSA)’, which
is the written Arabic of today (see below). That is, we may say ( )خذ راحتكonly for ‘4’, and (اقعد
)يف أرضكfor instance, for ‘5’.
The students, therefore, do not need to imitate all the English styles in Arabic. The main
reason is that there are usually four styles only in Arabic:
1. Classical Arabic (i.e. the language of the Holy Quran, the Prophet's Tradition and
classical literature ).
2. Modern Standard Arabic (MSA) (i.e. the formal written Arabic of today).
238
3. Colloquial Arabic (i.e. the language of conversation).
4. Vulgar (or slang) Arabic (i.e. the very local, unkind and/or bad language).
The English styles can be translated into these Arabic styles as follows:
(English) (Arabic)
2. Formal } → MSA
3. Informal
The most familiar styles/tones in Arabic are the formal and the colloquial ones, used in
general terms to cover the four styles above as follows:
There is a considerable problem for the students to distinguish between these styles,
especially in English and partly in Arabic, with regard to the differentiation between Classical
Arabic and MSA in particular. The good solution to this problem is to minimize the English
styles to one general style in Arabic, that is, Modern Standard Arabic, at early stages in
particular. The reason for choosing the MSA is that it is the middle ground among Arabic
styles: simple, easy, more acceptable, polite , known, popular,understandable and available to
the students at different levels of English. Thus, back to the example above, they can translate
the five statements into ()اجلس, which is the message in MSA, when it is difficult to imitate all
of these tones in Arabic. Although this translation ignores style, it is an acceptable solution to
such a problem of formality and informality of language and style.
The problem of formality scale appears in certain texts such as spoken English and texts of
general nature which are generally informal, whereas scientific, legal and most of literary texts,
for instance, are formal. Here are two examples for both types:
Example 1: A general text:
239
"You can’t paint watercolours without knowing how to lay a wash, though anyone can learn
the knack if they are willing to go to a bit of trouble. People have their own fads about the drill,
but my method seems to work as anyone’s." (Nash, 1980: 128-9)
a. The use of the second person pronoun style in words like ((ميكنك-ترسم-ك
ْ َمعر ْفت
ْ
b. The use of such words as (ك )دو ْن, ()الوقوع يف مشكل, ()شطارة, ( )مراقand ()كِيف
ْ َمعر ْفت
ْ
c.The disregard of the concord between singular ( )أي واحدand the plural of verb()كانوا يريدون.
d.The ignorance of standard word order .
e The vowelless stopping at the end of words by omitting vowelization / vocalization,
namely, stopping on ()سكون.
f.The use of singular form of ( )مراقهمinstead of the plural form ()مراقاهتم
It is not necessary to translate the English informal features into the same Arabic
equivalents, because it is not advisable nor possible to do so. Moreover, some of these features
(such as ‘can’t’) have no equivalents in Arabic. Rather, alternative features are used elsewhere
by way of compensation (e.g. ignorance of standard vocalization )تشكيل. After all, it is not
required to have the same number of the English informal features in Arabic, but to use some
informal expressions here and there in Arabic, if and when possible, that are suggestive of
informal style.
Another possible, easier version for the students in particular is the use of MSA as
follows:
240
(إذا
رغم أن أي واحد يستطيع أن يتعلم هذه الشطارة،ال ميكنك أن ترسم باأللوان املائية دون معرفتك كيف حتضر األلوان
للناس أمزجتهم اخلاصة يف التمرين ولكن مزاجي يبدو فعالًا كما هي أمزجة اآلخرينb.)كان يريد الوقوع يف مشكلة
Although this version can be safe and popular among the students, the previous informal
one is admittedly more precise and expressive of the important function of the English informal
style, which is intimate, direct, clear and simple.
“A great deal of interest has been generated recently in calcium mainly because of the role it
plays in the incidence of osteoporosis. At present some 35 to 40 per cent of women aged 65 in
the UK suffer from fractures of the forearm, femur or vertebrae as a result of osteoporosis”.
(From Health Express, July 1987)
(مرض نظراً للدور الذي يلعبه بشكل رئيسي يف حدوث،َتَوّلد يف اآلونة األخرية قدر كبري من االهتمام يف الكالسيوم
باملئة من النساء يف اململكة املتحدة من كسور يف الذراع أو عظم40 إىل35 هذا ويعاين اآلن حوايل.هشاشة العظام/لني
)الفخد أو الفقرات نتيجة هلشاشة العظام.
English scientific and technical texts are always formal in style, to imply seriousness,
conservatism and internationality. Consequently, the Arabic version should be formal, without
colloquial features being used, so that it reflects the same function of the original. Thus, a
translation using some informal features (like version 2 below) is rejected completely in
Arabic, because it seems strange and funny, giving the impression of a jocular, ironical
atmosphere of a serious English original:
Here are the underlined informal features with their formal equivalents:
1. (ٌتركيز كبري
ٌ حصل بري
ْ تركيز ْك
ْ حصل ْ )
َ
2. (الذي )اللي
241
3. (يعاين )بيعاين
4. (النساء من )من احلرمي
5. (الاليت )اللي
6. (جتاوزن )جتاوزوا
ِ ِب
7. (bنتيجة/سبب سبب
ْ ْ)ب
This version is a failure in style/tone, and affects the meaning of the whole text
negatively, making it abnormal. Therefore, the students are advised to ignore it and, instead,
concentrate on the first version, whose formal tone is the only acceptable one in Arabic. This
means that the informal version is problematic and should be avoided. Its only advantage is to
stand in contrast with the first one, which allows the students to notice the difference between
an acceptable, normal, formal and serious version (i.e. ‘1’) and an unacceptable, abnormal
informal and funny one (i.e. ‘2’).
On the other hand, it is not necessary to match every English informal feature with an
Arabic equivalent one. One or two token features of informal Arabic are sufficient to suggest
the informal tone of the English informal original, as shown in the previous examples.
However, some English texts (i.e. scientific)are formal only and, therefore, do not create a
problem of tone, because they have to be translated into MSA only. Any use of colloquial
Arabic in the translation of such texts will be poor, misplaced and, hence, unacceptable.
It is hoped that the discussion of the importance of the different stylistic tones in both
languages will invite the students to attend to them in some texts, and try to take them into
consideration as much as possible. However, the situation in English is different from that in
Arabic in this respect. That is, English allows more space for using informal features in writing
than Arabic which makes a clearcut distinction between formal written Arabic and informal
spoken Arabic. It remains to point out that these tones are marked either at the level of
grammar, or words , or at both levels.
3.2. Style of FRONTING:
Fronting (or 'foregrounding') is an important stylistic device , used widely at both the
sentence and text levels. It means to move a word, a phrase or a clause from its original place
in the middle or at the end of a sentence to the beginning (or the front position) of that
sentence. This can be understood by recognizing the normal word order in English language.
242
That is, a declarative sentence has the following normal order: ‘Subject-Verb-
Object/Complement’ When a sentence starts with an object, this object is fronted: e.g.: ‘Allah
she worshipped’, instead of: ‘She worshipped Allah’. Likewise, a complement is usually
positioned after the verb: e g ‘In my room he slept’, instead of: ‘he slept in my room’( نام يف
)غرفيت.
As to clauses, the normal clause order in English is the main clause, first, then the
subordinate clause: When the subordinate clause is put before the main clause, it is fronted: e.g.
“As he had been caught red-handed, the criminal was sentenced to death”.
(subordinate clause) (main clause)
Such frontings are not made by chance, but for good reasons. That is, the fronted words or
clauses have a more important function of emphasis, etc. than the other parts of the sentence.
This means that they play a vital role in understanding meaning. Therefore, they must be taken
into consideration in Arabic as follows:
Both the glorified ()اهلل, and ( )يف غرفيتare not in their normal positions in Arabic, yet they
have to be in such a position to reflect the same function of emphasis and surprise aimed at in
the English original.
243
The second clause is conditioned by the first. This is a good reason for fronting the latter,
despite being subordinate. In Arabic, this order should be retained to convey the same
condition, as confirmed by the version here.
Fronting is used not only at the sentence level, but also at the text level. Consider the
following example:
“Round a centrally-placed coffee-table there are three armchairs. To the left of the fireplace is
an alcove with built-in bookshelves. To the right, a table carrying a television set. Against the
wall facing the fireplace stands an upright piano’.
(From Nash, op.cit.: 10)
The underlined adverbial phrases are moved from their back positions at the ends of
sentences to a fronted position at the beginning. By this, they are emphasised strongly.
Moreover, they are put at the head of sentences to replace first, second, etc., as and at the same
time direct attention to certain things in the room in order. These functions are important to
undertand the message, and, hence, should not be ignored in the Arabic version (the equivalent
fronted Arabic phrases are underlined):
( طاولة.املوقد فجوة فيها رفوف كتب إىل اجلهة اليسرى من.يوجد ثالثة كراسي حول طاولة صغرية متمركزة يف الوسط
ينتصب بيانو عمودي على احلائط مقابل املوقد.)عليها جهاز تلفاز إىل اجلهة اليمىن.
In this version, there is nothing unusual about the underlined phrases, which does not
reflect the spirit and the emphasis of the original. In other words, a part of the message and
style will be lost. Therefore, it is not a favorable version.
When two structures are identical to one another, they are described as parallel. Such
parallelism can be important to meaning, implying a balance between two or more messages: e
g.
244
1. “My father is ill. My mother is sad. My sister is worried”
The structures of these three short sentences are parallel, as shown below
These sentences are well-balanced, not only in structure but also in meaning. That is,
when my father fell ill, my mother felt sad for him, and my sister was worried about him, or
about both. In other words, at the time my father fell ill, my mother was sad and my sister
worried. Also it can imply that my father’s illness is in parallel with my mother’s sadness and
my sister’s worry. All these are good reasons to insist on reflecting the same style of
parallelism in the Arabic translation, without changing anything in the structures of the
sentences: ( أخيت قلقة. أمي حزينة.) والدي مريض
It should be noted that if there is a change of the parallel grammatical structure of the
English original in Arabic (as the case here), we have to produce parallelism in the new Arabic
grammatical structures of sentences.
2. “I always advise my brother not to get nervous when he is dejected. He usually wants me not
to be passive when he is angry. Both of us often ask our parents not to be worried when we are
different”.
3. when he is dejected
when he is angry adv.+S+V+C(adj.)
245
when we are different
Such parallelism has the function of balancing and counter-balancing the three
interconnected parts of the message. That is, the first sentence is the advice, the second is the
reaction to it, the third is the bringing of both closer to one another. Also, they are made equal
in weight; neither outweighs the other. Therefore, we have to reserve parallelism in Arabic as
follows (each clause is translated individually first, for clarification, followed by the whole
translation):
1. I always advise my brother (ً)أنصح أخي دائما
not to get nervous (ًعصبيا )أال يكون
when he is dejected (ً)عندما يكون مكتئبا
3. Both of us often ask our parents (ما يرجو والديه ً)كالنا غالبا
not to be worried ()أال يكونا قلقني
when we are different ()عندما نكون خمتلفَني
The difference in word order is unimportant. What is important is to retain the word class
(i e noun → noun, adjective → adjective, etc.) of the original in Arabic, and to use a
parallel Arabic word order. Here is the Arabic translation in full:
(.ًغاضبا يريدين عادة أال أكون سلبياً عندما يكون.ًأنصح أخي دائماً أال يكون عصبياً عندما يكون مكتئبا
)كالنا غالباً ما يرجو والديه أال يكونا قلقني.
246
another. These functions are vital to the message, and, hence, are extremely important to retain
in translation. Usually a clear message should be conveyed. Here are examples, starting with
the most famous ones of syntactic ambiguity:
Neither of these two meanings is clearly stated in the sentence. Therefore, the same
ambiguity should be kept in the Arabic translation, and the word ( )صيدgives the required sense
here.
Similarly, ‘flying’ has two senses here (as a noun) and as an adjective (2):
3. “I smell a rat in what you say” : (فيما تقول )يلعب الفار يف عيّب
‘Smell a rat’ is an idiom that means ‘doubtful’. But the latter is straightforward whereas
the former is not. Therefore, in Arabic we look for an indirect equivalent such as the translation
suggested above. However, when there is a problem finding the most suitable version, the
students can resort to other phrases which are equally unclear such as ( رائحة مكيدةb)أشتم. If the
problem persists, they may use direct phrases like ( )تساورين شكوك, ( )أشكetc. but with a loss of
effect, though.
4 “The teacher’s method of teaching is a show of muscles”:
(للعضالت )طريقة األستاذ يف التدريس استعراض.
‘A show of muscles’ may not be quite clear, and, hence, should be translated into an
unclear Arabic phrase such as that suggested here. Straightforward translations like( تظاهر
ُ ), (تفاخ
ُ
247
)ر, ()مباهاة, etc. are acceptable, but not favorable because they distort the ambiguous style of a
beautiful expression in both Languages, English Arabic.
5. “John went to the bar to bury his sorrows”: (أحزانه )ذهب جون إىل احلانة ليدفن
In western non-Muslim culture, a miserable person may go to the bar and drink wine to
get drunk in order to forget his distress and troubles. In Arabic, Muslim culture, however, a
distressed person does not do that, because drinking wine is a sin. Instead, he prays to God
either at home, or in the mosque. Therefore, the above translation can be ambiguous to many.
However, the students are advised to keep this cultural ambiguity to give the chance to Arab
readers to know about one aspect of western culture. Simultaneously, teachers may explain the
cultural differences between the two cultures, in the same way as done here.
To conclude, ambiguity is a main stylistic device used to play a decisive role in the
understanding of the message. It can be syntactic (examples 1+2), lexical (3+ 4)or cultural (5).
When finding it difficult to translate into Arabic, the students are recommended to consult a
good reference or authority to solve it by disambiguating it, or, more advisably, by preserving
it.
Complexity of style can be dominant in a text to achieve a function of some kind, which
has impact on meaning. The same kind of style can render the same function and effect in
Arabic translation. Otherwise, meaning will be incomplete. Here are examples:
1. “Knowing how popular Robin Hood was among the common people and how he could
always slip quietly away into Sherwood forest where his pursuers would be hampered by their
248
ignorance of the terrain and their inablility to adapt to the conditions of guerrilla warfare, the
sheriff decided to take no immediate action”.
(op.cit.: 113)
The complexity of style is because the whole text is one single sentence which is
composed of several interconnected fronted subordinate clauses, followed by the main clause
in a final position, as the following analysis shows:
Apart from lexical problems like the translation of ‘hampered’, ‘terrain’, ‘guerrilla
warfare’, the difficulty for the students is in how to follow up and understand the complexity of
the sentence in Arabic, considering the delayed main verb and subject ( )قرر الشريفto the last
position in the sentence. The solution is to analyse the sentence into its constituent clauses in
English -as done above- and then start translating a clause by clause, with concentration on the
right start of the sentence(i.e. مبا أنه كان (يدرك/ًعاملا/ًعارفا/ًمدركا... and the proper grammatical
connection among them(see 1.10-1.17 earlier). Each clause should be in Arabic in the same
position ordered in the English original, producing an identical complexity. Such complexity is
syntactic (or grammatical).
2. “A still new patient, a thin and quiet person, who had found a place with his fianceé at the
good Russian Table, proved, just when the meal was in full swing, to be epileptic, as he
suffered an extreme attack of that type, with a cry whose demonic and inhuman character has
often been described, fell heavily on the floor and struck around with his arms and legs next to
his chair with the most ghastly contortions”.
(From Newmark, 1988: 25)
This text is one single sentence with one a subject, a main verb and an object. The first
problem to be solved by the students of translation is to locate these three major grammatical
categories of the sentence. Then, and only then can they understand its grammatical
complication, and translate it correctly. A misunderstanding of grammar will lead to mistakes
249
in translation. The other point of complication is the use of three main verbs added to one
another and separated by insertions in between. Also, complexity is caused by insertions
among the subject, the main verb(s)and the object of the sentence. The whole sentence reads as
follows:
" على الطاولة الروسيةb، وجد مكاناً مع خطيبته اليت كانت باملثل هادئة هزيلة، شخص هادئ وهزيل،مريض صامت جديد
مع صرخة، حيث عاىن من نوبة حادة من ذاك النوع، أنه مصاب بالصرع، أثبت حني كانت الوجبة يف أوجها،المحرتمة
سقط بقوة على األرض وختبط بيديه ورجليه مبحاذاة، غالباً ما ُوصفت أهنا شيطانية وغري إنسانية
كرسيه مع تشنجات مروعة."
Complexity is retained in Arabic because it is important to reflect the message. That is,
the whole sentence is about an abnormal, epileptic, complicated person. This message is put in
a complicated style of grammar. A complex style matches a complex person, so to speak.
Therefore, changing the complex grammatical structure of the original into an easy one in
Arabic is unsuitable, and mismatches the message. In any case, it is quite difficult to change
the complexity of style into an easy style in Arabic. If we try hard, to do so, a considereble
proportion of meaning and stylistic functions would be distorted.
The same point can be said of the complexity of the following text (taken from James
Joyce’s short story, The Sisters):
3. “It may have been these constant showers of snuff which gave his ancient priestly garments
their green faded look for the red handkerchief, blackened, as it always was, with the snuff-
stains of a week, with which he tried to brush away the fallen grains, was quite inefficacious”.
The Sisters is a story about paralysis and paralysed people. The grammatical structure of
this sentence is not smooth; on the contrary, it is quite complex to follow. By this, it resembles
the paralysed priest who the sentence is about. It is as untidy as the blackened handkerchief of
the priest. Thus, a paralysed structure is parallel with the condition of the paralysed priest.
These functions are good reasons for us to reflect the same style of complexity of this
sentence in Arabic as follows:
"املنديل
... ألن،السَعط هي اليت صبغت ثيابه الكهنوتية بلون أخضر داكن
َّ رمبا كانت هذه الرزازات املستمرة من جراء
كان عدمي، والذي حاول أن يزيل به الحبيبات الساقطة، ببقع السعط ملدة أسبوع،ً كما كانت حاله دائما،األمحر املسَْوَّد
الفائدة على اإلطالق."
250
The complication is in the second half of the sentence (i.e. ‘for the red … inefficacious ‘(
على اإلطالق... )ألن املنديلas follows:
The point about complication here can be made clearer by comparing this complex part
of the sentence to a hypothetical easy one, where clauses follow one another normally and
fluently, as follows:
“ …for the handkerchief was quite inefficacious as it was blackened with the snuff-stains of a
week and was used by him trying to brush away the fallen grains”.
This version is easier to follow and understand than the complicated Joycean origin. Yet,
it is not what the writer writes, and does not fit with a message about paralysis. In other words,
an easy style does not replace a complicated style, as each one has different functions and
reflects different messages.
4. “It is the very first really reliable do-it-yourself fibreglass sailing dinghy with oars and a full
suit of sails”:
(Nash: 1980: 66)
The complexity of this sentence is in the difficulty of finding the head word of the very
long complement. It also lies in the complicated modification. However, solving the first
251
problem is more urgent and vital than the second which can be solved by consulting a
dictionary. When the students know that the head word of the complement is ‘dinghy’, they
can start translating and solving the problem of complexity here. Here is a suggestion:
(من األشرعة )إنه حقاً قارب اإلحبار الزجاجي الليفي األول املصنوع يدوياً املتني مبجاديف وطاقم كامل
The complexity of the Arabic version is clear, caused by the follow-up of adjectives and
adverbs in particular without a stop, using no commas or the conjunction of addition, ‘and’ ( )و
which makes the translation more comfortable and fluent:
(األشرعة مبجاديف وطاقم كامل من، واملتني،ً)إنه حقاً قارب اإلحبار الزجاجي الليفي األول واملصنوع يدويا
However, it is not advisable to make this long, complex sentence into simple short
sentences, because it provides an interconnected, compact description of one and the same
thing (i.e. ‘dinghy’), which should be considered and taken as one inseparable unit. Hence, it is
not preferable to have such a version as the following:
(كامل وهو مبجاديف وطاقم. فهو مصنوع يدوياً ومتني.إنه حقاً قارب اإلحبار الزجاجي الليفي األول
)من األشرعة
5. “Why do you think we make Nuttall’s Mintoes such a devilishly smooth cool creamy minty
chewy round slow velvety fresh clean solid buttery taste?”:
(From Crystal and Davy: 1969)
(بطيء خمملي بارد قشدي نعناعي مضغي دائريbملاذا تظن أننا جنعل مينتوز ناتال ذات مذاق شيطاين سلس
)طازج نظيف متني ُزْبدي؟
The Arabic version has exactly the same style of complexity of the original, including the
absence of commas among adjectives. Complexity is the result of thirteen successive adjectives
for one and the same noun (i.e. ‘taste’( )مذاق. The problem of translating them can be solved by
taking care of their meanings and proper grammatical forms in Arabic. Complexity should,
therefore, be retained because this long stretch of adjectives is inseparable in its description of
the ‘taste of Nuttal’s Mintoes ’(i.e. mint’s chewing gum علك النعناع/ لبان:) which has these
properties together and at the same time. Any separation between them would damage the
purpose of the whole advertisement.
252
The style of complexity, then, has to be reflected in Arabic, without any attempt to
simplify it, because it has specific functions which cannot be expressed by a simple or any
other style. These functions are relevant to meaning and, therefore, should not be ignored.
The normal, unmarked style of sentences is those of medium length. However, short and
long sentences are two marked styles that have different functions and implications in relation
to meaning.
The style of short sentences, to start with, can be dominant in the English text. If so, the
Arabic translation needs to be so. More than one reason can be behind that, as the next two
examples prove:
1. “The police heard a little noise inside the bank. The robber noticed that. He wanted to
escape. The police chased him. Pedestrians noticed the scene. One of them shouted at the
robber. Another blocked his way. Then, the police arrived and arrested him”:
The style of short sentences here has an important function. It heightens the tempo of
action in this text which is written in the form of a story. It accelerates events and arouses
suspense. Maybe it is the only type of style which reflects this function of acceleration that can
be sensed at reading the text aloud and quickly. Thus, this style has to be reproduced in the
Arabic translation to keep this function:
253
(.املشهد املارة
ّ الحظ. طاردته الشرطة. أراد أن يهرب. الحظ اللص ذلك.مسعت الشرطة جلبة خفيفة داخل املصرف
حينئذ وصلت الشرطة واعتقلته. قام آخر بسد طريقه. باللصbصاح أحدهم.)
No cohesive devices like ( و، )فare used in this version. This reflects the follow-up of
events a stage by stage. It is not advisable to write the text in one long sentence for it has a
different function, as the next section will confirm.
2. “Middle age is a time of despair. Few men like themselves when they are fifty. The young
are engaged with their own images. The old are rapt in selfhood. Only a middle-aged man
dislikes what he sees in the mirror. He sees failure. And he knows he has to live with it. Young
men hope, because they dare. Old men forgive themselves, because they must. But a middle-
aged man knows neither hope nor reconciliation. He knows only the burden of responsibility.
He is responsible for the life he has made. He cannot plead excuses or look for sympathy”.
(Nash, op.cit.: 96)
This text is intended not to be flowing, but to present a group of wisdoms in the form of
short sentences. Its hidden force is mainly personal and emotional. The exploitation of the
technique of short sentencing is the best way to impress the reader by these proverbial
statements. Therefore, disregarding sentence length means the loss of these stylistic functions
which support the message. That is why the following Arabic translation is laid out in form of
short sentences too:
(.هبم فالشباب منشغلون بصورهم اخلاصة. قلة من الناس حيبون أنفسهم حينما يبلغون اخلمسني.سن الكهولة مرحلة يأس
ويعلم أن عليه أن. إنه يرى الفشل. الكهل هو وحده الذي ال حيب ما يرى يف املرآة.والكبار غارقون يف حب الذات
أما. والكبار يساحمون أنفسهم ألن عليهم أن يفعلوا ذلك. الشباب حيذوهم األمل ألهنم جيرؤون على ذلك.يتعايش معه
وال يستطيع أن. فهو مسؤول عن احلياة اليت عاشها. يعرف عبء املسؤولية وحسب.الكهل فال يعرف األمل وال املهادنة
إىل الشفقةb األعذار و يتطلعb)يلتمس.
It is not wise, then, to change short sentencing into long sentencing , because the latter has
different stylistic functions, as the forthcoming point shows.
254
3.7. Style of LONG SENTENCES:
Long sentences are frequent in language, but they are not the norm. They represent a type
of style of sentences used to reflect certain functions pertaining to meaning or message.
Therefore, they are usually retained in translation. The SL text can be one long sentence, or a
group of long sentences, for several reasons: the strong unity of the topic; reflection of a boring
subject matter, emphasis or non-emphasis of a subject, a predicate, a phrase, or a clause;
portrayal of a scene of some kind; avoidance of any shade of ambiguity and addition of any
extra thing to the text - especially legal texts -; etc. Here are three examples, two general and
one legal:
1. “In an attempt to help his ill mother, who needed an operation in a specialist hospital in
London, which was quite expensive and demanded money to be paid in advance, the boy, who
was still very young and inexperienced, worked in a mechanical workshop day and night to
earn as much money as he could and as quickly as possible”.
This is a long, complicated sentence. Yet, it has to be taken as one unit and one idea. We
cannot separate between its clauses because they are interconnected, and would not be
understood unless they are taken together as one whole. On the other hand, the subject (the
255
boy), main verb (worked) and complement (in a car repairs workshop) of the sentence are near
the end and quite distant from the beginning. Therefore, grammatically we cannot have the
sentence in any other style in Arabic, as suggested by the following version:
( والذي كان باهظاً جداً وطلب، يف مستشفى متخصص يف لندنbيف حماولة ملساعدة أمه املريضة اليت كانت حباجة إىل عملية
يف ورشة تصليح سيارات ليل هنار ليكسب قدر ما، عمل الصيب الذي كان ما يزال صغرياً وعدمي اخلربة،ًدفع النقود مقدما
)يستطيع من النقود وبأسرع ما ميكن.
2. “The recent fall in the number of applications for arts degree courses, though not very
surprising in view of the diminished glamour of university life and the natural anxiety of young
people about the prospects of employment at the conclusion of their studies, is nevertheless
disturbing because it implies a reduction in the status of the university as a guardian of humane
values.” (From Nash, op.cit. 94)
The interruptive clause (i.e. ‘though…studies’) has a message which is emphasised for its
importance and relevance to the whole idea of the sentence. That is why it is inserted in the
middle of the main clause (viz. ‘the recent fall…is disturbing’). More importantly, this long,
complicated sentence stresses the strong unity of this view about arts degrees and the
university. Thus: One sentence, one text, one unit, one idea. The Arabic version should,
therefore, be so:
( مع أنه غري مفاجىء بالنظر الحنسار بريق احلياة اجلامعية،إن اهلبوط احلديث يف عدد طلبات االنتساب للتخصصات األدبية
هذا اهلبوط مع ذلك مثري للقلق ألنه يتضمن،والقلق الطبيعي عند الشباب عن آفاق العمل املستقبلية حني إهنائهم دراستهم
)إنقاصاً من منزلة اجلامعة كحارس أمني للقيم اإلنسانية.
Because of the long separation between the two parts of the main clause, the key word (
)هبوطis repeated for the convenience of cohesion and making the sentence easy to read and
understand. This is common in Arabic in a case like this. It is possible to break this long
sentence into two or three short sentences. Yet, it is not preferable to do that, or else the
compactness and wholeness of the sentence will be lost. Maybe the problem of translating this
sentence as such can be more easily solved than splitting it into short sentences, if the students
follow the same English grammatical order at translating it into Arabic; whereas short
sentences require them to add extra words which are not found in the original. Thus, reserving
the style of the original saves the students from creating more problems for themselves.
3. “ A deduction of tax may be claimed in respect of any person whom the individual maintains
at his own expense, and who is (i) a relative of his wife and incapacitated by old age or
infirmity from maintaining himself or herself (ii) his or his own wife’s widowed mother,
whether incapacitated or not or (iii) his daughter who is resident with him and upon whose
services he is compelled to depend by reasons of old age or infirmity.”
(from Newmark, 1988: 205)
This sentence is one legal article. It is unified and its clauses are interconnected and
interdependent. Consequently, breaking it down into short sentences is harmful to its meaning
256
which is intended to be taken as one unit. On the other hand, in legal English, such style of
long sentences is commonly used to avoid ambiguity, misinterpretation and addition of
anything extra to documents. For all these important functions, the same style requires to be
reflected in Arabic, as follows:
(ً) قريباً له أو لزوجته ومعاقا1( والذي يكون،ميكن املطالبة باقتطاع الضريبة بالنسبة ألي شخص يرعاه فرد ما على نفقته
)3( سواء أكانت معاقة أم غري ذلك أو،) والدته أو محاته األرملة2( بالشيخوخة أو العجز عن رعاية نفسه أو نفسها أو
)ابنته اليت تقطن معه واجملرب على االعتماد على خدماهتا ألسباب الشيخوخة واإلعاقة.
To sum up, the style of long sentences is preferably imitated in Arabic, because it has
important stylistic functions that are a part of the meaning of the text. On the other hand,
translating an English long sentence into an Arabic long one might be less problematic than
breaking it into short sentences. The major difficulty which is common to the previous
examples is the location of the main grammatical categories of the English sentence(i.e.
subject-verb-object/complement), to have a grammatical start for a proper Arabic sentence
type. The examples display three different possible sentence types: A prepositional phrase( يف
)حماولةfor (1); inna sentence( )إن اهلبوطfor(2); and a verbal sentence( )ميكن املطالبةfor (3) (see 1.7-
1.8 for more Arabic sentence types). Therefore, the students need not strain themselves
unnecessarily to change the style of sentencing. Rather, they look for the best possible start for
their sentences in Arabic.
Passive and active are two contrastive forms and styles. They have different functions.
Therefore, they should not be confused or ignored in the Arabic translation. There is a common
mistake of changing the passive into active by some Arab and Arabic speaking translators who
claim that Arabic is an active language, but English is passive. This is not confirmed about
Arabic language by any linguist/grammarian or language reference, as both passive and active
are used in all types of Arabic texts. This means that both styles have to be reflected in Arabic
translation for their important functions to the message. Here are examples:
At first sight, the two sentences have the same meaning. Yet, careful consideration shows
that they are different. That is, while the first is active, stating clearly the doer of the action of
killing (or the killers), the second is passive, hiding the killers. This makes a big difference in
that the active style aims at focusing on the murderers for human and political reasons, and is
expected to be used by Arab and anti-Jewish mass media, for instance. The passive style, on
the other hand, aims at concentrating on the result of the action and the action itself (i.e. the
five Palestinian children and killing them), hiding the identity of the killers, and at the same
257
time ignoring the killers as if they were unimportant, or suggesting that perhaps the murder was
committed by somebody else like, for instance, Palestinians killed Palestinians. Moreover, such
passive style is expected to be used by the Jews and pro-Jewish and zionist media.
These significant functions for each style require to be retained in Arabic in order that
meaning can be conveyed in full, as in the following versions:
The passive can be changed into active in one form which keeps the doer of the action
hidden: that is, the use of the verb of completion ()مت, followed by the noun of the main verbs of
the sentence, as follows:
This kind of passive active has the same functions of passive voice indicated above.
2. “You think perhaps that the university is a bastion of unshakable virtue? Tommyrot. We’re a
bit more civilized maybe, than the tribe at the gate. But like other communities, we have our
villains. What do you say to thieves in a university library? I mean people who steal purses,
wallets, watches, fountain pens. We have them”.
(op.cit: 141)
Obviously the tone is entirely and strongly active. It is used as a straightforward, sharp,
provocative, candid and aggressive style. It implies an invitation to some kind of action to be
taken. It is not advisable, then, to ignore these functions in the Arabic translation:
(كالتجمعات إال إننا.رمبا تظن أن اجلامعة معقل الفضيلة الراسخة؟ هراء! قد نكون أكثر حتضراً بقليل من رجل الشارع
وحمفظات، ماذا تقول عن لصوص مكتبة الجامعة؟ أقصد األشخاص الذين يسرقون أكياس النقود.األخرى لدينا أوغادنا
عندنا هؤالء. وأقالم احلبر، وساعات اليد،)اجليب.
The Arabic version is loyal to the active tone of the English text, which reflects the same
stylistic functions aimed at by the latter.
A version of the same text in the passive style will have different functions and at the
same time would give more illustrations about the previous active version:
258
3. “It might be thought, perhaps, that the university must be a bastion of unshakable virtue. The
supposition would be misguided. Academics may be considered a little more civilized than the
population at large. But wrongdoers are nonetheless to be found in the university as elsewhere.
Though theft from a university library might be judged quite inconceivable, valuables in the
form of purses, watches, wallets or fountain pens are stolen”:
(op.cit.)
The passive is dominant here, and, hence, the stylistic effects are not the same as those of
the active. That is, it charges the text with a kind of neutrality of attitude on the part of the
speaker. It helps him to be distant from being sharp and critical, which is typical of academic
dialogue. In other words, it is an indirect, polite style. These are good reasons for us to retain it
in Arabic as follows:
( قد ُيعتَرب األكادمييون أكثر حتضراً بقليل من عامة. لعل هذا االفرتاض مضلَّل.رمبا ُيظَن أن اجلامعة معقل الفضيلة الراسخة
فإن، فبرغم أن السرقة من مكتبة جامعية قد ال تٌتَصور. لكن املخطئني مع ذلك موجودون يف اجلامعة ويف غريها.الناس
أو حمفظات جيب أو أقالم حبر، أو ساعات يد،سرق وتتمثل يف أكياس نقود َ ُ تb)األشياء الثمينة
(Passives are underlined).
By using passive style, the subjects (or the doers of the actions)are not mentioned, which
helps avoid embarrassing others or being embarrassed. This in turn supports the style of
indirectness aimed at by the passive here.
We may conclude that the two styles of passive and active are used in language to express
different stylistic functions and achieve different aims in relation to the message (Ghazala
(2007) points out thirteen functions for the active, and twenty seven functions for the passive in
language). If they are not two different styles, why are they used in language in the first place,
then? Therefore, the students of translation are recommended to insist on using the same
active/passive style of the English original in Arabic unless unavailable (e.g.
informal/colloquial written Arabic style).
259
3.9. Style of REPETITION AND VARIATION:
Many would think that repetition is a bad style and, therefore, has to be avoided in
translation. This is generally imprecise, for this style is a part of rhetoric, and can be used on
purpose to have important functions that affect the message considerably. The best examples
are available in abundance in the Holy Quran, the best language and style of any book on earth.
Hence, generalization about the style of repetition is unacceptable, as also illustrated in the
forthcoming discussion.
In a text where important words are repeated over and again, we are required to render
them fully into Arabic, however boring they might look to some. The writer of the English text
could be willing to repeat a word, or a phrase to reflect something important to the whole
message. The following examples illustrate the point:
1. “Football is the game my friend loves. Football is the sport he watches on the television.
Football is his favorite hobby. As a child, his dream was to play football as a professional
player. Here he is now a great football player”.
The key word of this passage is football. It is repeated in every sentence to be emphasised
and echoed in every part of the text. Also, it implies that football is everything in my friend’s
life, which is what the message of the whole text is about. For all these reasons, the Arabic
version has to produce the same repetition, as follows:
260
(b.املفضلة كرة القدم هي هوايته. كرة القدم هي الرياضة اليت يشاهدها على التلفاز.كرة القدم هي اللعبة اليت حيبها صديقي
ها هو ذا اآلن العب كرة قدم كبير. كان أمله أن يلعب كرة القدم كالعب حمرتف،)وكطفل.
It is not advisable to use variations on (القدم )كرة, because the text will lose its natural,
easy-going, fluent flow, and the important functions of ‘football’ will in effect disappear.
Instead, there would be a boring, awkward text and unclear stylistic functions, as the following
poor version may confirm:
(.املفضلة اللعبة األوىل يف العامل هي هوايته. إهنا الرياضة اليت يشاهدها على التلفاز.كرة القدم هي اللعبة اليت حيبها صديقي
ها هو ذا اآلن العب حمبوبة اجلماهري الكبير. كان أمله أن يلعب اللعبة الشعبية،)وكطفل.
The variations on (القدم )كرةare: the pronoun ( )هاin ()إهنا, ()اللعبة األوىل يف العامل, ()اللعبة الشعبية
and ( اجلماهريb)حمبوبة. Although they are favorable variations in Arabic, they do not have the same
effect of the repetitions of the head word (القدم )كرة.
2. “…It contained several large streets all very like one another, and many small streets still
more like one another, inhabited by people equally like one another, who all went in and out at
the same hour, with the same sound upon the same pavements, to do the same work, and to
whom everyday was the same as yesterday and tomorrow, and every year the counterpart of the
last and the next”.
(From Charles Dickens' Hard Times)
These repetitions (especially 2 and 3 )occur in the fifth chapter of the novel, Hard Times,
by the famous English novelist, Charles Dickens. It is about a town called ‘Coketown’ which is
described as lifeless, dead and unchangeable. These and other repetitions here are meant to
reflect the same atmosphere of lifeless, boring and hopeless town, people and everything else.
Everything and everybody in this town is the same as anything else and anybody else: no
difference, no change, no life. In other words, the style of repetition has the critical function of
reflecting as much as matching the contents of lifelessness and boredom of the chapter and
perhaps the whole novel. So it is unwise to ignore it in Arabic.
261
(أناس يقطنها،ً وشوارع صغرية كثرية يشبه الواحد منها اآلخر أيضا،تضمنت شوارع كبرية عدة يشبه الواحد منها اآلخر
ليقوموا بالعمل، على األرصفة نفسها، والصوت نفسه، دخلوا وخرجوا يف الساعة نفسهاb،يشبه الواحد منهم اآلخر كذلك
وكل سنة نفس الشيء كمثيلتيها املاضية واآلتية،ً وكل يوم بالنسبة هلم نفس الشيء كأمس وغدا،)نفسه.
It should be noted that every time the same word is repeated in the English text, the same
translation of it must be repeated in Arabic too. We need not use different translations for the
same word when used with the same meaning. The examples here and elsewhere in this work
illustrate this point. As for the last two informal translations of ‘same’ into ( )نفس الشيءin
Arabic, they are suggested to keep the word, 'same' in Arabc for its special importance. Yet,
they can be replaced by a variation(or a synonym) like ( )مثلor ( )يشبهas follows:
(...واآلتية وكل سنة تشبه مثيلتيها املاضية،ً)وكل يوم بالنسبة هلم مثل األمس وغدا.
So the students have two options. On the other hand, the last Arabic translation ( الشيء )نفس
is not mentioned in word in the original, but understood from ‘the counterpart’ ( )مثيل. All this
insistence on the use of ( )نفسwhenever possible in the passage is to reflect an effect in Arabic
that can be identical to that in English.
3. “Yes, yes, of course, I agree with you that we must cooperate, but on one condition, on one
condition: you work hard on the project. Otherwise, I I I work on my own, yes, on my own, do
you understand? on my own”.
In this text, which is a part of conversation, there are what might be described imprecisely
as ‘unnecessary repetitions’(underlined). That is, some words and phrases are repeated
unnecessarily, as the meaning is quite clear without repeating them. Yet, although such
repetitions are not required to help us understand the message, they are not used for no
purpose, but to achieve certain functions like:
1. Laying more emphasis on a word or a phrase (e.g. ‘yes’, ‘on one condition’,
‘on my own’).
2. Continuation of speech without stopping (e.g. ‘I’).
Even when the repetition is used for no good or special reasons, we are responsible for
transmitting it into Arabic. This makes the problem of translating it easy to tackle by the
students. Here is the Arabic translation:
( وإال.املشروع أن تعمل جبد يف: على شرط واحد، ولكن على شرط واحد، طبعاً أوافقك أننا جيب أن نتعاون، نعم،نعم
هل تفهم؟ مبفردي، مبفردي، نعم،)فأنا أنا أنا سوف أعمل مبفردي.
262
In fact, it is possible to dispose of all these repetitions with no great loss of meanimg, as
follows:
(املشروع أن تعمل جبد يف: ولكن على شرط واحد، طبعاً أوافقك أننا جيب أن نتعاون،نعم.
هل تفهم؟.)وإال فسوف أعمل بمفردي.
Yet, it is not a good suggestion to substitute repetitions for variations here, because they
may make the text unnatural and unfluent, as the following version shows:
( وإال.املشروع أن تعمل جبد يف: على أساس واحد، ولكن على شرط واحد، طبعاً أوافقك أننا جيب أن نتعاون، أجل،نعم
هل تفهم ؟ حلايل, لوحدي، بلى،)فأنا إنين إين سوف أعمل مبفردي.
This translation seems quite artificial, unconvincing and poor Arabic, in comparison to the
first version in particular. In fact, in natural conversation, such variations do not occur,
especially those on (()نعمi.e. أجل، )بلىand (( )أناi.e. إين،)إنين. Consequently, we'd better avoid
them in the Arabic translation.
The first version remains closer to the English original, then, as it reflects the same tone
and functions of the style of the latter.
In sum, the style of repetition would rather be rendered into Arabic, thus reflecting the
same effect of the original, and at the same time avoiding the problem of finding artificial
variations and synonyms, which might be awkward or hard to accept.
263
3.10. Style of REDUNDANCY:
1. “As a matter of fact to say the truth I have to say it frankly, I am not interested in
your offer”.
The underlined phrases have one and the same meaning. For convenience of easiness and
quickness of translation, such redundancy can be avoided in Arabic by translating only one of
the three expressions, as follows:
Yet, to reflect the function of politeness, hesitation and stammering of the redundant style
of the original, the students had better translate the three phrases into Arabic as follows:
264
2. “The economic policy of the new government is unacceptable completely, categorically and
in part and in toto”.
An acceptable, brief Arabic version is to use one word only for all the three underlined
ones as follows:
()السياسة االقتصادية للحكومة اجلديدة غري مقبولة برمتها.
However, the great emphasis intended by such redundancy in English is wasted in Arabic.
Therefore, an alternative, equally redundant Arabic version may reflect this important function
of emphasis, as the following version may point out:
(ً )مطلقاis stronger than ( )كليةwhereas (ًوتفصيال )مجلةis the strongest of all. (See the next
point for more details about this). Emphasis is well-expressed by these words in Arabic. We
may call this type of redundancy ‘emphatic redundancy’, which is important to reproduce in
translation.
3. “Ladies and gentlemen, first and foremost, I would like to thank the chairman for
giving me the floor at last, having been waiting for an hour or so”.
Redundancy here is the long, boring, undesirable way of starting a speech. The speaker
has chosen to begin with a long introduction instead of going directly to the point, namely,
being sharp and to the point. Therefore, one version of translation into Arabic could suggest the
disregard of redundancy completely:
This is the message here, but it does not reflect the insinuative, ironical and bad style of
the English original. A bad style should be transmitted as honestly as possible into a bad style,
not into a good style. There is no difference between the two styles to translators, for they
express the style of other people, not their own style. A back translation of this Arabic
translation into English will show how different it is from the original:
“Ladies and gentlemen , I thank the chairman for giving me the floor”.
This is a summary of the previous version. It is brief and written in a good style, whereas
the other is long, written in a bad style and has the function of irony. That is, the speaker is not
satisfied with the chairman because he ignored him for a long time. Thus, the retention of
redundancy in Arabic is required:
265
(ًأخريا أوالً وقبل كل شيء أود أن أشكر الرئيس على إعطائي الكلمة،ساديت وسيدايت،
ً)بعد انتظاري حوايل ساعة تقريبا.
(The underlined words and expressions imply irony).
4. “I am tired and fatigued. I spent last night studying and reading because I had to do a
difficult and hard assignment and homework, and was preparing myself for tests and
examinations”.
The five underlined phrases are redundant. Each is a pair of synonyms used unnecessarily
to reflect two main functions on the part of the speaker:
Redundancies here are for ‘self-correction’. That is, in each pair of words, the second
corrects the first and is, therefore, better, more expressive and more proper than it. In Arabic,
we may have two choices: one short, sharp and to the point, another long, redundant and
identical with the original:
1. (تدعى يف الربملانb فهو زعيم جمموعة. إنه دائماً يشن هجوماً شرساً على احلكومة وأتباعها.عضو الربملان ذاك متطرف
احلكومة إذ يعتربون أنفسهم مسؤولني عن الدفاع عن حقوق اجلماهير ضد مؤامرات.")"املدافعون عن احلقوق.
2. (ومؤيديها شرساً على احلكومة،ً يشن هجوماً شديدا، إنه دائماً يقود. متطرف،عضو الربملان ذاك متشدد،
266
، إذ يعتربون أنفسهم مسؤولني عن محاية." يف الربملان تدعى "املدافعون عن احلقوقb زعيم جمموعة، فهو رئيس.وأتباعها
مؤامرات احلكومة، اجلماهري ضد أالعيب،)الدفاع عن حقوق الشعب.
The former version concentrates on the second word of each pair, being stronger and
more expressive than the first. Also, it is fluent, good Arabic. Yet, it does not reflect the style
of redundancy of the original. The latter version, on the other hand, conveys all the
redundancies of the English text. It is an awkward, bad Arabic version. Nevertheless, it reflects
the style of redundancy of the original. Contrary to the former which is better than the original,
it is neither better nor worse than the original. It is as identical to it as possible. A little
improvement on the redundant version which makes it clearer and more acceptable in Arabic is
the addition of the correction word ( )بلbetween the two words of each of the redundant pairs,
as follows:
3. (احلكومة بل شرساً على،ً بل يشن هجوماً شديدا، فدائماً يقود. بل متطرف،عضو الربملان ذاك متشدد
إذ يعتربون أنفسهم." بل زعيم جمموعة يف الربملان تدعى "محاة احلقوق، فهو رئيس، بل وأتباعهاb،ومؤيديها
بل مؤامرات احلكومةb، بل اجلماهري ضد أالعيب، بل الدفاع عن حقوق الشعب،)مسؤولني عن محاية.
The use of ( )بلhas made the functions of self-correction, contrast and poweful meaning
clearer, and the whole version more readable than the second one. Having said that, there are
grammatical objections to the informality of the second and the third versions. That is, two
genitive nouns cannot follow one another in a row, as in ( مؤمراتb،أالعيب/ زعيم جمموعة،رئيس
الدفاع عن حقوق،محاية/)احلكومة. Formally ,they should be: ( احلكومةbأالعيب/رئيس جمموعة وزعيمها
محاية حقوق الشعب والدفاع عنها/)ومؤمراهتا.
Finally, the style of redundancy is regarded as a bad style of writing. Yet, in translation it
has to be reflected for two main reasons:
1. It may have an important function of emphasis, contrast, bad style, poor language, boring
text and/or speaker, or indirect, hesitant way of saying something.
267
3.11. EXPRESSIVITY , CONTEXT AND READERSHIP:
THE STYLE OF THE SHOW OF MUSCLES:
Sometimes, more than one equivalent can be available in Arabic for the same English
word, phrase or expression. But they may not fit equally in different linguistic/stylistic
contexts, because they have different degrees of expressivity. That is, one can be normal and,
therefore, is not suitable in a very formal and expressive context; whereas another may be too
strong and formal to be used in an ordinary text, or a text for children, for instance. In other
words, there can be a problem of confusing the use of the proper word in the proper context for
the proper readership.
The main reason behind such confusion of the context is the tendency towards using an
expressive, pompous translation, regardless of the style of the language of the text, context and
readership, in an attempt to show one's muscles ()استعراض عضالت, which is an artificial special,
pedantic skill in Arabic. The following examples illustrate this:
268
9. (الريح)ذهبت جهوده يف مهب.
10. () تبخرت جهوده يف اهلواء.
6. Normal language: (1, 2, 3): There is nothing special or metaphorical about the words
used. All of them are ordinary, common, easily understood and used by everyone.
7. Expressive language: (4, 5, 6)The words ()تثمر, ()تسفر, and ( )سدىgive more expressive
impetus to the translation than those of '1', because they are formal, rhetorical and
metaphorical.
8. Bombastic language: (7-10): This is indicated by the phrases: ()هباء منثورا, ()أدراج الريح, (
)يف مهب الريح, and (تبخرت يف اهلواء.). They are regarded as much more expressive and
pompous than those of '2' because they are:
Many students and translators prefer to use one of the last group, as a show of muscles.
This leads them to a misjudgement of types of readers, contexts and carelessness about
differences among these contexts. In other words, different contexts pose the problem of
choosing the more appropriate version for each one, as the same translation cannot fit in all
contexts. The following examples will illustrate the point:
2. “The new minister of economy did his best to improve the economic situation of the
country. But his efforts came to nothing”:
Here the first and perhaps the second groups only are suitable, because the context is
normal and language is ordinary Therefore, a pompous language of the third group does not fit
here. For example, to say ( )هباء منثوراis not expected in an economic text. It would be a
misplaced style, and no more than a show of muscles. Thus, a version like the following can be
what we expect:
1.(لكن/ لكنه مل يصل إىل نتيجة.عمل وزير االقتصاد اجلديد كل ما يف وسعه لتحسني الوضع االقتصادي للبلد
))جهوده مل تسفر عن شيء
269
3. “My fridge was faulty. The technician tried seven times to repair it. But, his efforts
came to nothing”.
Again, a technical text like this does not require a very strong, metaphorical language to
be used, because simple and/or technical language is usually difficult. Only group one of
ordinary, direct language can suit the context here. Any of the other two groups will look like a
big dress for a small thing:
(b) إال إن جهوده ضاعت دون نتيجة (إال إنه مل يصل إىل نتيجة. حاول الفين أن يصلحها سبع مراتb.)كانت ثالجيت معطلة.
9. “The peace mediator had three rounds of talks with officials from the two
neighbouring countries to stop war between them. Sadly, his efforts came
to nothing at the end”.
Here, the third group of bombastic language is quite plausible, for it is the best choice to
express the mediator’s great disappointment. The second group can also be acceptable.
However, the first is not advisable for it weakens the volume of the reaction of disappointment
implied. Thus, we may say the following in Arabic:
(جهوده هباء لألسف ضاعت. اجلارين إليقاف احلرب الدائرة بينهماbقام وسيط السالم بثالث جوالت حمادثات بني البلدين
باءت جهوده بالفشل) يف النهاية/)منثورا (تبخرت جهوده يف اهلواء.
10. “When she was a little child, she dreamed of a brilliant, bright future. She spent years
dreaming of blossoms and roses blooming her florescent future. To make this dream a
reality, she dedicated herself to story-writing to become a great novelist. But to her
surprise, she suffered utter failure at the very first attempt to publish her stories. She
was shocked at realizing that her painful efforts came to nothing”.
In such a metaphorical, literary text, we can use the most expressive and rhetorical words
and phrases possible in Arabic. Only group three above can fit here. The other two groups
would diminish expressivity in such a literary text. Hence this version:
(.الزاهر قضت السنوات حتلم باألزاهري والورود تنور مستقبلها. حلمت مبستقبل مشرق باهر،حني كانت طفلة صغرية
، ولدهشتها الشديدة، ولكنb. نذرت نفسها لكتابة القصص لتصبح روائية عظيمة،ولكي حُتَول هذا احللم إىل حقيقة واقعة
لقد صُعقت عند إدراكها أن جهودها املضنية تبخرت يف اهلواء.)أصيبت بفشل ذريع عند أول حماولة هلا لنشر قصصها.
Another remarkable show of muscles is in the translation of general texts for the public at
large. Here translators may use expressive, very formal words and expressions which are too
difficult for the laymen and not highly educated people to understand clearly and completely.
The best examples can be traced in the subtitled (or translated by writing) and doubled (or
translated orally) T.V. foreign series, films and programs. Translators tend to choose
270
ostentatious words at every possible opportunity in the text to show up their distinguished
knack in Arabic. This can be harmful to a translation forwarded to a public who mostly has an
average level of education and expects a simplified, easily understood and commonly used
standard Arabic (like the Arabic of good, quality newspapers). Here is a list of examples
illustrating the point, including the pompous words used and their ordinary, more appropriate
substitutes:
271
The list is very long indeed. (For more discussion of how to differentiate between
synonymous words like these, see 2.2. on ‘Synonymy’ above)
The problem becomes worse when the translated text is forwarded to children through
children’s T.V. programs and cartoons, for example. Children need a very simplified language.
Such a show of muscles’ translations are frequent and, therefore, spoil the original, do harm to
Arabic and create difficulties of understanding to children. Only with the aid of their educated
parents can they understand what they mean.
272
3.12. Style of NOMINALIZATION vs. VERBALIZATION:
The style of nominalization (or the use of nouns in preference to verbs) has the stylistic
function of injecting texts with abstraction, fixity and some kind of authority. On the other
hand, the style of verbalization (or the use of verbs in preference to nouns ) is an indication of
subjectivity, mobility and normality. The following examples give practical evidence for that
(each example is given in two versions: one nominalized, another verbalized to be compared
with one another):
5. “Registration at the university is the start of a long path into the unknown future. The
feeling of security in life is the main aim of many students. Also, the holding of a
university degree and the consideration of its holder among the highly educated, is a
valuable moral end for a great number of students”. (Nominalizations are
underlined)
Here is a suggested Arabic version, which reflects the style of nominalization of the
original:
1.(من فالشعور باألمان يف احلياة هدف رئيسي لكثري.التسجيل يف اجلامعة بداية طريق طويل يف املستقبل اجملهول
لعدد كبري غاية معنوية نفيسة، كما أن َحمْل شهادة جامعية واعتبار حاملها من بني األشخاص رفيعي الثقافة.الطلاب
)من الطلاب.
Obviously, the Arabic version has no one single verb; all sentences are nominal (i.e. topic
and comment each). This style gives the text a sense of formality, objectivity and
generalizations in the form of statements and axioms about facts of life, which accept no
argument or refusal. That means they are authoritative statements which are universal facts. A
verbalized version of the same text will have different functions and effects in both Languages,
English and Arabic, as follows:
6. “To register at the university is to start a long path into a future you do not know. To
feel secure in life is what many students mainly aim at. Also, to hold a university
degree and to consider its holder among the people who have high education is what a
great number of students take as a valuable, moral end”.
(The verbalized nominalizations of ‘1’ are underlined)
2. (ما يهدف فأن تشعر باألمان يف احلياة و.أن تسجل يف اجلامعة يعين أن تبدأ طريقاً طويالً يف مستقبل ال تعرفه
أن َتحمل شهادة جامعية وأنْ ُيعترب حاملها من بني األشخاص الذينْ كما،إليه بشكل رئيسي كثري من الطلاب
هو ما يتخذه عدد كبري من الطلاب كغاية معنوية نفيسة،)ميلكون ثقافة رفيعة.
273
Verbalizations in both languages have changed the tone of the message into some
informality, subjectivity and absence of authority. The text has become closer and more
intimate to the reader who would feel that the statements are directed to him personally in a
straightforward way. This makes his reaction different from that to the nominalized version.
This nominalized version is abstract and not quite vivid. It is written in a routine
philosophical style with the main aim of sending information to patients, but with no intention
to urge them to exert great efforts in the process. These are sufficient justifications for us to
render this nominalized style into Arabic as follows:
3.(النهائي يف واملؤدي إىل االكتشاف،نصح فرويد مرضاه بسبر منظم وشاق ألعماق الذاكرة
)الالشعور لألصول املعتمة لالضطراب العصيب.
The only verb used in this version is ( )نصحas a matching translation for ‘recommended’,
the only verb in the English origin too.
A verbalized version, on the other hand, has different reflections on the message. That is,
it is less abstract and more vivid than the nominalized version. It is written in an incitative
style, aiming at engaging patients directly and heavily in more than one process. That is, they
are urged to get through a process of four stages:
1. “to reach”
2. “to thread”
3. “to ransack”
4. “to discover”
On the other hand, whereas the nominalized version is direct and plain language, the
verbalized version is largely metaphorical with regard to verbs in particular, which are all
metaphors. Here is a verbalized version of the above nominalized one:
8. “ Freud encouraged his patients to reach into memory, thread with infinite care its
troubled maze, methodically ransack the cluttered chambers of the mind, and in that
groping fashion at last discover the corner from which neurosis darkly sprang”.
(op .cit.).
274
1.“profoundly painstaking and systemic investigation of the depths of the
memory”→ “reach into memory … thread with infinite care … methodically
ransack”.
2. “the eventual discovery in the unconscious”→ “in that groping fashion at last
discover” .
4. ( بشكل وأن يتمحصوا، وأن يشقُّوا بعناية فائقة متاهته املعقدة،حث فرويد مرضاه على أن يتوغلوا داخل الذاكرة
اليت انبثق منهاb وأن يكتشفوا كذلك بطريقة البحث هذه الزاوية املظلمة،منظم جتاويف العقل املتزامحة
)االضطراب العصيب.
Here are the two Arabic nominalized and verbalized versions juxtaposed:
1. (..."يشقوا وأن،بسرب منظم وشاق ألعماق الذاكرة" ← "أن يتوغلوا داخل الذاكرة...،
وأن يتمحصوا...")
2. ("واملؤدي إىل االكتشاف النهائي يف الالشعور" ← "وأن يكتشفوا كذلك...")
3. ("األصول املعتمة لالضطراب العصيب" ←"الزاوية املظلمة اليت انبثق منها...")
Clearly, both Arabic versions are identical with their English parallels, so that they reflect
identical stylistic functions. It does not matter whether the same number of nouns and verbs are
used in Arabic; what matters is to insist on reflecting the two styles of nominalization and
verblization in it.
In short, nominalization and verbalization are two different styles. Each implies specific
functions that do not have the same impact on, and relationship with the message as well as the
readers. Therefore, both styles need to be retained in Arabic. Ignoring them would render
meaning incomplete and the reaction to it different.
275
3.13. The Style of IRONY:
One of the most difficult, or perhaps, the most difficult types of style to realize and
recognize in language is the style of irony. The general, simple dictionary definition of irony
is “a method of humorous or subtly sarcastic expression in which the intended meaning of the
words is the direct opposite of their sense” (e.g. it is irony to call a stupid plan, ‘clever’)
(Webster's World Dictionary, Third College Edition); "The humorous or mildly sarcastic use
of words to imply the opposite of what they normally mean (Collins English Dictionary); and
"Irony is found when the words actually used appear to mean quite the opposite of the sense
actually required by the context and presumably intended by the speaker (Wales, 1989: 263).
A differentiation is made between three major kinds of irony: (1) dramatic irony ( هتكم
( )دراميimplications of a situation or expression understood by the audience, but not
understood by the characters in the play; (2) Socratic irony(( )هتكم سقراطيpretence of ignorance
in a discussion to expose the ignorance of the opponent); and (3) "irony of fate (pointed to by
Leech, 1969: 170) (( )سخرية القدرadding insult to injury, so to speak).
Other definitions of irony centre more or less around the same meaning. For example,
Leech (op.cit.) follows H.W. Fowler who describes irony as “a mode of expression which
postuates a double audience, one of which is "in the know" and aware of the speaker's
intention, whilst the other is naive enough to take the utterance at its face value" (A Dictionary
of Modern English Use, 1926: 295). Irony, adds Leech, involves the nation of disguise, a
mask and a concealment that is meant to be found out. For example, if someone dresses up as
a monkey to entertain children, he does not intend to be mistaken for a monkey. Also, Nash
(1989: 118) defines irony in simple terms as it "… says what it does not mean and means what
it does not say". He considers it in a book on Humour, (1985) as a major stylistic resort in
humour. The ironist, he says, insincerely states something he does not mean, but through the
manner of his statement “…is able to encode a counter-proposition, his ‘real meaning’, which
may be interpreted by the attentive listener or reader” (p.152). He splendidly draws a precise
comparison between irony and sarcasm as two different terms. That is, although both involve
overstatement and understaement, sarcasm is "ostensibly sincere, whereas irony states
something insincerely. For instance, let us have the statement "Tommy is lazy" ()تومي كسول. If
we want to be sarcastic we say: "Tommy doesn't strain himself” (تومي نفسه ال يُتعب/)ال جيهد, but
when we try to be ironic, we may say: “Tommy is renowned for his labours” ( تومي مشهود
)له(مشهور) جبهوده اجلبارة. . The main difference between the two versions … is that the second is
276
sharper and more blatant than the first. The relationship between the two can be simply
understood as follows: sarcasm is a light irony"()السخرية هتكم خفيف الظل.
The fact of the matter is that usually in language -English or Arabic- the two terms
interchange and explain one another.
Having established at some length the basics of the concept of irony in language, we can
discuss it now as a major stylistic problem of translation.
The very first step prior to translating an irony is to recognize it in the SL text. If the
translator fails to do so, he might distort the central point of the original. So, he is supposed to
be extremely attentive and cautious at handling ironic expressions and passages. The
procedures as how the translator can spot and then translate an irony, can be traced through
the discussion of the translation of the following types of irony with their illustrative
examples.
3.You are wonderful! Disgustingly wonderful! (القرف )!أنت رائع! رائع إىل درجة
The discrepancy in (1)between ‘great’ ( )عظيمand ‘lost everything’ (كل شيء )خسرis what
creates the irony. However, the ironical word is ‘great’ ()عظيم, understood in contrast to what
follows.
In (2), ‘backward’ is ironic, taken together with ‘fatness diet’, as there is no such diet.
The word ‘disgustingly’ of (3) disrupts the whole statement, converting it into an irony,
created by the paradox between it and ‘wonderful’. In language, that is, there is no such phrase
as "disgusting wonder" , unless we mean to use it as a trope.
2. Reactionary irony
277
-“Thank you! That’s very kind of you”: (من لطفك )!أشكرك! هذا
The tone of voice plays a vital role here. For the addresser, it is usually either a high-
high, or a low-high tone. However, for the addressee, it is normally a low-low tone, which
may be more effective than a high-high tone.
This is perhaps the most intricate type of irony to spot and translate. It requires a
maximum degree of concentration to locate, understand and then translate. It is hidden and
hard to trace, for it is not restricted to one word or phrase, but scattered through the whole
text. What adds to this complexity is the cultural, philosophical, religious or intellectual
background of the text. Consider this example by Jonathan Swift (in Nash, 1989:.118):
“If Christianity were once abolished, how would the free Thinkers, the Strong Reasoners,
and the Men of profound Learning, be able to find another Subject so calculated in all
Points whereon to display their Abilities. What wonderful Productions of Wit should we be
deprived of, from those whose Genius by continual Practice hath been wholly turned upon
Raillery and Invectives against Religion, and would therefore never be able to shine or
distinguish themselves upon any other subject. We are daily complaining of the great
decline of Wit among us, and would we take away the greatest, perhaps the only Topick we
have left?”
(Underlining of capitalized words is mine)
Here is the Arabic version which attempts hard to match the ironical atmosphere of the
English original:
( أن جيدوا، وذوي العلم الواسع، وأويل األلباب األقوياء، كيف للمفكرين األحرار،ست املسيحية يوماً ماْ إذا ما طُ ِم
موضوعاً آخر مدروساً بدقة من جوانبه كلها يستعرضون فيه عضالهتم وقدراهتم؟ كم من األعمال الرائعة من الظرافة
سوف حُن رم منها من أولئك الذين صبّوا جام عبقريتهم على ممارسة متواصلة للتنكيت والتشهري بالدين املسيحي
، إننا نشكو يومياً من االحندار الرهيب للظرافة بني ظهرانينا.لعجزهم متاماً عن التألق والتميز يف أي موضوع آخر
بل رمبا املوضوع الوحيد املتبقي لنا؟،)فهل نضرب بعرض احلائط أعظم موضوع
278
It is not easy to catch up with the ironic tone of this passage. It looks rather a normal
piece of writing, a mere personal point of view, intended to defend the miserable status of the
religion of Christianity in the British as well as Western societies. Yet, the translator might get
help from the following facts.
1)The passage is written by Jonathan Swift, the famous satiric writer, which presupposes the
possibility of using irony.
2)The main hypothesis, ‘If Christianity were once abolished’ is ominous of satiric message, as
it is hard for the British to believe such a hypothesis.
3)The paradox between the abolition of the Christian religion and its being a so calculated
subject.
4)The use of expressons of ironic intent like: ‘display their abilities’, ‘wonderful production of
wit......turned upon Railyery and Invectives against religion’; and ‘would never shine or
distingunish themselves upon any other subject’.
5)The use of outright critical expressions like “complaining of the great decline among us”.
6)Self-assertive defensive rhetorical question concludes the text as an indirect indication of the
fallacy of the hypothesis put forward in the first sentence of the paragraph.
In the Arabic translation, all these points are taken into account. For example, the use of(
)طُمست. for ‘abolished’ instead of ( )أولوا األلباب.(‘ )ألغيتreasoners’ instead of ( )ذوو العلم.( أصحاب
)العقولis ‘men of profound learning’( )يستعرضون عضالهتم.( )رجال املعرفةfor ‘display their abilities’
as an alternative for (عبقريتهم )صبوا جام.( )يعرضون قدراهتمfor "whose genius …turned upon",
instead of ( )ركزوا عبقرياهتمfor its rhetorical satiric effect in parallel with ()صبوا جام غضبهم, which
is the proper collocation in Arabic.
A striking stylistic feature of irony is the use of capitalization with usually uncapitalized
common nouns like: thinkers, reasoners, men, abilities, point, etc., not to emphasize them, as
normally the case, but to criticize and mock them even orthographically. In Arabic, however,
there is no such feature of writing in the Arabic Alphabet to translate the English original. A
possible solution is to underline the capitalized words in the Arabic translation(as done here).
Yet, other devices, like the use of an exclamation mark after each English capitalized noun,
can be a good equivalent and, hence, a good solution.
"An innuendo", says Leech, "is a special kind of ironic statement which is remarkable for
what it omits rather than for what it mentions" (1969:174-75). It is a kind of depreciatory
irony that draws heavily on insinuation (الغمز واللمز/)التلميح. The speaker appears to be positive,
but means to be negative. That is, he nunmbers another person’s merits, to imply his
279
outnumbered demerits. Put metaphorically, he points out the tip( )الغيض, to draw attention to
the iceberg( )الفيض. Here are examples:
1.Who claims they cannot give up smoking? They have given it up one hundred times (instead
of: “they have never given up smoking”).
()من يزعم أهنم ال يستطيعون اإلقالع عن التدخني؟ لقد أقلعوا عنه مئة مرة
(ًإطالقا مل يقلعوا عن التدخني:)بدالً من قولنا
2.My mother-in-law keeps her quiet for fifteen minutes a day (i.e. she is so talkative). ( تسكت
)ً إهنا ثرثارة جدا:محايت مخس عشرة دقيقة يف اليوم (أي
3.Her grand brother is exceptionally clever. He passes the exam once every three years (i.e. he
is exceptionally stupid. He fails very often).
( إذ ينجح يف االمتحان مرة كل ثالث سنوات (أي إنه.أخوها الكبري ذو ذكاء نادر
It is a strange type of irony that occurs when a person criticizes himself/herself harshly to
the extent that he/she likes who dislikes him/her, and dislikes who likes him/her. It is termed
by Nash (1985), ‘personal closed system’. He cites the following illustrative example entitled,
‘Jill’, by an English person. (p 111) (one or two slight changes have been made on the
original):
280
He cannot love someone he despises.شخصاً حيتقره إنه ال يستطيع أن حيب.
Since he loves Jackجاك مبا أنه حيب
He cannot believe he loves him.ال يستطيع أن يصدق أنه حيبه.
What proof can he give?ما دليله على ذلك؟
This is an unfavorable style of irony, meant to be taken more humorously than seriously.
An additional ironical feature here is achieved by laying this trash out in the form of a poem.
This implies a strong criticism and ridicule, for poetry is a highly respected genre of writing,
and this passage can be anything but poetry. By this, it can be regarded as another example of
the third type of irony, ‘disguised irony’ (see above), which involves the whole text to imply
the opposite of what is said or written. This is exactly the case with this extract which is laid
out in the form of a poem, but it is anything but a poem.
On the other hand, this style of irony is described as a closed system because the person
who uses it closes all routes leading to him/her to the point that he/she refuses any possible
exit or change of affairs. It is the least popular and appreciated style of irony. Perhaps only
complex people apply it.
To conclude, the translation of irony is as difficult as catching it. It is hoped that the
foregoing discussion of irony and its main types will help easen the burden of spotting,
comprehending and translating it. To help students and translators tackle the problems of
translating irony more easily and systematically, here is a summary of the translation
procedures of irony, which are guidelines for finding out the best possible solutions to these
problems:
281
8. Going for a direct, literal translation of the meaning of the ironical expression and/or
image, by investigating the contrastive, paradoxical words and insinuations (
طرف خفيْ إشارات من/ )تلميحاتof the original..
9. Suggesting an equivalent style of irony in Arabic that can reflect the English
counterpart in a way or another.
10. Trying as a last resort, the literal translation of words in a hit-or-miss attempt (i.e. ضربة
حماولة يا تصيب يا ختيب/)!حظ.
English Punctuation Marks (i.e.commas, full stops, colons, semi-colons, etc.) are
graphological, grammatical and stylistic tools used to have meaning and perform particular
functions in writing. They are, then, indispensable to any written text, a part of a text, or even
a sentence. They are used to achieve organisation, clarity, easiness of reading and
comprehension, avoidance of possible ambiguity of struture and meaning. These are stylistic
functions, or implicit meanings for them. However, some punctuation marks have explicit
meanings that cannot be expressed if they are omitted. Illustrative examples are given below.
Similarly, punctuation marks in Arabic are equally important in the same way, for they
have similar functions and meanings. Yet, unfortunately, they have been and are still being
ignored by many for no good reasons, to say the least. lndeed it is quite unfortunate situation
in Arabic writing. Here lies the problem in translation. That is, English uses punctuation
systmatically and emphatically in writing as a part and parcel of the structure and meaning of
any piece of language. However, in Arabic, punctuation is considered as an ornamentation,
neither more nor less, and is, therefore, disregarded, sometimes completely. To confirm this,
just a quick look at any classical book, whether the original, or a recently published edition,
(e.g.: A Handbook of Rhetoric (()1995:32( ,b– الدليل إىل البالغةwhich is about Arabic traditional
poetry- where punctuation is overwhelmingly marginalized throughout. Not only this,
punctuation is used poorly and haphazardly, by way of decoration, or, rather, misused. Full
stops, commas, question marks and exclamation marks in particular are badly used as an
indication of their insignificance in Arabic, which is not the case. Here are miscellaneous
examples:
1.The first example is taken from Al-Jurjani’s book: (bالبالغة ( )أسرارMysteries of Rhetoric, 3rd
ed., 1983: p.33):
282
" وأما احلالة األخرى اليت قلنا إن االسم فيها يكون استعارة من غري خالف فهي حالة إذا وقع االسم فيها مل يكن االسم
.جمتلباً إلثبات معناه للشيء وال الكالم موضوعاً لذلك ألن هذا حكم ال يكون إال إذا كان االسم يف منزلة اخلرب من املبتدأ
فأما إذا مل يكن كذلك وكان مبتدأً بنفسه أو فاعالً أو مفعوالً به أو مضافاً إليه فأنت واضع كالمك إلثبات أمر آخر غري
"ما هو معىن االسم:
(“The other case in which the name can unarguably be a metaphor is when the case of the
name does not entail confirming its meaning to an object nor speech is meant to imply that a
case that only occurs when the noun is functioning as a comment for a topic. In case it is not
so and instead it is a topic by itslef a subject an object or a genitive your speech means
something else other than the meaning of the noun in question”.)
Regardless of the translation of this paragraph into English, which is not the point here,
we can notice clearly that, apart from the use of one single full stop in the whole paragraph,
punctuation marks are completely ignored, even a full stop at the end is not used. The better,
more proper use of punctuation in this paragraph can be as follows:
" فهي حالة إذا وقع االسم فيها مل يكن االسم،وأما احلالة األخرى اليت قلنا إن االسم فيها يكون استعارة من غري خالف
ألن هذا حكم ال يكون إال إذا كان االسم يف منزلة اخلرب من، وال الكالم موضوعاً لذلك،جمتلباً إلثبات معناه للشيء
فأنت واضع كالمك إلثبات، أو مضافاً إليه، أو مفعوالً به،ً أو فاعال، وكان مبتدأ بنفسه، فأما إذا مل يكن كذلك.املبتدأ
أمر آخر غري ما هو معىن االسم."
Nine punctuation marks (8 commas and a full stop) are dropped from the original to no
good reason. A quick comparison of the two Arabic versions shows the great difference in the
degree of understandability of them. On the other hand, the absence of punctuation in both
versions of the TL (Arabic) and the SL (English) demonstrates the special importance of
punctuation marks in any piece of writing, and without them language will be ambiguous,
confusing and confused. This is illustrated more by comparing the unpunctuated English
version above, to the following properly punctuated one:
(“The other case in which the name can unarguably be a metaphor, is when the case of the
name does not entail confirming its meaning to an object, nor speech is meant to imply that a
case that only occurs when the noun is functioning as a comment for a topic. In case it is not
so, and, instead, it is a topic, a subject, an object, or a genitive, your speech means something
else other than the meaning of the noun in question.”)
283
Another striking example is taken from a book in Arabic about translation -it has just a
little more than its title about problems of translation! It is entitled, The Translation’s
Fundamentals, Principles and Applications, (1988). On page 143, it discusses punctuation and
claims vital importance for it. lronically, the examples given in English are translated into
Arabic with punctuation marks -especially the comma- dropped! e.g.
1. “The earth, the air, and the water, teem with delighted existence”. (imprecise punctuation of
the second and third commas). It is Translated into Arabic as follows:
(تعج األرض واهلواء بوجود هبيج.) (144) (Commas are dropped).
2.”Goodness is a virtual plant; it flourishes in good soil”:(الطيبة )اخلري نبات طيب يزدهر يف الرتبة
(op.cit.) (No punctuation marks used!)
(I have reservations on the English statements and their Arabic translations, but there is
no space for raising them here.) Throughout the whole book -which is a recent book!-
punctuation is terribly misused. Having said that, bad books like this one are, I hope, the
exception, not the rule among today’s publications, for several recent books are punctuated
satisfyingly.
In the following, only the most important, recurrent and complicated punctuation marks
are discussed:
"the comma, the semi-colon, the colon, the period/the full stop, the dash, the brackets, the
quotation marks/the inverted commas, the question mark and the exclamation mark".
1.The Comma: A comma has the following functions in English. Therefore, disregarding or
misusing it would result in ambiguity of some degree, lack of organization and inconvenient
reading and understanding process.
“You are most welcome any time, alone, with your family, or enjoying the company of
close friends.”:
( أو بصحبة أصدقاء محيمني، أو مع أسرتك، لوحدك،)أهالً وسهالً بك يف أي وقت.
The disregad of the three commas used here after a word, a phrase and a clause would
result in ambiguity and confusion. That is, ‘alone’ will be taken together with ‘with your
family’ which is contradictory, for one cannot be at the same time alone and with one’s
family. In a similar way, the omission of the third comma will confuse one’s family with
one’s friends. Such confusion will be reflected in the comprehension of the Arabic translation
unless these commas are retained.
Confusion can even take place at the level of consecutive individnal words if they are left
without cammas to set them off. e.g.
284
“He insists that he has four parents: his father, father-in-law, mother, and mother in law! .(
ومحاته، ووالدته، ومحاه، والده:)!يصر على أن له أربعة آباء
Apparently, the dropping of commas will lead the reader of both the English origin and
the Arabic translation (i.e. )والده محاه والدته محاتهto misread both ‘father’ and ‘father in law’, on
the one hand, and ‘mother’ and ‘mother in law’ on the other. He might reckon that two
unnecessary repetitions are used boringly in both languages, especially when a translator opts
for ( )والدfor the first pair, and ( )والدةfor the second, as the same term is used for both the
parents, and parents in law in some Arab Countries and Arabic dialects.
“The old man, left on his own by his sons, felt so depressed”:
( باالكتئاب، وقد تركه أبناؤه يعيش لوحده،)شعر الرجل املسن
It is clearer and easier for the reader of both English and Arabic texts to have two
commas to separate the interruptive clause ‘left...sons’ which performs two functions: first, to
state the reason for the old man’s depressron, and, secondly, to underline its importance, so
that it has interrupted the main clause apruptly. Without commas, both ambiguity of meaning
and structure, and failure to recognize this stylistic importance would occur in the Arabic
version.
285
a.Yusef Ali, Abdullah.
b. Nash, Walter.
c. Carter, Ronald.
etc.
With commas, we understand that the surname is first, while the first name is second.
That is, in Arabic the full name is( )عبد اهلل يوسف علي, ( )وولرت ناشand ( )رونالد كارترconsecutively.
On the other hand, without commas, these names will be mistranslated as (اهلل )يوسف علي عبد, (
)ناش وولرتand ( )كارتر رونالد, which are the upside down names, so to speak, in most Arab
countries, which is not acceptable.
6. To set off a non-restrictive, non-essential phrase or clause:
“Mrs. Margaret Thatcher, nicknamed the iron lady, was the first lady prime minister in the
UK.”:
( أول امرأة رئيسة للوزراء يف اململكة املتحدةb، امللقبة باملرأة احلديدية،)كانت السيدة مارجريت ثاتشر.
The non-restrictive relative clause between the two commas is an additional, highlighted
information about the subject, Mrs. Thatcher. So, enclosing it between two commas helps
understand its grammatical structure and function.
Thus, the stylistic functions of the comma are equally important in both languages,
English and Arabic. Yet, the case is not always so in other examples where the commas are
vital in English only, but not necessarily in Arabic. Therefore, commas are optional in Arabic
here. Yet, despite the fact that they are usualy ignored, they are recommended to be reserved:
286
“She is a good girl, but she is unable to cope with the new situation”:
() لكنها غري قادرة على التأقلم مع الوضع اجلديد،()إهنا فتاة طيبة
3. To indicate an omitted word or part of parallel constructions: e.g.
“Salma always cooks her lunch for herself Jane, hardly ever”:
()أما جني فهيهات،( )تطبخ سلمى دائماً بنفسها
4. to prevent misreading:e.g.
“When the meeting was over, the head left at once”:
(ً غادر الرئيس فوراb)،(االجتماع حينما انتهى.)
To sum up, the comma is generally either obligatorily retained, optionally or advisably
kept, or replaced by dropped punctuation marks like the dash, or greater and lesser symbol (<
>). (See Table below). Still, the translator is recommended to take all English commas into
account in Arabic.
2. The Colon (:): It is an important punctuation mark, used in English mainly to indicate the
following stylistic functions that have to be retained in the TL as properly as possible: (The
colons are underlined in both languages)
“You and I are in the same shoes: We are both waiting for the result of the exam.”
( كالنا ينتظر نتيجة االمتحان النهائي: )أنت وأنا يف الوضع نفسه
The sentence after the colon illstrates the preceding phrase ‘in the same shoes’. Another
clear example is the use of the colon hunderds of times in this book to introduce illustrative
examples or explanatory notes.
287
2.A Long quotation, statement or speech: e.g.
“After the headlines, here is the news: demonstrators in Indonesia stormed into the
Parliament building …”
( اقتحم متظاهرون يف إندونيسيا مبىن الربملان: إليكم األخبار،) بعد املوجز(العناوين...)
The whole news is coming after the colon, no matter how long it may be.
3.Introduction of a list of a series of names: e.g.
“Three major events took place in the Country last week: The resignation of the prime
minister, the new elections, and the celebration of the Independence Day.”
( واالحتفال بيوم، واالنتخابات اجلديدة، استقالة رئيس الوزراء:وقعت ثالثة أحداث كربى يف البالد يف األسبوع املاضي
)االستقالل(باليوم الوطين
The colon is used as a signal for introducing the three events in question.
4.Introducing the cause of something aforementioned: e.g.
“There was no hope for him this time : it was the third stroke”
(From Joyce’s The Sisters)
( فقد كانت الضربة القاضية:)ما كان عنده أمل هذه املرة
This use of the colon here is peculiar, intended to head the reason for the first statement
about ‘him’, to mean exactly ‘because/for’. However, this is a rather uncommon use of it.
The colon here is employed to accentuate the most important item in the statement:
GRADUATION. Although this function for the colon is ignored in favour of other emphatic
devices like capitalization, underlining, bold facing, italicizing, and fronting, it is still useable
and applicable.
6. Separating between the year of publication and page number of a book, etc.(e.g. Newmark,
1988: 63); two numbers of different reference (e.g. one to volume, another to page); and the
hour and minutes in American English (e.g. 10:30 (ten thirty)). The first two uses are
exemplified many times in this book.
It goes without saying that the colon has to be reserved in Arabic translations, except in
the last use which is conditioned by the established standards in Arabic language books and
references.
288
3. The period/full stop: The main use of the full stop is to mark the end of a declarative
sentence in both languages. Failing to use it leads to confusing sentences-and hence, ideas,
especially in Arabic which does not have the capitalization system of English: e.g.
“Many people are crowding in the main street. This is quite unusual." ( يتجمع أناس كثريون يف
ً هذا غري مألوف إطالقا.الشارع الرئيسي.)
Dropping the full stop in Arabic will confuse the reference of ()هذا, which could be
mistaken as a reference to ‘street’()الشارع.
Another use for the period is after abbreviations like: ‘Dr., km, Mr., Dept., etc.’ In
Arabic, however, the case varies. The period is either retained(Dr.: د.), replaced by a slash (Dr.
Ali: علي/)د, or dropped completely, especially when the full word is given(e.g. Dept.: قسم, Mr.:
)سيد.
The unfortunate situation in some Arabic texts is the negligence of the intersentential use
of the full stop, leaving the reader with some difficulties of reading and understanding. In
other words, the readability of Arabic translation is seriously affected.
4. The Semi-colon (;): The semicolon is used between two closely connected sentences to
indicate the strong relationship between them. In traditional Arabic, however, it is almost
absent, and in modern Arabic it is rarely used. Simply, it interchanges with the full stop in
Arabic. e.g.
“Millions of Muslims visit the two Holy Mosques in Makkah and Al-Madinah every
year; these millions come from all over the world”:( ماليني من املسلمني احلرمني الشريفني يف مكة يقصد
يأيت هؤالء املاليني من شىت أصقاع العامل. )املكرمة واملدينة املنورة كل عام.
5. The Dash (-):The dash has the primary function of marking an abrupt change or break in the
sequence of the sentence, with a good proportion of emphasis being implied. Usually
translators take care of this mark of punctuation in Arabic. But it interchanges with the comma
and greater or lesser marks (< >). e.g.
“The author of this book -I cannot remember his full name now- is dead”:
( ميت-) اآلن... ال أستطيع تذكر امسه الكامل (ال حيضرين امسه-إن مؤلف هذا الكتاب.)
6. The Question mark: used to mark a question, without which, sometimes it is difficult to
recognize whether a statement is a question or a declarative, especially in informal
conversation in both languages. e.g.
a. “Are you listening to me?”: ()هل تصغي إيل؟
b. You are listening to me(?)”: (إيل؟ )تصغي
There is no problem with (a) in both languages; but (b) cannot be distinguished in writing
from a declarative statement unless a question mark is used. In this case, it will be an informal
289
form of question in both languages for subject-verb inversion is ignored in English, and a
question particle like (هل/َ )أis not used in Arabic. It is a type of question of everyday
conversation that leans heavily on the tone of voice (i.e. low-rising tone).
The other type of question which has to be treated with care in translation is ‘rhetorical
question’ (وحbbمفت/ؤال بالغيbb)س. It is an open question, usually of a general nature, that demands
no immediate answer, or no answer at all. e.g.
a. “Who knows? An atheist might repent?”: ()اهلل )من يدري؟ لعل ملحداً يتوب (إىل
b. “The T.V. space channels have invaded homes. What’s next, minds?
( العقول؟، ماذا بعد.)لقد غزت القنوات التلفازية الفضائية البيوت.
The first question, ‘who knows?’, does not beg an answer at all, while the second,
‘what’s next, minds?’ requires no immediate answer now. The latter is posed to get the reader
involved in the argument about the invasion of homes by space channels, with all their
disadvantages more than advantages being insinuated. The next stage of this invasion could be
the people’s minds, who knows? And such a rhetorical question serves as a warning against
that invasion. The former question, on the other hand, paves the way for a possibility that
some would consider as impossible. Thus, the stylistic functions and implications of these
questions are vitally significant to the translated message.
Such questions are also the form of several verses of the Holy Koran: e.g.
(أن حييادر علىbb أليس ذلك بقbون أن يغفر اهلل لكم(؟)؛bbده(؟)؛ أال حتبbbاف عبbbاكرين(؟)؛ أليس اهلل بكbb بالشbأعلمbbأليس اهلل ب
)املوتى (؟)؛ أليس اهلل بأحكم احلاكمني(؟
(The question marks are mine). They are respectively:
All these questions demand no answers from us. Rather, they all imply ‘yes’ answers (
)بلى, which is a matter of course when put by God the Almighty.
7. The Exclamation mark(!): The exclamation mark has four important stylistic functions:
1. Exclamation: e.g.
“what a wonderful weather!” ()!يا له من طقس رائع
2. Exaggeration: e.g.
“This car is worth five hundred thousand dollars!” (ألف دوالر )!مثن هذه السيارة مخسمائة
290
3. Indication of strong, bad language: e.g.
a. Shut up! ()!أغلق فمك
b. Get off! ()!أُخرج
c. Hold it! (ِر ْسلك
على/ًمهال/)انتظر
d. Don’t move it! (إبق يف مكانك/)!ال تتحرك
4. Irony: e.g.
“Shut up! Oh, thank you, that’s very kind of you!”
(ما ألطفك/منك هذا لطف،ً)!أغلق فمك! أشكرك جدا.
In Arabic, usually the exclamation mark is kept, but sometimes it is doubled or tripled
with double or triple question marks, especially for exaggeration and irony. These stylistic
functions should be reflected in the TL by retaining exclamation marks.
1. Square brackets: [ ]
2. Brace brackets { }
3. Parentheses/round bracket ( )
Normally, square brackets are used for corrections, comments or additions within a
quoted material. In other words, they are used to mark a new material that is not originally
mentioned. As to brace brackets, they are used to connect words or lines that belong together.
e.g.
Bread potatoes
Butter apple FOOD
Dates fish
a. “The admiral (i.e. a kind of butterflies) is common in Europe and North America”
(explanation): ( نوع من الفراشات) شائعة يف أوربا وأمريكا الشمالية:)األدمريال األمحر (أي
b. “Some Indo-European. Languages(e.g. Latin) are dead now”
(exemplification): (أوربية(مثل الالتينية)لغات منقرضة-اهلندو )بعض اللغات
c.“Many countries (including some Arab countries) produce and export crude oil”
(exemplification) ()كثري من البلدان (من ضمنها بعض البالد العربية) منتجة للنفط اخلام ومصدرة له
d.“The number of casualties of the train crash has risen to (230)”:
291
(figures)() إصابة230( )ارتفع عدد اإلصابات يف حادث اصطدام القطارات إىل
e.“The basic elements of nature are four:(1) earth, (2) air, (3) water, (4)fire”:
(enumeration) () النار4( ،) املاء3( ،) اهلواء2( ،) الرتاب1( :)العناصر األساسية للطبيعة أربعة هي
1. Double quotation marks (“ ”): used in pairs to enclose quotations, titles, books, stories,
poems, chapters, radio and television programs, and words emphasized; or used in special
senses.
2. Single quotation marks (‘ ’): used in pairs to enclose a quotation within a quotation, a
word of special use or emphasis, or words in a series.
In Arabic, however, quotation marks of both types are either retained, or more commonly
changed into small parentheses (« »). In addition, and in place of some quotation marks, and
with the widespread computer facilities, both graphological devices and bold face type of
printing are widely employed to print quotations and words of special use and emphasis in
Arabic as much as in English (as this and other contemporary books demonstrate).
292
parenthesis (…) and
small parentheses « »:
9.Quotation marks ↔ -quotation marks/small parentheses.
CONCLUSIONS:
The foregoing discussion of the most prominent and recurrent stylistic problems with
their possible solutions in translation asserts that style is considerably important to the
message in both SL and TL texts. It is an implied part of meaning that has to be rendered into
the TL with care and full concentration. Contemporary studies of style have strongly
confirmed that it is inseparable from meaning. Since our whole concern in translation is with
meaning, we are required, then, to keep an open eye on the transmission of the style of the SL
text into the TL as closely and carefully as possible. By so doing, all the functions,
implications and reflections of the style of the original are completely and faithfully and
securely retained in the TL.
This great interest in style is a strong invitation to revolt against the carelessness and
negligence of many translators towards style in translation. The old-fashioned view of style as
irrelevant to the message no longer sustains these days, as the great number of stylistic studies
published and done now confirm. Hopefully, more justifications have been provided in this
chapter for the importance of style in translation .
It is significant to point out that the focus of the chapter has mainly been on
grammatical/syntactic and lexical/semantic stylistic problems. That is, whereas fronting,
293
parallelism, complex & simple sentences, short sentences, long sentences, and passive &
active styles are syntactic stylistic problems; repetition and variation, redundancy,
expressivity, nominalization & verbalization and irony are lexical stylistic problems. Only
formality vs. informality, ambiguity and punctuation marks are both syntactic and lexical
stylistic problems at the same time.
Having discussed three major types of translation problems in detail, grammatical, lexical and
stylistic, it is high time now to introduce the fourth and last major type of translation
problems: Phonological Problems.
EXERCISES
1. Two Arabic versions of translation are suggested down for this English text, with concentration
on tone. Which one is the good translation, and why? Point out the main stylistic features of the
distinctive tone of the second.
“ ‘Here is the news. First, the headlines… .’. For many people, ‘the news’ is an important
part of daily life, both on radio and television, and in the newspaper delivered to the home or
picked up in the newsagent’s or supermarket. But ‘the news’ is not the simple truth about
events, waiting out there to be passed on to the rest of the country. It is a ‘commodity’,
something manufactured by journalists and writers. Its material is language, and if we think of
language as a system or network of choices, we can see that the choices of vocabulary and
grammar made by journalists are what determine our understanding of an event which is
reported as ‘the news’.
It is therefore most important that we should be aware of the way in which our
knowledge of what goes on is constructed out of our reading of the news. The study of
language can help us to be critical, sometimes even skeptical, about what we are told.”
(From Freeborn et al, 1985: 164)
(1) " ،ةbbاليومي تعترب األخبار جزءاً مهماً من احلياة، بالنسبة لكثري من الناسb."... ونبدأها باملوجز.إليكم نشرة األخبار
حف أو من حملbb ائع صbb راؤها من بbb بيت أو يتم شbb bحف اليت ترسل إىل الbb b ويف الص،ازbb bانت يف اإلذاعة أم على التلفbb bواء أكbb bس
ر يف أحناء البالدb b b b b b واليت تنتظر على قارعة الطريق لتُن َش،داثbb b b b b b b bار‘ ليست احلقيقة الكاملة عن األحbb b b b b b b b بيد أن ’األخب.جتاري
294
امbb وإذا ما فهمنا اللغة على أهنا نظ،ةbb b مادته اللغ،ابbb bّحفيني وال ُكتbb bدي الصbb bناعته بأيbb bيء متت صbb b ش,‘اعةbb b إهنا ’بض.رىbb bاألخ
حفيون هي اليت حتدد فهمناbb ميكننا أن ندرك أن خيارات املفردات والقواعد اليت قام هبا الص،اختيار أو شبكة من االختيارات
‘للحدث الذي نُقل إلينا ’باألخبار."
إن دراسة اللغة كفيلة.لذا من األمهية مبكان أن نعي الطرق اليت تتكون فيها معرفتنا مبا جيري من خالل قراءتنا لألخبار
ًمبساعدتنا على أن نكون ناقدين ملا يتم إخبارنا به بل وشكاكني به أحيانا."
“It was the best of times, it was the worst of times, it was the age of wisdom, it was the
age of foolishness, it was the epoch of belief, it was the epoch of incredulity, it was the season
of Light, it was the season of Darkness, it was the spring of hope, it was the winter of despair,
we had everything before us, we had nothing before us … .
There were a king with a large jaw and a queen with a plain face, on the throne of
England; there were a king with a large jaw and a queen with a fair face, on the throne of
France.”
(Charles Dickens’ Opening to A Tale of Two Cities. Printed in Nash, 1989: 188)
3. The following paragraph is unusually verbless, except the last sentence. Besides, it
invests the style of short sentences. There are several stylistic functions for such
structuring, like the reflection of the unimportance of any action, especially by
people; the possibility of understanding the text by means of following the directions
and locations of pieces of furniture and items mentioned; the state of chaos of the
room, which either reflects the condition of confusion and uncertainty of people
involved, or is intended to be a joke played on them, etc. So, the Arabic translation
has to take these and other potential implications of the style of the original into
295
account, by translating it into imperfect nominal sentences, namely, some sentences
may have a topic only, or a comment only in a prepositional or an adverbial nominal
phrase:
“A room. A window in the back wall, the bottom half covered by a sack. An iron bed
along the left wall. Above it a small cupboard, paint buckets, boxes containing nuts, screws,
etc. More boxes, vases, by the side of the bed. A door, up right. To the right of the window, a
mound: a kitchen sink, a step-ladder, a coal bucket, a lawn-mower, a shopping trolley, boxes,
sideboard drawers. Under this mound on an iron bed. In front of it a gas stove. On the gas
stove a statue … . Down right, a fireplace. Aroud it a couple of suitcases, a rolled carpet, a
blow-lamp, a wooden chair on its side, boxes, a number of ornaments, a clothes horse, a few
short planks of wood, a small electric fire and a very old electric toaster. Below this a pile of
old newspapers. A bucket hangs from the ceiling.”
(From Harold Pinter’s The Caretaker, op.cit.: 191)
4. The style of complex and long sentences has considerable stylistic effects, that
require to be retrieved into Arabic by translators. This passage is about the
implications of old age. It is an Aristotelian, philosophical, passive and
uncomfortable, but realistic view of old age. This passivity and discomfort is
sometimes reflected by unfluent sentence structure (e.g. the second sentence) because
of interruptive phrases and clauses. Another type of long sentence, which is quite
frequent here, is displayed by the causative clause (headed by words like ‘because,
for, as, since, due to, owing to, etc.) –used fourteen times. Also the co-ordinate
phrases, clauses and sentences initiated by the conjunction of addition, ‘and’ are
abundantly used to accumulate as much as link ideas and structures together to unite
the whole text. These and other stylistic functions cannot be rendered into Arabic
unless this text is translated with these stylistic considerations in mind. This can be
achieved by sticking as closely and directly as possible to the style of the original in a
straightforward way, keeping complexity of sentence structure and clause order in
Arabic as it exactly is in English as far as Arabic clause and sentence structure
allows. As usual, punctuation marks have to be fully attended to in Arabic here as
anywhere else in translation:
“Older men and those who have passed their prime have in most cases characters
opposite to those of the young. For, owing to their having lived many years and having been
more often deceived by others or made more mistakes themselves, and since most human
things turn out badly, they are positive about nothing, and in everything they show an
excessive lack of energy. They always ‘think’, but ‘know’ nothing; and in their hesitation they
always add ‘perhaps’ or ‘maybe’; all their statements are of this kind, never unqualified. They
are malicious; for malice consists in looking upon the worst side of everything. Further, they
are always suspicious owing to mistrust, and mistrustful owing to experience. And neither
their love nor their hatred is strong for the same reasons; but, according to the precept of Bias,
they love as if they would one day love. And they are little-minded, because they have been
296
humbled by life; for they desire nothing great or uncommon, but only the necessaries of life.
They are not generous, for property is one of these necessaries, and at the same time, they
know from experience how hard it is to get and how easy to lose. And they are cowardly and
inclined to anticipate evil, for their state of mind is the opposite of that of the young, they are
chilled, whereas the young are hot, so that old age paves the way for cowardice, for fear is a
kind of chill. And they are fond of life, especially in their last days, because desire is directed
towards that which is absent and men especially desire what they lack. And they are unduly
selfish [and] self-loving, for this is also littleness of mind. And they live not for the noble, but
for the useful, more than they ought to, because they are selfish; for the useful is good for the
individual, whereas the noble is good absolutely.”
(Aristotle, op.cit.: 207-8)
5. Translate the following journalistic-scientific text into as simple and direct style as
possible by means of retaining the style of the original with regard to technical terms
(some of which are already translated), sentence structure and voice in particular:
6. The following two texts display a similar message with two different styles, one
active, another passive. Each style has certain stylistic implications which affect the
message heavily. Moreover, bluntness and a sense of irony are implied in the
grammatical structure of the first sentence of the active style, set by analogy to the
famous English proverb, ‘you can lead a horse to the water, but you cannot make him
drink’. For these and other good stylistic reasons, translate these two texts into
Arabic in two equally different styles corresponding to those of the original. This can
be done by keeping as close to the SL style as possible:
(a) “You can make a man fit seat-belts on his car, but you can’t make him wear one. The
police can’t (as yet) prosecute him. Safety councils and other bodies may advise him,
but that’s all. You can never pass laws to make people behave prudently.”
297
(b) “Though seat-belts may be compulsorily fitted in motor vehicles, no driver can be
compelled to wear one. He cannot (as yet) be prosecuted by the police. He may be
advised, but no more than that, by safety councils and other bodies. Prudent
behaviour can never be enforced by law.”
(Nash,1980: 140-41)
7. Two Arabic translations are provided for the following English text. The second one
is written in the style of a show of muscles. What does this kind of style exactly
mean, and how ironical does it sound? Pick up the features of language that mark it
here in this version , in parallel to the normal features of the first translation:
“A well-known scientist (some say it was Bertrand Russell) once gave a public lecture on
astronomy . He described how the earth orbits around the sun and how the sun, in turn, orbits
around the center, a vast collection of stars called our galaxy. At the end of the lecture, a little
old lady at the back of the room got up and said: ‘What you have told us is rubbish. The world
is really a flat plate supported on the back of a giant tortoise’. The scientist gave a superior
smile before replying, ‘What is the tortoise standing on?’ ‘You’re very clever, young man,
very clever,’ said the old lady. ‘But it’s turles all the way down!’ ”
(From Baker, 1992: 261)
(1) " فقد وصف كيف.راسل) مرة بإلقاء حماضرة عامة عن علم الفلك ِّ قام عامل معروف(بعضهم يقول إنه بريتراند
يف هناية. من الكواكب تدعى اجملرةbتدور األرض حول الشمس وكيف تدور الشمس بدورها حول مركز جمموعة ضخمة
فالعامل يف احلقيقة طبق مسطح قائم على. ’ما أخربتنا به هراء:احملاضرة قامت سيدة عجوز صغرية يف آخر القاعة وقالت
قالت السيدة.‘ ’على ماذا تقف السلحفاة؟: ابتسم العامل ابتسامة متعالية قبل أن جييب بقولهb.‘ظهر ُسلَ ْحفاة عمالقة
ولكنها سالحف أخرى هو كل ما حتتها.ً ذكي جدا, ’إنك ذكي جداً أيها الشاب:‘!العجوز."
(2) " رسل الغين عن التعريف)مرة بإلقاء حماضرة عامة مشهودة عنّ قام عامل واسع الشهرة (قيل ما هو إال بريتراند
إذ كان سخياً يف بذل الشروحات عن كيفية دوران األرض حول الشمس ودوران الشمس بدورها حول. الفلكbعلم
يف هناية احملاضرة انتفضت من فورها سيدة أصاهبا الكرب ووهن العظم. هائلة من النجوم السيارة تدعى اجملرةbمركز جمموعة
فما العامل إال آنية مفلطحة.’ما تفوهت به ُتّرهات برتهات:منها تقبع يف الصفوف اخللفية للردهة وقالت بأعلى صوهتا
ٍ فتبسم العامل ساخراً من قوهلا وقال بأنفة.‘تستند إىل عقب سلحفاة جبارة
’عالم تتكئ السلحفاة إذاً يا أفالطون:وتيه
لكن ما حتت السلحفاة. ذكاؤك خارق، ’إنك خارق الذكاء أيها الشاب اليافع:زمانك؟‘ أردفت العجوز احلَْيَزبون قائلة ِ
"‘!إال سالحف وسالحف وسالحف
8. The following text is mainly military and economic. It is a little long and complicated
in style concerning sentence/clause structure and vocabulary. Although it is always
advisable to take it into account in translation, style might be less important than
information, as the case here. Therefore, we can translate this text giving precedence
to contents and solving the problems of translating difficult words,expressions and
grammatical structures, with no great interest in style. However, style may be useful
298
in this respect, by translating as directly and closely to the original structure as
possible into Arabic:
Translate the remaining part of this text (the greater part of which is already
translated), setting an example for how to apply that in practice, and how to translate
some special military and economic terms in particular. Feel free at suggesting other
possibilities for some expressions and structures that can be equally feasible:
MANPOWER
50 million people employed in
meeting the demand
for military goods and services
"Tens of millions of persons around the world are engaged in military activities, whether
as soldiers, sailors, airmen, bureaucrats, scientists, engineers or general workers. It has been
estimated that over 100 million people are affected, directly or indirectly, by the $500
thousand million that the world now devotes to military preparations. It has not been possible
to substantiate this figure, but the estimates derived below suggest that roughly 50 million
people are employed in meeting the demand for military goods and services, either directly or
indirectly.
Even this latter figure covers categories of labour that differ in the manner and the degree
to which they depend on military outlays. For our purposes it is useful to distinguish between
five categories of demand for labour that can be said to be generated or supported by military
expenditures:
a) The labour force, including uniformed military personnel, engaged directly by defence
ministries to render services or to provide goods and services that are exclusively military in
character, that is, goods and services that for all practical purposes have no civilian utility
whatever;
b) The labour force engaged in supplying intermediate goods and services to the concerns
engaged in meeting the direct demand from ministries of defence for finished and specialized
military goods and services. This indirect employment supported by military expenditures
relates to employment by subcontractors, by firms supplying the subcontractors and so on.
There will clearly be at this level a lingering degree of specialization for military work, but
this would diminish sharply as one moved down the manufacfuring chain;
c) The labour force in manufacturing and service industries engaged in meeting the direct
demand from ministries of defence for goods and services that are little different from those of
the civilian market;
299
d) The labour force engaged in supplying intermediate goods to the concerns under (c), that is,
;a second category of labour services supported indirectly by military expenditures
e) The labour force stemming from the multiplier concept, which is quite distinct from the
other four categories. All expenditure, including military expenditure, is subject to a multiplier
effect that permeates throughout the economy. If, say, the multiplier in a particular country is
estimated to be two, expenditure of $10 thousand million will ultimately result in a total
”increment in effective demand of $20 thousand million.
القوى العاملة
مخسون مليوناً من البشر ميارسون أعماالً تستهدف
تلبية الطلب على السلع واخلدمات العسكرية
جbويني" يقوم عشرات املاليني من البشر يف كافة أرجbاء العbامل بأنشbطة عسbكرية إما كجنbود أو كمالحني حبريني أو
أو مbbوظفني إداريني وعلمbbيني ،أو مهندسني أو عمbbال بوجه عbbام .وقد قbbدر أن ما يربو على 100مليbbون من األشbbخاص هم
على ص bb bلة م bb bا ،مباش bb bرة أو بش bb bكل غري مباش bb bر ،مببلغ الـ 500ألف ملي bb bون دوالر اليت خيصصbb bها العbb bامل حالي b bاً للتجهbb bيزات
العسكرية .ومل يكن باإلمكان إثبات صحة هذا الرقم ،غري أن التقديرات الواردة أدناه توحي بأن قرابة 50مليوناً من الناس
ستخدمون ،بصورة مباشرة أو غري مباشرة ،لتلبية الطلب على السلع واخلدمات العسكرية .يُ َ
وحىت هbbذا الbbرقم األخري يشbbمل فئbbات من القbbوى العاملة ختتلف فيما بينها من حيث كيفية اعتمادها على النفقbbات
العسbbكرية وإىل أي مbbدى .وألغbbراض هbbذه الدراسة من املفيد التميbbيز بني مخس فئbbات للطلب bعلى القbbوى العاملة الbbذي ميكن
.اعتباره ناشئاً عن النفقات العسكرية أو مدعوماً منها
)أ( القوى العاملة ،مبا يف ذلك األفراد العسكريون الذين يرتbدون الbزي العسbكري ،واليت تسbتخدمها بصbورة مباشbرة وزارات
.الدفاع ألداء خدمات أو لتوفري سلع bوخدمات ذات طابع عسكري حمض ،أي ليس هلا من الناحية العملية bأية فائدة مدنية
القbb b bوى العاملة املعنية بتوفري السbb b bلع واخلدمات الوسbb b bيطة bللمؤسسbb b bات املهتمة bباالسbb b bتجابة للطلب bاملباشر من وزارات )ب(
الbb b bدفاع على السbb b bلع العسbb b bكرية التامة الصbb b bنع واملتخصصة وعلى اخلدمات .وتتعلق هbb b bذه العمالة غري املباش bb bرة اليت ت bb bدعمهاb
300
ومن الواضح أنه.راb جbاطن وهلمbدين من البbورد للمتعاقbbركات اليت تbاطن من الشbbدين من البbكرية بعمالة املتعاقbالنفقات العس
دة كلماbb تنخفض بشbb غري أن تلك البقية الباقية س،كريةbb bال العسbb bتوى بقية باقية من التخصص يف األعمbb bذا املسbb bيظل يف هbb bس
bهبطنا على سلم الصناعة التحويلية."
Chapter Four
PHONOLOGICAL PROBLEMS
Introduction:
301
Although sounds are the constituents of words in language, they are not always
significant, nor can they be individually important. Only when they combine together more
homogeneously than heterogeneously in different forms of patterns, can they be described as
important, and called sound features. Here are the most prominent ones:
1. Rhyme (a kind of phonetic echo or matching found in verse in particular at the end of the
words and lines in both English and Arabic): ()القافية
2. Rhythm (regular stressed and unstressed syllables in poetry. In general terms, it is a kind
of melody in language that might include mainly meter and foot, and generally all the
phonological features which contribute to the musical arrangement of language):
()اإليقاع
3. Alliteration (a kind of initial rhyme that involves the repetition of the same consonant
sound at the beginning of two or more usually consecutive words in English. In Arabic,
however, it is at the end of words:(e.g. your footsteps feel from grass to granite: يف وقع
ِ ب وإىل العش
ب ِ )خطاك على الصل (السجع
َ )
4. Assonance: (a half alliteration that occurs when the same vowel sound is repeated in the
middle of two or more usually consecutive words. In Arabic it is not as clear as in
English: ( e.g. rose and sole/soul)): ( الصوائتb)سجع
5. Consonance (a half-rhyme realized by using the same consonant sound at the end of two
or more usually successive words, preceded by different vowels. It is similar to
alliteration in Arabic (e.g. round and find)): ()سجع الصوامت
6. Chiming (two or more words similar in spelling and close in sound/pronunciation, with a
kind of alliteration common between them, taken to be identical in meaning, but in
reality they are not (e.g. men and mice): ()تآلف الصوت واملعىن
7. Onomatopoeia (conformity of sound to meaning in both languages (e.g. bang, quack,
cuckoo, etc.; طقطق، ربت،) فحيح: ()حماكاة الصوت للمعىن
8. Prosody (the study of the art of versification regarding sound features in poetry in
general) () َعروض
9. Meter (rhythmic arrangement of syllables in poetry according to the number and kind of
foot in the line of verse): ()البحر
10. Foot (a line unit of a line of verse that contains stressed and unstressed syllables):()التفعيلة
11. Beat (the basic rhythmic unit, or the stressed syllable in a foot): املشدد) (شطر التفعيلة
12. Off-beat (an unstressed syllable in a foot): ()شطر التفعيلة املخفف
13. Scansion/scanning ()تقطيع شعري
302
14. Tone/stress/pitch (describe voice and its layers): (الصوت وطبقة،) والنرب(الشَّدة،)النغمة
These are the main sound/prosodic features which can be important in translation, when
clustered together in a relationship of some kind, to have an impact on the message.
In support of the importance of sounds, Lawson stresses the fact that “much more
meaning is conveyed by rhythm and stress than we recognize…” (1979. Printed in Duff,
1981: 97). More surprisingly, sound effects can be more important to translators than
meaning, not only in poetry, but also in ordinary language and realistic narrative, as this
example (adopted from Newmark, 1988: 58) which is translated from German:
4.1.Miscellaneous examples
303
The following examples will display some phonological problems of translation,
alongside of their suggested solutions. We start with the less difficult and important, to end
with the most difficult and significant types of examples:
It must be admitted that these examples are fairly easy to translate, for they have their
ready-made Arabic equivalents, provided by the translator readily, perhaps without sensing
the value of sound effects. Let us have a more difficult set of examples:
304
forced to cut (ضرييب )إىل اقتطاع
License fee ()على البث التلفزي
(a British quality newspaper’s headline).
In the first example two features help retain the rhythm of the sentence:
In the second example, the same can be said of the rhythmical: (نرجس-جيلس-عرس
ْ ). and
ْ ْ
the backgrounding of ( )جيلسto fit better with rhyme.
As to the third example, it is difficult to echo the alliteration and syllabic symmetry of
the original perfectly in Arabic. That is, ‘bad sad and mad’, are alliterative by virtue of the ‘d’
sound, assonantal by means of the sound (æ), and perfectly balanced as they are one syllable
each. The Arabic version, however, tries its best to match the original by achieving a good
rhyme by means of the feminine endings of the three adjectives, alongside the letter ()ن, to
combine together an agreeable end-rhyme (هbْ b )نamong the three of them. But this is done at
the expense of precision of equivalence with regard to the translation of ‘bad’, into ()نتنة
(which collocates with ‘smell’, rather) instead of the more precise(b )سيئةfor reasons of better
rhyming.
The fourth example, on the other hand, is a newspaper headline, using poetic rhyme in a
serious subject as an indication of irony. The Arabic translation tries to imitate the SL rhyme
in the best way possible.
The fifth and final example has a partial rhyme in English, reflecting the part of the
problem in question. In Arabic, the translation cannot match even this partial rhyme. At its
best, it makes ( )فحمrhyme in the same way with the backgrounded ( )دعائم, to match it with
the message.
305
4.2. Advertisements:
4. The biggest hamburger under the bun.(اخلبزbb bامبورجر بbb bه أكرب/املدور
َّ ما أطيب اهلامبورجر يف اخلبز
)املدور.
5. Why do you think we make Nattall’s Mintoes such a devilishly smooth, cool, creamy,
minty, chewy, round, slow, velvety, clean, solid, buttery taste?
( ،ةbbقوي ،ةbb نقي،ةbb خمملي،يابيةbb انس،دورةbb م،ةbb لباني،ةbb نعناعي،ةbb طري،اردةbb ب،ةbbول بنكهة سلسbbات النتهbbملاذا يف رأيك نعمل نعناع
)زبدية
Here rhyme and rhythm are more powerful than the message. They are intended to attract
customers and draw their attention to the advertised product, which is the first, preliminary
step of selling it. That is the reason for concentrating in the Arabic translation on producing
effective rhythmical language, perhaps at the expense of the message which leans heavily on
sound effects, or else it would not be considered in the first place.
In (1), the word (بيبbb( )لclever) is added for the sake of creating a perfectly pleasant
rhyme, This helps achieve the stylistic function of interesting as much as attracting
readers/customers.
In (2), however, nothing is added, but ‘recede’(i.e.( ينحسرis translated into its function
rather than direct, close meaning. That is, the recession of hair leads to baldness(لعbb )الص.
Secondly, the rhyme between (لعbb b b يصand (زرعbb b b يenforces the intended function of the
advertisement.
306
4. Change of word class: the verbs ‘work’ ( )ينشطand ‘rest’ ( )يرتاحare changed into nouns’(
)نشاط وراحة.
Example (4) is close to informal Arabic, with more than one change made: ‘The biggest’
is translated freely into the informal ( )ما أطيبinstead of (bأعظم/ربbb)أك.. ‘Bun’ is translated into
plural as ((املدور
اخلبز, instead of the singular (دورةbb بزة مbb ( )خone bread).another good, closer
version could .()أكرب هامبورجر باخلبز املدور
The last example (5) has been translated directly and closely into Arabic, with a good
proportion of rhyme being achieved, thanks to the feminine endings of adjectives.
4.3. Poetry:
Perhaps the most important and recurrent phonological features are used in poetry. It can be
described as the variety of language which is based on sound, prosodic features and effects. An aesthetic
type of language like poetry demands a special attention by translators to sounds, or else the beauty as
well as the message will be distorted.
On the other hand, such density and richness of sound features and effects poses an
extremely difficult problem of translation, and could rightly be considered as the most difficult
problem to students of translation in particular, and to all translators in general.
The case is really so, as the transmission of such features and effects is disrupted by
many frustrations and disappointments. Yet, it is possible, not to perfection, but to
satisfaction, though. It is hoped that the following examples would prove that. At the same
time, and in the course of discussion, several problems of translating poetry are pointed out,
followed by suggested solutions to them:
307
Or the rest will be wanting one, too!’ راحةbb b b b b b b b b b b b اقي بصbb b b b b b b b b b b b تهاه البbb b b b b b b b b b b b اش وإال
(From Nash,1985: 52)
Since these lines of verse are a joke, considerable changes are made in Arabic:
1.The city, ‘Crewe’ (in the Northwest of England) is replaced by a general word ()مدينة. (city),
for it is not so important to the text, and has special cultural implications. So, using ()مدينة
instead, makes reference neutral, rather than cultural (see 2.9. earlier), and, hence, more
understandable. In addition, it meets the requirements of rhyme. The same applies to ‘stew’
which is translated into a more general word (وربةbb( )شsoup) rather than the less known, but
more accurate .( وجبة( )خينةis also applicable here).
2.‘Don’t shout’ (رخbb )ال تصis translated freely into ‘listen to my advice/take my word’(ذهاbb خ
)نصيحة.
3.The word (يحةbb( )فضi.e. scandal), is not used in the original, but inferred from ‘don’t shout’
and ‘wave it about’, to rhyme with, as much as match (يحةbb )نصto create a relationship of
contrast that is well-established in Arabic culture. Hence, it has performed two functions: to
achieve rhyme; and more importantly, to bring about a humorous atmosphere.
4. In the last line, ‘wanting (يطلب/دb )يريis translated into (تهىb )اشwhich is sharper, more direct
and expressive than the former, to heighten the effect of the punch-line of the whole joke. In
addition, the last word ( )بصراحةis added just for convenience of rhyme with the previous two
lines.
308
She lived unknown, and few could know عرفت
ْ ٌ وقلة،جمهولةً عاشت
When Lucy ceased to be; انطفأت
ْ حني اختفت لوسي وحياهتا
But she is in her grave, and oh, يا ويليت،لكنها يف قربها
The difference to me! ِ
!واملوت شتان ما بني حياهتا
(William Wordsworth. From Carter and Brumfit (eds), 1986: 135)
The Arabic Translation gives prime importance to rhyme and rhythm, but not at the expense of
meaning, anyway. To achieve that, three main procedures have been employed freely, one
grammatical/stylistic, another lexical, and a third translational:
1. The change of normal word order, or, the stylistic device of FRONTING:
(متخفية )عن العيون instead of متخفية عن العيون
(متجلية)يف السماء instead of متجلية يف السماء
()جمهولة عاشت rather than عاشت جمهولة
()قلة عرفت... instead of عرفت قلة
()حياهتا انطفأت instead of انطفأت حياهتا
2. Synonymy: e.g.
( )هبيمةrather than منها ال رجعة/جمهولة املولود فيها مفقود/
()شرذمة , instead of جمموعة/حفنة/قلة قليلة
()متخفية instead of / خفية/خمتفية/خمتبئة
()لؤلؤية , not ( )متأللئةfor instance
()متجلية preferred to ساطعة/المعة
3. Expansion: This procedure means the translation of one word into two or more words
in Arabic:
309
‘O where are you going’ ? Said reader to rider للفارس
ْ أين ذهابك يا هذا؟ قال القارئ
‘That valley is fatal when furnaces burn, ذاك الوادي مميت حينما تشتعل األفران
Yonder’s the midden whose odors will madden, هنالك مزبلة بروائح منتنة جبنو ْن
‘That gap is the grave where the tall return’. .تلك اهلوة قرب حيث يعود اجلبارو ْن
310
5. Employing lexical and grammatical gaps (i.e. syntactic structures and words left out
of the poem but implied within).
Priority is given to rhyme and rhythm, as always the case with the translation of poetry
into Arabic, for they are the cornerstone of verse. Consequently, a poem with no rhyme and
rhythm in particular would be considered in effect poor, because what sets poetry aside from
ordinary language is chiefly its aesthetic, prosodic features, on top of which are rhyme and
rhythm. This is the case - especially in Arabic - for the norms of writing, reading, perceiving
and, hence, translating poetry are to be rhymed and rhythmical. Otherwise, it is not worthy of
interest in the eyes of the public. This view is confirmed by the criticism of ‘blank verse’ (الشعر
)احلر غري املقفىin Arabic in the forties-sixties of the Twentieth Century, which is a kind of
modern poetry with no concern with rhyme and rhythm. It is closer to prose, rather. Hence its
notorious nickname, ‘prosaic poetry’ (ورbb bعر املنثbb b)الش, to insinuate its semi-poetic identity. It
should not be confused with the well-established and fully recognized ‘free verse’ (احلر عرb)الش,
which is based on rhyme, rhythm, foot and meter, the bases of classical poetry(or Qasidah),
with some differences between the two types concerning the layout and number of rhymes in
the same poem, though.
The English original does not have a perfect rhyme. This puts it on equal footing with the
Arabic version, which is not perfectly rhymed too. Take for example, the first line of each
stanza; it does not rhyme with the rest of the lines of the stanza (see للقارئ، للسامع، للسائر،للفارس
). However, they are made to achieve a semi-rhyme with one another by virtue of the long (
)آ/æ/, which is a common motif (or main feature) among them, and their strong end-stop(
)سكون. Also, ( )أفرانhalf-rhymes with ( اجلبارون، )جبنون. The last stanza (or quatrain) has no end-
rhyme at all. Yet meter and foot compensate for that somehow.
As to synonymy, it plays a critical function in the realization of rhyme and rhythm. That
is, many words are chosen among large lexical sets from which translators can feel free to
some extent to select the closest word(s) - especially key words - to achieve both features, and
then accuracy of meaning, sometimes closely, sometimes loosely. In any case, the selected
synonym has to be within the range of the semantic dimension of the original word of the SL
poem. This is how it is done in practice:
A Sample Example:
311
We take, for instance, the title word, ‘song’. We start looking for the commonest
equivalent Arabic word for it. It is of course, (b)أغنية. Then we check some of its synonyms like
( طقطوقة ، موشح، أُرجوزة، نشيد،)أنشودة. Perhaps we need a reference of some kind to help us in our
search, say, a dictionary of synonyms in both languages. Luckily they are available in English,
but unfortunately not many in Arabic. However, good bilingual dictionaries are available, and
can be quite useful. Having collected some good synonyms, we can now compare them to one
another to choose the most appropriate in this context, bearing in mind sense, rhyme and
rhythm. The best choice is the one that meets the conditions of the three together, then rhyme
and rhythm, then meaning only. In other types of texts, however, priority is given to meaning.
On the other hand, the title allows more space for freedom of choice even outside the scope of
its direct meaning. Yet, the closer to the original, the better. Hence the election of (ودةbb )أنش
which could be more poetic and emotive than (b)أغنية. Moreover, the latter usually connotes
love poetry unless modified )as in (bوطنية/دينية b( أغنيةreligious/national song). ()نشيد, on the other
hand, is confined to certain contexts of nationalism, religion and may be social topics. Hence
‘the National Anthem’ (يد الوطينbb )النش. So it may not be the best choice here. The remaining
three terms are of narrowly specific reference to certain types of traditional Arabic popular
songs and ballads. Therefore, they are left out.
More difficult and confusing is the decision to select the proper word among a host of
choices available in language for some key words in the poem. At the same time, a wide
choice like this might facilitate the process. A good example could be the key word, ‘horror’:
the list of synonyms is long, including the following: ( ،لbb وج،زعbb ف،عbb هل، رعب،ديدbbوف شbb خ،وفbbخ
رهبة،يةbb خش،زعb)ج. The choice of (b )هلعis based on two criteria: (1) the degree of the feeling of
fear in ‘horror’, which is the highest (see 2.2. earlier); and (2) rhyme and rhythm, as ()هلع
rhymes partially with (امعbb)س, and at the same time meets the requirements of meter and foot
(i.e. rhythm) in Arabic. Nevertheless, not all the words of the poem are equally important, or
have a wide range of synonyms (e.g. ‘reader, going, looking, discover, madden, trees, hearer
and the greater part of words). However, this limits the freedom of choice, which in turn might
affect rhyme and rhythm in particular.
The change of word order is invested to a maximum degree in Arabic for its flexibility
much more than English in this respect. Further, the stylistic technique of deviation from the
normal word order is always licensed and justified in Arabic poetry in particular. Hence the
well-known statements: (ريهbbاعر ما ال جيوز لغbb( )جيوز للشLit.: ‘What is permitted for the poet is not
permitted for others’); and (الشعر ضرورة/( )الضرورة الشعريةpoetic license). e.g.
312
(a) (جداً ثاقبة )النظرةinstead of (ً)النظرة ثاقبة جدا
(b) (عجله يأتيك الشبح
ْ )من خلفك يفrather than ( يأتيك الشبح من خلفك...)
(c) ( )خطواتك أبداً لن تثمرin the place of (ً)لن تثمر خطواتك أبدا
(d) ( )إذ يف إثرك هم ماضونinstead of ()إذ هم ماضون يف إثرك
(e) ()حني هنالك خلّفهم, replacing ()حني خلفهم هنالك
The disruption of the word order of these phrases is merely for achieving rhyme and
rhythm, neither more nor less. However, this is vitally important for the poem and its
reception and approval by readers.
As regards the alteration of the grammatical classes of words, it is another tool used in
the translation of poetry to accomplish rhyme and rhythm again. e.g.
(f) is quite interesting for it involves changing not only the word class, but also changing
it into a relative clause, which is quite rare in language varieties other than poetry. But the
most interesting example is the last one which is an exploitation of ‘poetic license’. That is, in
Arabic, the plural of ( ) َعْيبis (وبbb )عيnot ( ) ِعيَبwhich is used here as a poetic license for
reasons of rhyme and rhythm.
The final procedure employed in the translation of this poem is the so-called ‘lexical and
grammatical gaps’ (bج اللفظية والقواعدية
ُ رbَ b b( )ال ُفsee Newmark, 1988: ch.12; and its translation,
Ghazala, 2004/2006: Ch. 12). They refer to grammatical features and words which are missing
from the original text, but implied in it and understood from context. Here are illustrative
examples from the poem:
(a) (الصلب
َّ ) implies (األرض/( )الصخرi.e. الصلبة األرض/)الصخر الصلب
(b) ( )يف ط َفحاتwith ()شكل )يظهر (يفmissing, but implied.
313
(c) (إثرك )هم يفimplies the omitted (ماضون يف إثرك/آتون/)قادمون
(d) ( )يا هذاused once in every stanza, to stand for an implied vocative in the SL
poem.
These gaps are frequent in language, especially the Holy Quran, poetry and conversation.
They are missing words or grammatical structures and categories for reasons of rhetoric,
rhyme and rhythm, clarity of meaning and/or conciseness. All these reasons are employed in
poetry whenever necessary. Here, they are generally used for convenience of rhyme and
rhythm in the main. The last example is in the opposite direction, namely, it is used to fill in a
lexical gap of vocative(داءbb )النin Arabic, but not in English, for there is no vocative case in
English grammar as understood in Arabic. As to grammatical gaps, they are not exemplified
in Arabic for many of them -like the subject, object, and topic and comment in particular- are
common and used sometimes unconsciously in almost any piece of Arabic language, whether
written or spoken. They are hidden (ترتةbb )مسor implicit (مرةbb مض/دَّرةbb) ُم َق. Therefore, examples
would be redundant and unnecessary.
Now, another Arabic version for the last three stanzas of Auden’s poem is suggested
below. It is completely free and made to conform perfectly with the classical Arabic poetry
(i.e. Qasidah (i.e. يدةbb bالقص/وديbb bعر العمbb b )الشin terms of layout, rhyme and rhythm (see also
Lefeveré, 1992: ch. 6). Only the spirit of the message of the original is retained:
الرعب قال وعرّب ا ما اخلطب طريُ ما جرى
أشباح رعب قد ترى املعتل يف أحشائه
ّ للسامع
من خلفك الرعب سرى يف جوف أشجا ٍر لوت
فوق الثرى حتت الثرى ٍ
بنعومة ٍ
بعجالة
جلد تبقَّع واهرتا يا مبتلى هذا الوبا
ومغادر من بيتنا يا قارئاً أنا فارس
ماتت خطاك فسر بنا يا خائفاً أنا سائر
يف إثرك أشباحنا يا رعبنا أنا سامع
يف مأمن عنا هنا حني نأى عنهم هناك
The poem’s meter is the popular(الكامل ( )البحرLit.: ‘The perfect/complete meter’), which
is two/three long feet for each hemistich(i.e. )شطرof the line of verse, as follows:
///0//0 (/0/0//0) ///0//0 ///0//0
(متَفاعلن متفاعلن ))متَفاعلن (مْتفاعلن
314
In terms of English poetry, it can read as follows: (a=/ stressed syllable; b=x unstressed
syllable)
a a a b a a b (a b a b a a b)/ a a a b a a b/ a a a b a a b
/ / / X / / X (/ X / X / / X) / / / X / / X / / / X / / X
This should not be mistaken for an English meter, since five, six, seven or eight-feet meter
(pentameter, hexameter, heptameter and octameter consecutively) are odd and quite rare in English
prosody in the first place (see Leech, 1969:104-19). The most popular English feet and, hence, meters are
(from the most to the least popular):
To aid memory, the famous Romantic poet, S.T. Coleridge devised a verse of six lines about these
meters/feet (from 1-5), entitled ‘Metrical Feet’ ()تفعيالت حبور الشعر:
Metrical Feet
So, English prosody is different from Arabic prosody, sometimes sharply. Yet, broadly speaking,
both are based on rhyme, rhythm, meter and foot.
The more important point to focus on is the drastic changes made on the English original
in the Arabic version. Although the general sense is retained, many things have been
sacrificed for the sake of producing a classical Arabic poem with perfect rhyme and rhythm.
Indeed, it sounds like any perfectly written Arabic poem with all its aesthetic features and
poetic atmosphere. It is translated in accordance with what we called in the introduction for
this book, ‘bound free translation method’, which is partly faithful to the original, and partly
departs from it. At first sight, the poem looks completely new, but a careful consideration will
confirm that it is derived directly from the English poem, apparently by retaining key words
315
like (أشجار ، جلد، سائر، خائف، سامع، رعب، طري...) and the ongoing dialogue among the characters
of the original in particular.
It must be admitted that the process is quite hard to go through safely and properly. It is extremely
difficult to convert an English poem into an Arabic poem the way exemplified for here, for translators are
not thought of as poets. Therefore, students of translation are not required to worry about producing such
translation of poetry. The first version is closer to what is normally expected in the process of translating
English poetry into Arabic. After all, to translate poetry satifactorily, we are not required to be poets.
Rather, we can have a bash at translating poetry with sense, first, and rhyme and rhythm, second, in case
we cannot achieve both. Certainly such a translation would be much poorer than the original, but it
manages to get the message through at least, which is the minimum requirement here.
The fact remains that producing a perfectly rhymed, metered and footed Arabic poem like the one
suggested in the second version of the last two poems, is not impossible. Good knowledge of both
English and Arabic, familiarity with Arabic prosody and rules of rhyme and rhythm, and accumulated
experience can guarantee good translation and possible solutions to the problems of translating poetry in
general.
Calm and deep peace on this high wold, هدوء وسكينة عظيمة على ذي التلة العاليه
And on these dews that drench the furze, bوعلى قطرات الندى هذه تُبَلِل اجلولق الشوكيه
And all the silvery gossamers ولعابات الشمس الفضيه
That twinkle into green and gold: تتألأل باألخضر وذهبيه
316
Calm and deep peace in this wide air, سكون وهدوء عميق يف هذا الفضاء الواس ِع
These leaves that redden to the fall, تلك األوراق اليت ْحت َمّر حىت السقوط الدام ِع
And in my heart, if calm at all,شيء
ْ هناك لو كان،ويف قليب
If any calm, a calm despair: ئ
ْ لو كان هدوءاً لكان اليأس اهلاد
Calm on the seas, and silver sleep, والنوم الفضي،سكون على البحار
And waves that sway themselves in rest, وأمواج تؤرجح نفسها بارتياح شجي
And dead calm in that noble breast وهدوء ميت نام يف ذاك الصدر النقي
Which heaves but with the heaving deep. يتنهد التنهد العميق القوي
(Alfred Tennyson. From Carter and Long: 1987)
There is always a real problem of translation when any piece of good poetry is translated into Arabic
with equivalent sound/prosodic features and effects. In this Tennysonian poem, there is a big problem
matching its smooth rhyme in Arabic.
The Arabic translation has some kind of rhyme, but it is not as smooth, fluent and perfect
as the English original; nor is it as successful as that of the previous poem. Yet, it can be
described as satisfactory. The following points can be noticed about the translation:
1.‘Sound’ is translated into ( )ضجيجand not, ()صوت, not so much to achieve rhyme as to render
its proper sense here.
2. ‘Plain’ is translated into the plural ()سهول, instead of the singular (( )سهلi.e. change of word
class) for convenience of rhyme. That is, ( )سهلis masculine and should be followed in Arabic
by a masculine adjective, which does not fit here; whereas the plural becomes feminine,
followed by a feminine adjective to match the intended rhyme. Although rhyme and rhythm
have been taken into consideration in this version, sense has been given prime concern. In the
following version, priority is given to prosody to produce an a good poem in terms of rhyme
and rhythm (or meter and foot), in the form of Arabic ‘Free Verse’(عر احلرb )الشwhose prosodic
features are the same as in traditional poetry, with an English layout:
317
الصخب
ْ إن السكون صبيحة bدون
للعجب
ْ ما مثله إال األسى يا
وحسب
ْ ذوت منها
من بني أوراق ْ
بضرب
ْ الكستناء على الثرى اهنالت
العاليات
ْ سكن رهيب يف السهول
ات
الرمَت ْ
شوك ّ
بل َوعلى الندى قد َّ
بتموجات
ْ ونسيج مشس فضةٌ
آلت
باألخضر الذهيب هن مأَل ْ
أهدل
سهلك ُِ يا للسكون ونور
تتسه ُل
وعرائش ّ
ٌ خبريفه
تتآكلb
ُ ومزارعٌ مكتظةٌ وبروجه
يتمايل
ُ لتعانق البحر الذي
أرحبت
ْ هذي السكينة يف الفضاء
هوت
ذوت حىت ْتلك الوريقات ْ
حوت
لو كان شيء مهجيت فيها ْ
ت
صم ْ
لو كان شيء فالقنوط وقد َ
اليم هادي والكرى من ِ
فضة ُّ
واملوج مرتاح شجي الرقصةِ
وسكينة أبدية bيف ذلك الصدر الفيِت
وتنه ٌد أنّاتُه يف حسر ِة
Although the meaning of the original is only partially affected and has not undergone
many changes, modifications or additions in this relatively free version, its
grammatical/stylistic structures have suffered major changes, that are not related directly to
their English counterparts. A quick comparison between this form with that of the previous
version of the poem(see above) will illustrate the point. Three main lexical points can be
318
discussed here, followed by the most dominant grammatical/stylistic one. All of them are
conceded mainly for achieving rhyme and rhythm:
(a) Inclination toward preferring more classical, or frozen formal words like:
( شجي، الكرى، اليم، قنوط، مهجة، هوى، أرحب، أهدل، اهنال، ثرى، ذوى، أسى،)صخب
ّ
(c.f.حزين ، النوم، البحر، يأس، قلب، سقطb، وسع، خميِّم، تساقط، ذبل، حزن،)صوت
(c) Deviation from language norms of spelling of some words justified by ‘poetic license’ to
achieve rhyme and rhythm:
(بل
ّ )- rather than the full form ()بلّل
()الرمتات- instead of the singular form ( الرمْت
َ ) to refer to one kind of thorny plants.
(مألآلت )هن- plural for the animate, to replace the inanimate plural()هي مألألة
()هادي- instead of the normal ()هادئ
(فضة...)ونسيج- is preferred to the grammatical ()من فضة
ِ )من- with ‘kasrah’ vocalization, replacing the conventional
(يف حسر ِة...فضة
ٍ )منwith tanween(or double kasrah).
(يف حسر ٍة...فضة
()هذي- instead of the well-known ()هذه
319
Certainly it is a tall order to come up with such version of a piece of Arabic poetry,
especially for the students. For this particular reason, phonological problems have been
delayed to the last part of this book, when the students may have developed their translation
skills to a satisfactory level. Then, and only then can they follow, feel and taste the process of
translating poetry, and enjoy the daunting task of struggling for the right word in the right
place for the right rhyme and rhythm in connection with meter and foot in particular.
Alliteration, assonance, consonance and other sound/prosodic features, the tools for realizing
rhythmical language, come second.
Again, the students are not required or expected to think of the translation of poetry in
terms of producing such version in Arabic. Rather, they are strongly urged to do their best to
render the message with as much rhyme and rhythm as possible. However, when they feel the
strain of getting the last two features –as usually the case- they may leave them aside and,
instead, concentrate on attaining sense in the best way possible. They can feel free at choosing
the words, phrases or collocations of different types to compensate for the losses of
phonological features.
The last two examples of this chapter are two translated passages of poetry, one from
T.S. Eliot’s famous poem, The Waste Land ()اب (اخلرابbb b b( )األرض اليبFaber&Faber, 1972),
translated by (Lu’lu’ah, 1980); and another from Shakespeare’s Play, Macbeth ()مكبث,
translated by two different translators. They are evaluated mainly from a phonological point of
view:
320
ليس.وال احلجر اليابس صوت ماء
Clearly, the translator’s sole concern here is with meaning, nothing else but meaning,
disregarding sound features and effects completely, perhaps mimicking and reflecting the
original for reasons of wastefulness of life. By this, he succeeds at the level of accuracy of
meaning, but fails at the phonological level. This failure could have been insignificant, had the
translated text not been poetry. By far, we understand that phonological features are the
milestone of any poem, or else, it might sound sterile and dispirited, as the case here. The
translator does not attend even to the lines’ endings in regard to clause and sentence
structures, ending them haphazardly, regardless of organizing them in grammatical units of
some kind. All this can be justified on the grounds that the original is equally disrupted and
un-rhymed. However, to overcome these shortcomings, and compensate for some
phonological losses, here is a suggested rhymed version:
منت
ْ وكذا الغصون وقد،ت ْ َما ذي اجلذور تشبث
يرثَ َى لك، آه يابن آدم.رت
ْ حتج
ّ من مهمالت
لك
ْ bحتزر ال علم
ُ تقدر ال
ُ ال
هيكلك
ْ متحطمه من أصنُ ٍم والشمس تضرب
bْ ٍ سوى
كومة
321
راحتك
ْ واجلندب سلب،متحجره
ْ شجره
ْ ال ظل حتت
مطر
ْ احلجر دون ْ واملاء جف عن
الصخ ْر
َ ال ظل إال حتت محراء
الصخر
ْ هنا أستظل بظل محراء
الصباح
ْ سأريك شيئاً يف
الصباح
ْ ما ظلك اجملرور ذيالً يف
صاح
ْ أو ظلك اجملرور ليالً يأيت
انشراح
ْ بل حفنة من ذا الرتاب خميفةٌ دون
Obviously, this whole version has notable rhyme and rhythm. It is much smoother and more fluent
not only than the previous version, but also than the original itself which is not rhymed, but with rhythm,
though. Therefore, perhaps it is the favorable version of translation in Arabic for its proximity to Arabic
poetry of good rhyme and rhythm, which is an established norm in the versification and reception of this
poetry, whether classical or modern. Equally important is the sense which is not marginalized this time. A
quick comparison between this and the previous version will confirm that. Apart from one or two words
and phrases added here and there (e.g. راحbb انش،احbb ص،ً اجملرور ليال،ً اجملرور ذيال،رbb مط،كbb هيكل،كbbرثى لbb)ي, which are
concluded from context, there is almost no difference between them in this respect. The major difference
is marked at the level of grammatical structure of word order (e.g. ، محراء الصخر، املاء جف،اجلندب سلب راحتك
رتاب خميفةbb حفنة من ذا الinstead of : رتابbb حفنة خميفة من ذا ال،خر أمحرbb b ص، جف املاء،كbb bدب راحتbb لب اجلنbb ;)سaddition of
connection and small words like ( بل، دونb،ال، و، آه،دbb ;)قand some deviations of words and vocalization
from the common norms for convenience of rhyme and rhythm (e.g. ( )ذيfor( )هذه, ( )كذاfor ( )كذلكshort (
)آin ()آه, shortened ( )ىin ()يرثى, long /u:/ ( )ضمةin (حيزر... ُ يقدر
ُ ), a final stop( )سكونin( متحطمه bْ ), the change
of (خورbbص/خرb ْ b )صinto (خرb
َ b)ص, shortened ( )اin ()هنا, the change of the normal collocation (ر أذيالهbّb )جinto (
ً)اجملرور ذيال, and the shortening of (احيبbb )يا صinto (احbb )صonly). Surely, had the translator of the previous
version worked harder, he would have achieved a better rhyme and rhythm in Arabic. In any case, the
suggested version has been made easier to rewrite by leaning heavily on this ready-made version. Still,
the concern of the students and translators is to attain meaning in the first place.
4.2.6. MACBETH (reacting to the news of the death of his wife, Lady Macbeth)
322
There would have been a time for such a word.
Tomorrow, and tomorrow, and tomorrow,
Creep in this petty pace from day to day,
;To the last syllable of recorded time
And all our yesterdays have lighted fools
!The way to dusty death. Out, our brief candle
Life’s but a walking shadow, a poor player
That struts and frets his hour upon the stage,
And then is heard no more: it is a tale
Told by an idiot, full of sound and fury,
Signifying nothing.
)(William Shakespeare, Macbeth: Act V, scene v
َم ْكبِ ْ
ث
تؤدة ومن " كان ينبغي أن متوت فيما بعد لكن يوجد وقت أنسب إلبالغي مبثل هذا اخلرب .غد ويليه غد ،مث غد ،يزحف يف
ي bbوم إىل يbbوم ،حىت يصل إىل آخر ح bbرف يف س bbجل الزم bbان .كل األيbbام الغbbابرة يف حياتنا أض bbاءت للحمقى الطريق إىل املوت
الbbذي حييل جثتنا إىل تbbراب .ابعbbدي يا شbbعلة الوجbbود القصbbرية املدى ،ابعbbدي ،وما احليbbاة إال بطل ثbbائر ،وفنbbان مسbbكني يزهو
ويع bbزف على املس bbرح ،مث ال يسbb bمع عنه من بعد ذلك احلني إهنا قصة يسbb bردها أبلbb bه -قصة حافلة بالض bbجة واهلي bbاج دون أي
".معىن
323
ً متخبطا،يقضيها املمثل على مسرحه،
إن. مث يتوارى إىل حيث ال يرى بعد،ًتعبا
هي إال أقصوصة يقصها أبله بصيحة
كلمات فخمة على حني أهناb،عظيمة
فارغة من أي معىن.
Unfortunately, these are some of the cheap translations we have on the market in some
Arab countries. These two versions are translationese (i.e. bad translations), and good
examples of ‘commercial translations’ ()الرتمجات التجارية. They are bad translations in terms of
proper meaning, let alone the concern with sound features and effects. The two different
translations of the second line (i.e. ‘There would have been a time for such a word’) confirm
the type of inaccuracy of comprehension and, hence, translation. Adding insult to injury is the
two bad printing mistakes, one in the first (i.e. (ائرb )بطل ثfor ‘walking shadow’, instead of (ظل
))سائر, and another in the second (viz.( )ظالل عابرfor ())ظالل عابرة. To be fair, although the first
translation is a disgrace with regard to poor and miserable word-for-word literal translation,
and negligence of any aesthetic, stylistic or other feature of language and translation, the
second is better at the two levels of meaning and phonological features, like the rhyme
between ( هبا،اbb b بقربه، ;)موهتاthe repetition of ( )انطفئtwice; the alliteration between the two
consecutive words (ًتعبا... ً)متخبطا, and the layout which is that of modern poetry. Yet, and still
it is far from being satisfactory in any of those aspects.
324
خرب عنه يدور
ْ مث اختفى ال حس ال
فيها الصخب فيها من الغضب الكثري،هي قصة عن أمحق
فارغه من أي معىن كاألثري
ْ هي.
A partial realization of rhyme and rhythm is injected in this version , by investing
grammatical changes of word order and word classes, synonymy at liberty, repetitions,
contrasts (e.g. between ( )زمانvs. ( ;)مكانand ( )أضاءvs. ( ;))انطفئand some alliterative, rhymed
collocations (like (الbb bوج الbb b))ص, to mention some features only. However, overstating the
importance of sound features in such a dramatic text, is not advisable, especially when we
translate Shakespearean plays, which are works of poetry in the first place. A dramatic text
gives more space for less concentration on sounds, with more focus on the presentation and
direction of the material on stage. Hence, concern with sense is reasonably good for students
as well as translators.
In fine, phonological features and effects are sometimes crucial to meaning and text as a
whole in translation, especially poetry and commercials, where sounds can be more significant
than sense, as a means of learning, persuasion, attraction and enjoyment. As we have seen,
they create an extremely difficult problem of translation. Nevertheless, they are translatable,
mostly partly than perfectly, in different ways and versions, as illustrated and confirmed
above. The students of translation are advised to take care of them at translating certain types
of text exemplified for earlier, trying hard to reflect at least some of them in the Arabic
translation. When they fail to do so, they render meaning carefully and accurately as the last
resort. Having said that, the fact remains that the reflection of phonological features is possible
and achievable in their translation. To make this task easier to handle, and to find good
solutions to the reflection of English sounds into Arabic, the following procedures are put
forward as guidelines for the students and translators, by way of concluding this chapter:
(1) Careful reading of SL text, especially poetry, and for several times to absorb meaning
properly by reading through the lines, and between the lines, before starting translation. If
lexical, stylistic or grammatical problems of translation arise, they have to be resolved
first, before going to the next step.
(2) Translating the English text into sense in Arabic, ignoring sound features completely.
(3) Assigning a good time for considering the main phonological features of the original,
especially rhyme and rhythm as a general umbrella for common prosodic features of
alliteration, consonance, assonance, foot and meter in particular.
325
(4) Concentrating on achieving a kind of rhyme or half rhyme, first, and then rhythm of
some kind by any, some or all means that follow hereafter. Illustrative examples are
sought for in the foregoing discussion.
(5) Investing the flexibility of Arabic word order to a maximum to make any changes
necessary to accomplish the rhyme or near rhyme required, and then, rhythm of a kind, if
possible.
(6) Looking for the widest possible range of synonyms for key words and rhyme words
in particular, disregarding whether they are near or close synonyms, individual words, or
long expressions equivalent to the original lexical items, and may achieve the intended
sound features in Arabic. Informal synonyms close to standard Arabic, as much as
classical, very formal ones can be included in the scope of choice, on the condition that
they derive from the type of text and context of the original. That is, while the latter are
preferable in poetry and formal texts in general, the former are allowed only in informal
texts like advertisements, jokes, etc.
(7) Employing the changes of the grammatical classes of words freely, using an adjective
for a noun, an adverb for an adjective, a verb for a noun in Arabic, etc., so that a
considerable space is made available to help realize some key sound features.
(8) Employing the so-called poetic license in full in Arabic, in regard to stylistic, lexical
and grammatical deviations, abbreviations and short forms of words, and vocalization
with the four vocal points: ( السكون، الكسرة، الضمةb، )الفتحةanywhere in the text.
(9) Adding extra words that are not readily used in the original, but derived from the
context or implied somehow in the SL text. They also include sentence connectors and
initial words.
(10) Dropping unnecessary words, or words implied in others, or understood from the
context easily.
EXERCISES
1. In this poem by Alexander Pope, sentence structure is disrupted, word order is not
fluent, and several deletions occur for convenience of rhyme and rhythm. First,
reorder sentences in their normal sequence, and retrieve deleted words and
expressions by way of paraphrase, so that they can be read and understood fluently
and easily. Then, translate the poem with more emphasis on message than rhyme, or
rhythm (the first step, reordering words normally, is done below. Reordered elements
are underlined, and deleted items are in brackets):
326
“ ’Tis with our judgments as our watches; none
Go just alike, yet each believes his own.
In poets as true Genius is but rare,
True Taste as seldom is the Critic’s share;
Both must alike from Heav’n derive their light,
These born to judge, as well as those to write.
Let such teach others who themselves excel,
And censure freely who have written well.
Authors are partial to their wit, ’tis true.
But are not Critics to their judgment too?”
(From Pope’s An Essay on Criticism (1711). In Bradford, 1996: 108)
(A paraphrase)
“Like our watches, our judgments do not look alike, yet each … own.
Genius among poets is rare, True taste of the critic’s share is seldom;
Both must derive their light from Heaven alike,
These (critics were) born to judge, as well as those (poets were born) to write.
Let such (critics and writers) teach others who excel themselves,
And censure … written well.
It is true that authors are partial to their wit.
But are not critics (partial to their judgment) too?”
2. In the following poem, ‘London’, William Blake employs ‘poetic license’ a number
of times with regard to omitted sounds/letters and deviant grammatical structure.
Spot these omissions and violations first. Another prominent stylistic/lexical feature
here is repetition. Translate the poem, re-echoing all instances of repetition, and
exploiting poetic license to the full in Arabic, to produce the best possible rhyme and
rhythm, to the sacrifice of a part of the message:
327
Every black’ning Church appalls;
And the hapless Soldier’s sigh
Runs in blood down Palace walls.
(London, by William Blake: op.cit.: 150)
(N.B. ‘Thames’: the river running through London: (اميزbb ‘ ;)هنر التmanacles’: handcuffs(;)أغالل
‘Palace’: maybe Buckingham Palace (باكينغهام )قصر, the royal Palace in London)
3. These four stanzas from ‘ The hunchback in the Park’(احلديقة دب يفbb )األح, a poem by
the Twentieth Century’s British poet, Dylan Thomas, are two sentences only. The
only punctuation mark used twice is the full stop at the end of the second and fourth
stanzas. Therefore, a careful reading and full understanding of the sentence and
clause structure, then contents are preconditions for translating the poem in as full
rhyme and rhythm as possible. Guidelines for analyzing sentence structure, and
translating into rhymed and rhythmical Arabic verse, are given below. Use these
guidelines to complete the analysis of the sentence structure and translation of the
remaining stanzas of the poem in as rhythmical Arabic version as possible. When this
is unattainable, sense has to be properly translated:
328
Past lake and rockery
Laughing when he shook his paper
Hunchbacked in mockery
Through the loud zoo of the willow groves
Dodging the park keeper
With his stick that picked up leaves.”
(From Dylan Thomas’ ‘The Hunchback in the Park’. In Cambridge Book of English Verse
(1939-1975), 1976: 66-67)
4. Translate this poem with as much rhyme and rhythm as possible, with equal interest
in meaning. The former is lively in English and can be matched in Arabic somehow.
As to the latter, it is essential here and need to be handled with extra care and
accuracy, in regard to contrastive, juxtaposed phrases (especially ‘hollow men’ vs.
‘stuffed men’; ‘headpiece’ vs. ‘filled with straw’; ‘shape’ vs. ‘form’; ‘shade’ vs.
‘color’; ‘paralysis’ vs. ‘force’; ‘gesture’ vs. ‘motion’; ‘lost’&‘violent souls’ vs.
‘hollow men’), repetitions, and organic, absolute unity of subject matter in every line
329
and throughout. Try to invest Arabic abstract expressions like (وأحالم الbb bام البغbb bأجس
( )العصافريLiterally: mules’ bodies and sparrows’ minds (i.e. Mickle head, little wit));(
التنبbb( )رأس مليء بLit. a head filled with straw/hay);( َخامbداخل ُسbام ومن الb( )من اخلارج خLit.:
neat outside, and soot inside);( ;)شكل من غري مضمونetc.
330
And flickered his two-forked tongue from his lips, and mused a moment,
And stooped and drank a little more,
Being earth-brown, earth-golden from the burning bowels of the earth
On the day of Sicilian July, with Etna smoking.
331
CONCLUSIONS
This ambitious Textbook of Translation for University Students and Trainee Translators
has attempted to achieve the ultimate objective of locating the most recurrent and important
problems of translation come across by the students of translation as well as translators in
practice. Alongside that, possible solutions have been suggested to these problems with a mine
of illustrative examples.
The Book’s approach to translation has based on viewing it in terms of problems and
solutions. The four main types of translation problems discussed almost exhaustively (i.e.
grammatical, lexical, stylistic and phonological) have covered in broad terms most problem
areas of the Subject of Translation. It has been shown that although lexical problems are
weightier and greater in number, the other three types are not marginal. On the contrary, they
demand more careful attention from teachers of translation, students of translation as much as
translators in general. Undermining them would result in misunderstanding, ambiguity,
mistranslation, and/or loss of a part of meaning at least. Thus, the full picture of the
comprehensiveness of the approach as well as translation could have been achieved only by
considering the four types of problems, accompanied by possible solutions, based on criteria
like context and types of text, language and readership in particular.
Phonological problems are included in this hugely revised and extended edition of the
book because they are significant in some texts like advertising, literature, especially poetry.
Although they are difficult and complicated for the students at this early stage of study, they
can be handled at a later stage of study. That is why they have been discussed in the final
chapter of the book.
The lexical problems of translating cultural terms have also been included in this new
edition, because of the exceptional role of culture in understanding language and, hence,
translation in certain texts at least. In addition to that, miscellaneous cultural hints have been
made occasionally here and there in the course of discussion throughout other lexical
problems like those of the translation of collocations, fixed phrases(i.e. idioms and proverbs),
and metaphors in particular. Also, some stylistic and phonological problems of translation
display cultural aspects and backgrounds.
I may declare that this problem-solution approach to translation put forward in this work
is comprehensive, essentially practical, simplified and, therefore, easier to apply and more
suitable for the students to follow and accommodate. Moreover, it does not adopt a
presupposed theory according to which examples have been devised. Rather, it has viewed the
discipline of translation in practical terms in teaching, learning as well as application, without
presuppositions. Most of the problems of translation are defined in various types of text and
context, plainly, directly and with specification. Practice-based solutions have been suggested
332
to them, so that the whole subject of translation has become complete, concrete and more
convincing, I hope.
On the other hand, all the examples used in this book have been translated as closely and
directly as possible. Free, pragmatic, or showy translations are avoided because they cannot be
easily justified either textually or contextually in clear, straightforward terms, especially for
the students at the early stages of translation courses. Yet, these are not dismissed as
unacceptable for they can be applicable in certain texts and contexts of literary, rhetorical,
expressive and aesthetic nature, at advanced stages of translation classes.
It is important to point out here that four new sections and a whole chapter have been
added in the edition: The translation of (a)sentence connectors (ch.1); (b)cultural terms (ch.2);
(c)punctuation and (4)irony (ch.3); and (5)phonological problems (ch.4). Furthermore, a
number of sections (especially those on the translation of verb ‘do’, ‘synonymy’ and technical
terms) have been extended, and many examples added and/or slightly modified throughout.
On top of that, a few modifications and additions have recently been made on the theoretical
background of the Introduction, concerning the free method of translation and the priority
order of the points of discussion in particular.
It is hoped that teachers, students of translation and translators can benefit from the
practical approach of this textbook and put it to use. It is also hoped that it can be enriched and
developed by interested and experienced teachers, translators and readers. Translation is a
field of knowledge that is wide open and has not been exhausted yet.
333
REFERENCES
Abdu, M.(eds) Nahjul-Balagha of Al-Imam Ali Bin Abi Taleb, (Egypt: Dar Al-
Marifah).
Abu Risha, Y. (1986-7), Applied Translation, (Damascus: Ibn Kaldun Press).
Akil, F. (1988), Dictionary of Psychology (English-Arabic), (Beirut: Dar Al-Raed
Al Arabi).
Al-Akbari, A. B. H(1976), At-Tibian Fi lrabi-L-Quran, Two vols. (Beirut: Dar
Ash-Sham Lit-Turath).
Al-Bustani, B. (1977), Muhit-Ul-Muhit: Arabic Language Dictionary, (Beirut:
Librairie du Liban).
Alexander, R.(1984a), “Fixed Expressions in English: Reference Books and the
Teacher”, in English Language Teaching Journal, vol. 38, no. 2, PP. 127-34.
Ali, A. Y. (1946), The Holy Quran: Text, Translation and Commentary, (Jeddah:
Islamic Cultural Centre).
Al-Khuli, M. (1982) A Dictionary of Theoretical Linguistics, English-Arabic,
(Beirut: Libraire du Liban).
Al-Kasimi, A. (1979), “ Problems of Technical Terminology in Arabic
Lexicography”, in Hartmann, R (ed.)Dictionaries and their Users, (University
of Exeter), PP 111-18 .
Al-Kasimi, A.(1980), “An-Nazariyya Al-'amma Liwad’i Al-Mustalahat Wa-
Tawheediha Wa-Tawtheeqiha” Al-Lisan Al-Arabiyy(Rabat: Maktab Tanseeq
At-Ta’reeb), vol 8, 1.
334
Al-Khatib, A. (1971), A New Dictionary of Scientific&Technical Terms:English
Arabic(2000 edn), (Beirut: Libraire du Liban )
Al-Maydaani, A. (1996), Majmaa Al-Amthaal(4vols.), Beirut: Dar Al-Jeel)
Alvarez,R. and Vidal, M.(ed.)(1996) Translation, Power, Subversion (Multilingual
Matters Ltd., Clevedon, Philadelphia, Adelaide).
Aziz, Y. (1982), “Cultural Problems of English-Arabic Translation”, Babel, vol
1, PP 25-29.
Al-Mu’jam Al-Waseet,(Arabic-Arabic) (1987), (2nd edn), (Beirut: Amwaj)
AlMunjid Fil-Luga Wal-Alaam,(Arabic-Arabic) (1987), (29 th edn), (Beirut: Dar Al-Mashreq).
Ash-Shalquni, A. H. (1977), Masader Al-Lugah(Tripoli: Al-Munsha a L-Aammah
Lin-Nashr).
Ath-Thaalibi, A. B. (1981), Fiqhu L-Luga, (Tripoli and Tunis: Ad-Dar Al-Arabiyyah
Lil-Kitab).
Baalbaki, M. (2005), Al-Mawrid Al-Akbar: A Modern English-Arabic Dictionary,
(Beirut: Dar El-Ilm Lil-Malayin).
Baalbaki, M. (1991), Al-Mawrid: A Modern English-Arabic Dictionary(22nd
edn), (Beirut: Dar El-Ilm Lil-Malayin).
Baalbaki, R.(1988), Al-Mawrid: A Modern Arabic-English Dictionary, (Beirut:
Dar EL-Ilim-Lil-Malayin).
335
Carter, R. (1987), Vocabulary: Applied Linguistic Perspectives, (London: Allen&
Unwin).
Carter, R.(ed). (1982), Language and Literature : An introductory Reader in Stylistics,
(London: George Allen&Unwin).
Carter, R. and Long, M. (1987), The Web of Words: Exploring Literature Through
Language, (Cambridge University Press).
Carter, R. and McCarthy, M. (1988), Vocabulary and Language Teaching,
(London: Longman).
Carter, A. and Nash. W. (1983), “Language and Literariness”, Prose Studies,
6 2 PP 123-41.
Carter, A. and Nash, W. (1990), Seeing Through Language: A Guide to Styles of
English Writing, (Basil Blackwell).
Catford, J.(1965), A Linguistic Theory of Translation, (London: Oxford
University Press).
Chapman, R.(rev) (1977), Roget’s International Thesaurus, (Fourth edn), (New
York: Harper&Row Inc)
Collins (1979), Collins English Dictionary, (2000 Millenium edn.), (Harper Collins
Publishers).
Collins (1995), Collins Thesaurus: The Ultimate Wordfinder From A to Z(3rd edn: 2003),
(Harper Collins Publishers).
Collins (1979), Collins English Dictionary, (2nd edn. 1986),(London&Glasgow: Collins).
Courtney, R. (1983), Longman Dictionary of Phrasal Verbs, (4th edn. 1992), (Longman).
Cowie, A.(1981), “The Treatment of Collocations and Idioms in Learner’s
Dictionaries”, Journal of Applied Linguistics, 2, 3, PP. 223-35.
Cruse, D. A.(1977), “The Pragmatics of lexical Specificity”, Journal of
Linguistics, vol. 13, PP. 153-64.
Cruse, D A.(1982), “On Lexical Ambiguity”, Nottingham Linguistic Circular,
vol. 11, no 2, PP. 65-80.
Crystal, D. (1984), Who Cares about English Usage, (Penguin).
Crystal, D.(1980 b), A Dictionary of Linguistics and Phonetics, (London:
Deutsch).
Crystal, D.and Davy, D.(1969),Investigating English Style (Longman).
Cummings, M.and Simmons, R.(1983), The Language of Literature, (Pergamon
Press).
A Dictionary of Scientific and Technological Terms, English-Arabic(1982),
(Beirut &Tripoli: Al-inmaa' Arabi Institute).
Dar Al-Kutub Al-Ilmiyyah, (1990), Macbeth (Arabic Translation), (Beirut: Lebanon)
The Daily Express British Newspaper (2000: No. 25)
Dickens, C., A Tale of Two Cities.
Dickens, C, Hard Times
Didaoui, M.(1992), Ilm-At-Tarjamah Bayna An-Nazariyyah Wat-Tatbeeq, (Susa,
Tunis: Dar Al-Maaref).
Duff, A.(1981), The Third Language, (Pergamon Press).
336
Durant, A. and Fabb, N.(1990), Literary Studies in Action, (Routledge).
Eliot, T. S. (1972), The Waste Land and Other Poems, (Faber and Faber: London).
Elyaziji, I. (1970) An Arabic Book of Synonyms and Collocations(in Arabic), (Beirut:
Libraire de Liban).
Fabb, N., Attridge, D., Durant, A. and MacCabe, C.(eds)(1987), The Linguistics
Of Writing: Arguments between Language and Literature, A conference,
(Manchester University Press).
Faruqi, H.(1988), A Dictionary of Law: English-Arabic, (5th edn.), (Beirut:
Librairie du Liban).
Fawcett, P. (1998), “Ideology and Translation”, in Baker, M.(ed.), Routledge
Encyclopedia of Translation Studies, (Routledge: London and New York), pp.
106-111.
FIT (1993), Translation-The Vital Link, A Conference, 2 vols. (London: The
Chameleon Press Limited).
Fowler, H. (1926), Fowler’s Modern English Usage (2nd ed. 1965), (O.U.P.)
Fowler, R.(1981), Literature as Social Discourse: The Practice of Linguistic
Criticism, (London: Batsford).
Freeborn, D., French, P. and Langford, D.(1986), Varieties of English, (2nd edn.,
1993), (Macmillan).
Al-Ghalayeeni, M.(1999) Jame' Ad-Durus Al-Arabiyyah(3vols.) (Arabic)(Al-Maktabah
Al-Asriyyah: Sayda&Beirut).
Ghazala, H. (2012a) Translating the Media and Political Idiom: A Textbook for University
Students, (Konooz Al-Marifa: Jeddah, Saudi Arabia).
Ghazala, H.(2012c) A Course in Literary Stylistics, (Konooz Al-Marifa: Jeddah, Saudi Arabia).
Ghazala, H. (2011) Cognitive Stylistics & the Translator (Sayyab Books: London).
Ghazala, H. (2007a), Dal El-Ilm Dictionary of Collocations:A Comprehensive English-Arabic
Dictionary of Accuracy of Word Combination and Usage (Beirut: Dar El-Ilm Lil-Malayin).
Ghazala, H. (2007b), "Simultaneous Development of SL & TL Skills in a Translation
Class", A Conference, Sultan Qaboos Univ. Oman.
Ghazala, H. (2005), "At-taareeb fi zamanit-Taghreeb", Proceedings of Language in the
Age of Globalization: A Symposium, King Khaled Univ. KSA, Vol. I, pp. 92-101.
Ghazala, H. (2002a), “The Translator’s Dilemma with Bias”, in Babel, 48:2, pp. 147-62.
Ghazala, H. (2002b), “ Allegory in Arabic Expressions of Speech and Silence: A
Translational-Stylistic Perspective”, Accurapid Internet Translation Journal, vol. 6:2,
pp. 1-47,USA.
Ghazala, H.(2002c), “Cross-Cultural Links in Translation: English-Arabic”, Bahri
International Journal of Translation: vol. 14:1, pp137-62, India.
Ghazala, H.(2001), “At-Taareeb Min Alifihi Ilaa Yaa-ihi”, At-Taareeb Journal, vol.21:1
Ghazala, H. (1996), A Dictionary of Stylistics and Rhetoric (English-Arabic/Arabc
English), (Elga Publications: Valetta, Malta).
Ghazala, H.(1995), “Stylistic Translation”: English-Arabic, in FIT Newsletter,
XIV, Nos 1-2, pp. 7-38.
Ghazala, H.(1994a), “Stylistic Pedagogical Procedures in an EFL Classroom”,
337
Abhath Al-Yarmouk, vol.10, No.2, PP.71-94.
Ghazala, H.(1994b), Varieties of English Simplified: A Textbook for Advanced
University Students(2nd edn., 1999), (Malta: Elga).
Ghazala, H.(1993), “The Translation of Collocations”: Arabic-English (in
Arabic), Turjuman, vol.2, no.1, pp.7-44.
Ghazala, H.(1993), “The Translation of Collocations”: English-Arabic(in
Arabic, Turjuman, vol.2 no PP.7-33.
Ghazala, H.(1993), “The Dilemma of Arabization: dotting the i’s and crossing
the t’s”, the First Conference on Arabization, Benghazi, Libya..
Ghazala, H.(1992), Al-Jame fit-Trajamah(A.Translation of Newmark’s A Textbook
of Translation(1988)(2nd edn. 200, the Complete Trans). (Valletta, Malta: Elga).
Ghazala, H.(1992), “The Problem of Duality in Translation and Arabization”,
(Unpublished conference proceedings, Musratah: Libya).
Ghazala, H.(1987), Literary Stylistics: Pedagogical Perspectives in an EFL
Context, (Ph.D.Thesis, University of Nottingham, (UK).
Gimson, A.C. (1981), An Introduction to the Pronunciation of English (3rd edn.),
(Edward Arnold, London).
Haddad, E.W.(1987), A Dictionary of Data Processing and Computer Terms,
English-French-Arabic, (Beirut: Librairie du Liban).
Halliday, M.A.K.(1975), Learning How to Mean, (London: Arnold).
Halliday, M.A.K.and Hasan, R.(1976), Cohesion in English, (Longman).
Hatim B. and Mason, I. (1990), Discourse and the Translator, (London
and New York: Longman).
Hatim, B. and Mason, I. (1997), The Translator as Communicator, (Routledge:
London and New York).
Hill, J. and Lewis(ed.) (1997), Dictionary of Selected Collocations(2nd.ed.1999)
(London: LTP Language).
Hitti, Y. and Al-Khatib, A. (1989), Hitti’s New Medical Dictionary: English-Arabic,
(Beirut: Libraire de Liban).
Hleil, M.(1990), “Collocations and Translation” (in Arabic), Proceedings of
Professional Arabic Translation and New Technologies: A Round Table,
PP.31-50 (Tanger, Morocco).
Holder, R. (1987), The Faber Dictionary of Euphemisms, (Faber&Faber).
Holmes, J. (1970), The Nature of Translation: Essays on the Theory and Practice
of Literary Translation, (The Hague. Mouton).
The Holy Quran.
Jamal, G. (19?), Macbeth (Arabic translation), (Dar Al-Qalam: Beirut)
Jeffries, L. (2010) Stylistics (Cambridge University Press)
Joos, M.(1962), “The Five Clocks”, International Journal of American
Linguistics, 28, 2, pts, (Bloomington).
Joyce, J.(1941), Dubliners, (edn.1983) (London: Granada).
Karmi, S. (1987), Al-Mughni Al-Akbar: A Dictionary of Classical and Contemporary
English (English-Arabic), (Beirut: Libraire de Liban).
338
King Fahd Complex (1996) The NobleQuran: English Translation of the Meanings
and Commentary, (King Fahd Complex for the Printing of the Holy Quran:
Al-Madinah Al-Munawwarah, K.S.A.).
Leech, G.(1981), Semantics, (2nd edn) (Harmondsworth: Penguin).
Leech, G.(1969), A Linguistic Guide to English Poetry (London: Longman).
Leech, G, Deuchar, D. and Hoogenraad, R.(1982), English Grammar for Today:
A NewIntroduction, (Macmillan).
Leech, G. and Short, M..(1981) Style in Fiction: A linguistic Introduction to
English Fictional Prose, (London and New York: Longman).
Longman, (1979), Longman Dictionary of English Idioms, (4th edn. 1992),
(Longman).
Lefevere, A. (1992), Translation Rewriting&the Manipulation of Literary Fame,
(London and New York: Routledge).
Lulu’a, A. (1980), Al-Ardu L-Yabab: The Poet and the Poem (Arabic Translation
of T.S. Eliot’s The Waste Land), Arabian Institution for Studies and Publication:
Beirut).
Lyons, J.(1981), Language, Meaning and Context, (London: Fontana).
Lyons, J.(1977), Semantics, 2.vols, (Cambridge: Cambridge University Press).
Makkai, A.(ed.) (1984), Barron’s Handbook of Commonly used American Idioms,
New York, London, Toronto, Sydney: Barron's Educational Series, Inc.
Mansi, A. and Ibrahim, A. (!988), Translation: Its Fundamentals, Principles and
Applications (in Arabic), (Mars Publishing House: Riyadh, K.S.A.).
Mason, 1.(1988), “The Role of Translation Theory in the Translation Class”,
Quinquereme, 5, 1, PP.18-33).
Mclntosh, A.(1966), “Patterns and Ranges”, in Mclntosh, A. and Halliday, M.A.K.,
Patterns of Language: Papers in General, Descriptive and Applied Linguistics,
(London Longman), PP.182-99.
Nash, W. (1980), Designs in Prose, (Longman).
Nash, W. (1985), The Language of Humour: Style and Technique in Comic
Discourse,(London and New York: Longman).
Nash, W. (1989), Rhetoric: The Wit of Persuasion, (Blackwell: Oxford
and Cambridge
Newmark, P. (1998), More Paragraphs on Translation, (Multilingual Matters Ltd:
Clevedon, Philadelphia, Adelaide).
Newmark, P. (1993), Paragraphs on Translation, (Multilingual Matters Ltd:
Clevedon, Philadelphia, Adelaide).
Newmark, P. (1991), About Translation, (Multilingual Matters Ltd: Clevedon,
Philadelphia, Adelaide).
Newmark, P. (1988), A Textbook of Translation, (London :Prentice Hall).
Newmark, P. (1981), Approaches to Translation, (Oxford: Pergamon Press).
Nida, E.(1964), Towards a Science of Translating with Special Reference to
Principles and Procedures Involved in Bible Translating, (Leiden: E.J. Brill).
Oxford(2002),Oxford Collocations Dictionary for Students of English(4th impression,
339
2003), (OUP).
Oxford (1983), Oxford Dictionary of Current Idiomatic English, (OUP).
Palmer, F. (1981), Semantics: A New Outline, (2nd edn). (Cambridge: Cambridge
University Press).
Partridge, E. (1978), A Dictionary of Catch Phrases, (Routledge).
Pickthall, M. M. (1980), The English Translation of the Glorious Koran with
Introduction and Notes, (3rd impression), (George&Allen Unwin).
Quirk, R. and Greenbaum, S. (1973), A University Grammar of English, (Longman).
Quirk, R. and Stein, G. (1990), English in Use, Longman).
Richards, J.C. (1970), “A Psycholinguistic Measure of Vocabulary Selection”,
IRAL, vol.8.no.2, PP.87-102.
Robinson, D. (1997), Becoming a Translator,( Routledge :London and New York).
Ritter, H.(ed.) (1983), The Mysteries of Eloquence of Abdul-Qahir Al-Jurijani,
(Beirut: Dar El-Massirah).
Rudzka, B., Channel, J., Ostyn, p. and Putseys, T.(1985), The Words You Need,
(London: Macmillan).
Sabeq, J. (1985), A Dictionary of Economics: English-Arabic(Beirut: Dar Sabeq).
Safwat, A. (1963), Al-Kamel Fi Qawaed Al-Arabiyyah, Nahwiha Wa Sarfiha, 2.vols,
(Egypt: Mustafa l-Babi L Halabi Publication House).
Sallum, A. and Noor Al-Deen, H. (1990), Handbook of Al-Khalil’s Prosody
(in Arabic), (Dar Al-Uloom Al-Arabia: Beirut).
Shakespeare, W. (1977), Macbeth, (ed. Lott, B.), (Longman).
Simpson, P.(2004), Stylistics: A Resource Book for Students(Routledge:
London&New York)
Sinclair, J.M. and Jones, S.(1974), “English Lexical Collocations”, Cahiers de
Lexicologie, vol.24, PP.15-61.
Snell-Hornby, M. (1988), Translation Studies: An Integrated Approach, (John
Benjamins Publishing Company: Amsterdam/Philadeliphia).
Stetkevych, J. (1970), The Modern Arabic Literary Language, (Chicago: Chicago
University Press).
A Team of University Teachers, (1985), A Dictionary of English Idioms:
English-Arabic, (Beirut: Librairie du Liban).
Theodory, C. (1986), Al-Mounged Dictionary: English-Arabic, (Oriental Library).
Thornborow, J. and Wareing, S. (1998), Patterns in Language, (Routledge:
London and New York).
Toolan, M. (1998), Language in Literature: An Introduction to Stylistics, (Arnold:
London, New York, Sydney, Auckland).
The Twentieth Century Chambers English Dictionary, (1983).
Vermeer, H. (1998), “Didactics of translation”, in Baker, M.(ed.), Routledge
Encyclopedia of translation Studies, (Routledge: London and New York),
pp. 57-60.
Wahbi, M. (1974), A Dictionary of LiteraryTerms: English-French-Arabic,
(Beirut:Librairie du Liban).
340
Wales, K. (1989), A Dictionary of Stylistics, (Longman).
Webster’s English Dictionary, (1961), (Longman).
Webster’s New Collegiate Dictionary, (1965), (Springfield, Massachusetts,
U.S.A.).
Wehr, H.and Cowan, J.M. (1976), A Dictionary of Modern Written Arabic,
(Third edn), (Ithaca, New York: Spoken Language Services, Lnc.).
SELECT BIBLIOGRAPHY:
1680-1711
Dryden, John. Preface to his translation of Ovid’s Epistles. 1680.
Preface to Sylvae: or, the Second Part of Poetical Miscellanies. 1985.
Dedication to his translation of the Aeneis. 1697.
Preface to his translation of the Fables. 1700.
“The Life of Lucian.” 1711.
1715
Pope, Alexander . Preface to his translation of the Iliad.
1790
Tytler, Alexander Fraser. Essay on the Principles of Translation. Edinburgh. Rep .
Edinburgh. Repr. Edinburgh: Neill&Co., 1813.
1791
Cowper, William. Preface to his translation of The lliad/of Homer.
1827
Goethe, Johann Wolfgang Von. “Letter to Carlyle, 20 July”. Reprinted in
Goethe-Briefe. Berlin: D. Eisner, 1902-5.
1861
341
Arnold, Matthew. “On Translating Homer” London. Reprinted in Essays Literary
and Critical. Introduction and Notes by W.H. D. Rouse. London: John Murray, 1905.
Newman, Francis W. Homeric Translation in Theory and Practice: A Reply to Matthew
Arnold. London: Williams and Northgate.
Rossetti, Dante Gabriel. Preface, in The Early Italian Poets.
1918
Ritchie, R.L.G., and Moore, J. M. Translation from the French. Cambridge:
Cambridge University Press.
1919
Phillimore, J.S.“Some Remarks on Translation and Translators”. The English
Association Pamphlet 3, no.42. Oxford: Oxford University Press.
1920
Amos, Flora Ross. Early Theories of Translation. New York: Columbia University
Press.
Pound, Ezra. “Translators of Greek: Early Translators of Homer: In Instigations.
Reprinted in Literary Essays of Ezra Pound. Ed. and with an introduction
by T.S. Eliot. Norfolk, CN: New Directions, 1954. This essay was composed of
parts of an earlier series that originally appeared in the Egoist 5(7-9), 1918, and
6 (1-2), 1919.
1922
Postgate, J. P. Translation and Translations: Theory and Practice. London: G. Bell
and Sons.
1924
Belloc, Hilaire.“On Translation” In London Mercury 10: 150 ff. London.
Reqrinted in A Conversation with an Angel and Other Essays(London,
1929)and on Translation: The Taylorian Lecture (Oxford: Clarendon Press, 1931).
1927
Conley, C.H.The First English translators of the Classics. New Haven: Yale
University Press.
1930
Smith, F.Seymour. The Classics in Translation: An Annotated Guide to the Best
Translations of the Greek and Latin Classics into English. London: Charles
Scribner’s Sons.
1931
Matthiesssen, F.O. Translation: An Elizabethan Art. Cambridge: Harvard University
342
Press. Repr. New York: Octagon Books, 1965.
1932
Richards, 1.A.Mencius on the Mind: Experiments in Multiple Definition. New York:
Harcourt, Brace and Company.
1933
Lathrop, H.B. Translations from the Classics into English from Caxton to
Chapman 1477-1620. University of Wisconsin Press.
1936
Bates, E. Stuart. Modern Translation. London: Oxford University Press.
1941
Nabokov, Vladimir. “The Art of Translation”. New Republic 105.
1943
Bates, E. Stuart. Intertraffic: Studies in Translation. London: Jonathan Cape.
1947
Nida, Eugene A. Bible Translating: An Analysis of Principles and Procedures,
With special Reference to Aboriginal Languages. New York: American Bible
Society.
1953
Auden, W.H.“Translation and Tradition: A Review of Ezra Pound’s Translation”.
Encounter 1: 75-78.
1955
Frost, William. Dryden and the Art of Translation. New Haven: Yale University
Press. Nabokov, Vladimir. “Problems of Translation: Onegin in English”. Partisan
Review 22 .
1956
Austin, R.G.“Some English Translations of Virgil: An Inaugural Lecture”. Liverpool.
Leishman, J.B. Translating Horace: Thirty Odes Translated into the original metres
with the Latin text and an Introductory and Critical Essay. Oxford Bruno Cassirer.
Rosenberg, Justus. “Constant Factors in Translation”. In On Romanticism and the
Art of Translation: Studies in Honor of Edwin Hermann Zeydel. Princeton:
Princeton University Press.
1957
343
Knox, R.A. On English Translation: The Romanes Lecture Delivered in
the Sheldonian Theatre 11 June 1957.Oxford: Clarendon Press
Savory, Theodore. The Art of Translation. London. Repr. Boston. The Writer,
Inc., 1968.
1958
Booth, A.D. et.al., eds. Aspects of Translations: Studies in Communication 2.
London: Secker and Warburg.
Jacobsen, Eric. Translation: A Traditional Craft. Copenhagen: Nordisk Forlag.
1959
Brower, Reuben A.ed.On Translation. Cambridge, Mass: Harvard University Press.
Jakobson, Roman.“On Linguistic Aspects to Translation” In On Translation:
Cambridge, Mass: Harvard University Press.
1961
Arrowsmith, William, and Shattuck, Roger, eds. The Craft and Context of Translation.
Austin: University of Texas Press.
1963
Cary, Edmond, and R.W. Jumpfelt. Quality in Translation: Proceedings of the IIIrd
Congress of the International Federation of Translators, Bad Godesberg, 1959.
New York: Macmillan.
1964
Nida, Eugene. Toward a Science of Translating with Special Reference to
Principles and Procedures Involved in Bible Translating. Leiden: E.J.Brill.
1965
Catford, J.C. A Linguistic Theory of Translation: An Essay in Applied Linguistics.
London: Oxford University Press.
1966
Selver, Paul. The Art of Translating Poetry. Boston: The Writer, Inc.
1967
Levy, Jiri.“Translating as a Decision Process”. In To Honor Roman Jakobson:
Essays on the Occasion of his Seventieth Birthday, 11 October 1966. Paris:
Mouton.
1969
344
Nida, Eugene A.,and Taber, Charles R. The Theory and Practice of Translation.
Leiden: E.J.Brill. Waley, Arthur. “Notes on Translation”. Delos 3: 159-69.
1970
Day-Lewis, C. On Translating Poetry: The Jackson Knight Memorial Lecture,
University of Exeter 1969. Abingdon-on-Thames: Abbey Press.
Holmes, James, editor. The Nature of Translation: Essays on the Theory and
Practice of Literary Translation. The Hague: Mouton.
Nims, John Frederick.“Poetry Lost in Translation?” Delos 5: 108-26.
1971
Proetz, Victor. The Astonishment of words: An Experiment in the Comparison
of Languages. Austin: University of Texas Press.
Raffel, Burton. The Forked Tongue: A Study of the Translation Process. The Hague:
Mouton.
The World of Translation(Papers delivered at the Conference on Literary Translation,
New York City in May, 1970). New York: PEN American Center.
1972
Haugen, Einar. The Ecology of Languages: Essays by Einar Haugen, selected and
introduced by Anwar S. Dil. Stanford University Press.
Mason, H.A.To Homer Through Pope: An Introduction to Homer’s ILiad and
Pope’s Translation .New York: Barnes and Noble.
Tate, Allan. The Translation of poetry: A Lecture. Washington, D.C. Library of
Congress.
1973
Adamas, Robert M.Proteus: His Lies, His Truth: Discussion of Literary Translation.
New York: W.W. Norton.
Partridge, A.C. English Biblical Translation. London: Andre Deutsch.
1974
Walsh, Donald D. “Poets Betrayed by Poets” In Fact and Opinion, PP.140-44.
1975
Davie, Donald. Poetry in Translation. Walton Hall, Milton Keynes: The Open
University Press.
Steiner, George. After Babel: Aspects of Languages and Translation London:
Oxford University Press.
Steiner, T.R. English Translation Theory: 1650-1800. Amsterdam: Van Gorcum.
1976
Brislin, Richard W., ed. Translation: Applications and Research. New York:
Gardner Press.
345
Levy, Jiri. “The Translation of Verbal Art”. In Semiotics of Art. Cambridge, Mass.:
MIT Press.
1977
Lefeveré, Andre. Translating Literature: The German Tradition From Luther To
Rosenzweig. Amsterddam: Van Gorcum.
1978
Barnstone, Willis. “ABC’s of Translation”. Translation Review 2. 35 -36.
Beaugrande, Robert de. Factors in a Theory of Poetic Translating. Amsterdam:
Van Gorum.
Bellitt, Ben. Adam’s Dream: A Preface to Translation. New York: Grove Press.
Kelly, L.G. The True Interpreter: A History of Translation Theory and Practice
in the West. Oxford : Blackwell .
1980
Bassnett-McGuire, Susan. Translation Studies. London: Methuen.
Cohen, Jonathan. “Neruda in English: A Critical History of the Verse Translations
and their Impact on American Poetry”. Ph.D.diss, State University of New York
at Stony Brook.
Felstiner, John. Translating Neruda: The Way of Macchu Picchu. Stanford:
Stanford University Press, 1980.
Hawkes, David, “The Translator, The Mirror and the Dream: Some Observations
on a New Theory. “Renditions 13: 5-20.
Zeber, Ortun, ed .Languages of the Theater: Problems in the Translation and
Transposition of Drama. Oxford: Pergamon Press.
1981
Gaddis-Rose, Marulyn, ed. Translation Spectrum: Essays in Theory and Practice.
Albany: State University of New York Press.
Jones, Frank. “Translation: Fun or Folly? Georgia Review 35 (3): 557-70.
Newmark, Peter. Approaches to Translation. Oxford: Pergamon Press.
1982
Larson, Mildred L. “Translation and Semantic Structure”. Estudios Filologicos
17: 7-21.
1983
Clayton, J. Douglas. “the Theory and Practice on Poetic Translation in Pushkin and
Nabokov”. Canadian Slavic Papers 25: (1): 90-100.
Frawley, William. ed. Translation: Literary, Linguistic, and Philosophical
346
Perspectives. Newark: University of Delaware Press.
1985
Gibbons, Reginald. “Poetic Form and the Translator” Critical inquiry 11(4): 654-71.
Graham, Joseph, ed. Difference in Translation. Ithaca: Cornell University Press.
The essay by Jacques Derrida, “Des Tours de Bable”, was originally published
in this collection.
Honig, Edwin. The poet’s Other voice: Conversations on Literary Translation.
Amherst: University of Massachusetts Press.
Riffaterre, Michael. “Transposing Presuppositions on the Semiotics of Literary
Translation.” Texte: Revue de Critique et de Theorie Litteraire 4: 99-110.
Scogt, Henry. “Semantic Theory and Translation Theory”. Texte Revue de Critique
et de Theorie Litteraire 4: 151-60.
Schulte, Rainer. “Transferal of Poetic Frontiers: Renovation and Innovation.”
World Literature Today 59 (40: 525-30.
Schulte, Rainer. “Translation and Reading.” Translation review 18.
1987
ITI(1987)Translation and Interpreting, A Conference, (London; Unwin Brothers).
Radice, William, and Reynolds, Barbara. The Translator’s Art: Essays in Honour
of Betty Radice. Middlesex: Penguin Books.
1988
Malone, J. (1988)The Science of Linguistics in the Art of Translation, (State
University of New York).
Newmark, Peter, A Textbook of Translation. New York: Prentice Hall.
Raffel, Burton. The Art of Translating Poetry. University Park: University of
Pennsylvania Press.
Schulte, Rainer. “Multiple Translations: An Integrated Interpretive perspective”.
Translation Review 28.
Schogt, H, Linguistics, Literary Analysis, and Literary Translation. University of
Toronto Press: Toronto Buffalo, London).
Snell-Hornby, Mary. Translation Studies: An Integrated approach. Philadelphia:
John Benjamins Publishing Co.
Worth, Valerie. Practicing Translation in renaissance France: The Example of
Etienne Dolet. Oxford: Clarendon Press.
1989
Biguenet, John and Rainer Schulte, eds. The Craft of Translation .Chicago:
University of Chicago Press.
Schulte, Rainer. “The Study of Translation: Re-creative Dynamics in Literature
and the Humanities”. Mid American Review 9 (2): 69-80.
Warren, Rosanna. The Art of Translation: Voices from the Field. Boston:
347
Northeastern University Press.
Weissbort, Daniel: ed. Translating Poetry: The Double Labyrinth. Iowa City:
University of Iowa Press.
1990
Hatim, B. and Mason, I. Discourse and the Translator, (London and New York:
Longman).
1991
Bassnet-McGuire, S. Translation Studies(Revised edn.). London: Routledge.
Bell, R. Translation and Translating: Theory and Practice. Longman.
Lefeveré, A. Redefining Translation. London: Routledge.
Newmark, P. About Translation. Multilingual Matters Ltd: Clevedon, Philadelphia,
Adelaide.
1992
Baker, M. In Other Words: A Coursebook on Translation. London and New York:
Routledge.
Didaoui, M. Ilm At-Tarjama Bayna An-Nazariyya Wat-Tatbeeq. Susa, Tunis:
Dar Al-Maaref).
Ghazala, H. Al-Jame’ Fi T-Tarjama, (A Translation of Newmark's A Textbook of
Translation: Part I(1988)). Valletta, Malta: ELGA.
Hutchins, W. and Somers, H. An Introduction to Machine Translation. Academic
Press: Harcourt Brace&Complany, Publishers, London and New York.
Lefeveré, A. Translation, Rewriting & the Manipulation of Literary Fame. London
and New York: Routledge.
Turjuman, A Journal of Translation Studies. Morocco, Tanger: King Fahd High
School of Translation.
Schulte, R. and Biguenet, J. Theories of Translation: an Anthology of Essays from
Dryden to Derrida. Chicago and London: The University of Chicago Press.
Venuti, L .Rethinking Translation. London: Routledge.
1993
FIT, Translation-The Vital Link, A Conference, 2. vols. London The Chameleon
Press Limited.
Newmark, P. Paragraphs on Translation. Multilingual Matters: Clevedon,
Philadelphia, Adelaide.
Samuelsson-Brown, G. A Practical Guide for Translators. Multilingual Matters
Ltd. ; Clevedon. Philadelphia, Adelaide.
1995
348
Bassnet, S. and Lefeveré, A. Translation History and Culture. London: Routledge.
Dingwaney, A. and Maier, C., eds. Between Languages and Cultures:
Translation and Cross-cultural Text.
1996
Alvarez,R. and Vidal, M.(eds.), Translation, Power, Subversion. Multilingual
Matters Ltd., Clevedon, Philadelphia, Adelaide.
1997
Bassnet, S. (ed.), Translating Literature.
Robinson,D., Becoming a Translator. Routledge :London and New York.
Rose, M.G., Translation and Literary Criticism: Translation as Analysis.
Shuttleworth, M. and Cowie, M., Dictionary of Translation Studies.
1998
Baker, M.(ed.), Routledge Encyclopedia of Translation Studies. Routledge:
London and New York.
Bassnet, S. and Lefeveré, A. Constructing Cultures.
Campbell, S., Translation into the Second Language. Longman: London and New York.
Jones,R. "Conference Interpreting Explained". St. Jerome Publishing: Manchester, UK.
Newmark, P., More Paragraphs on Translation. Multilingual Matters Ltd:
Clevedon, Philadelphia, Adelaide.
1999
Bassnet, S. and Trivedi, H.(eds.), Postcolonial Translation: Theory and Practice.
2002
Ghazala, H. “Cross-cultural Links in Translation”, in Bahri International Journal of Translation,
vol. 14:1, pp.137-62.
Ghazala, H. “ The Translator's Dilemma with Bias”, In Babel, 48:2, pp. 147-62
Ghazala, H. "Allegory in Arabic Expression of Speech and Silence: A Stylistic-Translational
Perspective": (Accurapid Online Translation Journal, vol. 6, pp.1-49, USA)
2003
Ghazala, H. "Idiomaticity Between Evasion and Invasion in Translation: Stylistic, Aesthetic
and Translational Considerations", Babel, vol. 49, No3, pp. 203-228)
2004
Ghazala, H. Essays in Translation and Stylistics, ( Dar El-Ilm LilMalayin: Beirut)
Ghazala, H. Al-Jame’ Fi T-Tarjama, (the Complete Translation of Newmark's
A Textbook of Translation (1988)). Valletta, Malta: ELGA.
2006
Boase-Beier, J. (2006) Stylistic Approaches to Translation, (St. Jerome Publishing,
349
Manchester, UK & Kinderhook, USA).
2007
Ghazala, H."Simultaneous Development of SL and TL Skills in a Translation Class",
A Conference, Sultan Qaboos Univ. Oman.
Pérez, M.C. Transitivity in Translating. The Interdependence of Texture and Context. (Peter Lang).
Ghazala, H. Dar El-Ilm Dictionary of Collocations: A Comprehensive Dictionary of Accuracy of
Word Combination and Usage. (Dar El-Ilm Lil-Malayin: Beirut).
2011
Ghazala, H. (2011) Cognitive Stylistics & the Translator (Sayyab Books: London).
2012
Ghazala, H. (2012a) Translating the Media and Political Idiom: A Textbook for University
Students, (Konooz Al-Marifa: Jeddah, Saudi Arabia).
Ghazala, H.(2012b) Arabization from A to Z: A Textbook for University Students, (Konooz
Al-Marifa: Jeddah, Saudi Arabia).
GLOSSARY
Abnormality شذوذ
Absolute synonymمطلق مرادف/مطلق/رديف
Abstract words كلمات جمردة
Acronym خمتصر
Active style للمعلوم
املبينbأسلوب
Adapted metaphors استعارات مقتبسة
Additive connectors/conjunctions روابط اإلضافة
Adjectival noun كنعت مستعملbاسم/اسم نعيت
Adjectives نعوت/صفات
Adverbs ظروف
Adverbs of contrastمغايرةظروف
Adverbs of frequency ظروف الورود املتكرر/ظروف التكرار
Adverbs of place ظروف املكان
350
Adverbs of time الزمان ظروف
Advertising إعالن
Adversative connectors/conjunctions روابط املغايرة
Aggressive هتجمي
Agricultural زراعي
Alliteration bسجع
Alternative بديل
Ambiguous style غامضbأسلوب
Ambiguity غموض
Anatomy تشريح
Antonymy تضاد/طباق
Applicablility تطبيقية/التطبيق إمكانية
Arab League Educational , Cultural and Scientific Organization(ALECSO)
) والثقافة والعلوم (األلكسوb العربية للرتبيةbاملنظمة
Arabic culture الثقافة العربية
Arabization/Arabicization تعريب
Arabize يعرب
ِّ
Arabized معرب
َّ
Arabized Technical terms معَّربة
َ مصطلحات فنية
Arabized terms مصطلحات معربة
Arabzid words كلمات معربة
Articles أدوات
Assonance ) األصوات(الصوائتbسجع
At sentence level على مستوى(صعيد)اجلملة
At text level على مستوى(صعيد)النص
Attached pronoun ضمري متصل
Auxiliaries )اإلجنليزية
أفعال مساعدة(يف
Auxiliary verb )فعل مساعد(يف اإلجنليزية
351
Back naturalization تطبيع عكسي
Back-translation test اختبار الرتمجة العكسية
Back translation ترمجة عكسية/ترمجة bرجعية
Bad style أسلوب bرديء
Balance توازن
Bear responsibility يتحمل مسؤولية
Beat شطر التفعيلة املشدد
Bilingual dictionary قاموس ثنائي اللغة
Biological حيوي
Borderline حد فاصل
Bound free translation ترمجة حرة مقيدة
Brace brackets أقواس متعرجة
Brackets أقواس
السببيةCausal connectors/conjunctions روابط
Cause and effect السبب والنتيجة
Central meaning معىن مركزي/معىن رئيسي
Change of word class تغيري صنف الكلمة(من اسم إىل صفة إخل).
Chemical terms مصطلحات كيمياء/كيميائية
Chiming تآلف/تقارب الصوت واملعىن
Circumstantial word حال
Clarity وضوح
Classical Arabic اللغة العربية التقليدية/العريقة
مصنِّفClassifier
Clause by clause عبارةً فعليةً عبارةً فعليةً/عبارةً بعد أخرى
Clause order ترتيب العبارات الفعلية
Clauses عبارات فعلية
Closed system irony سخرية احلَيص بَيص
Cliché metaphors استعارات مبتذلة
352
Close synonym رديف(مرادف)لصيق
Close translation ترمجة لصيقة
Cohesive devices أدوات رابطة
Coinage سك/نقش
َ
Coined مسكوك/منقوش
Collocability إمكانية التالزم/تالزمية
Collocate يتالزم/يالزم
Collocations متالزمات لفظية
Colloquial عامي
Colloquial Arabic اللغة العربية العامية
Common meaning معىن شائع/معىن عام
Common phrasal verbs أفعال مركبة شائعة
Communicative translation )ترمجة ختاطبية(حرة
Compactness تضام/إحكام
ّ
Complex irony مبطنةbسخرية/أسلوب هتكم معقد
Complex style أسلوب معقد
Complexity تعقيد
Complicated network شبكة معقدة
Complicated SL grammar قواعد اللغة األصل املعقدة
Componential analysisاملكونات حتليل
Components of metaphor مكونات االستعارة/عناصر
Comprehensiveness مشولية
Computer terms مصطلحات احلاسوب
Conjunctionربط أداة/رابطة
Connectorأداة ربط/رابطة
Connotations مضامني
Consonance الصوامتbسجع
Construction تركيب
353
Contempt احتقار
Contractions إدغامات/)اختصارات(قواعدية
Context of words سياق الكلمات
Contrastive connectors روابط املغايرة
Contrastive irony مسرحي/هتكم درامي
Contrastive styles أساليب مغايرة
Conversion )ً مثالbقلب قواعدي(بتقدمي الفعل على الفاعل يف اإلجنليزية
Co-ordination Bureau of Arabization (CBA) مكتب تنسيق التعريب
Core combination ائتالف جوهري
Core meaning معىن أساسي/معىن جوهري
Creative translation ترمجة خالقة
Criteria أسس/معايري/فياصل
Crystallized meaning معىن ُمبَلور
Countable nouns أمساء معدودة
Counter-balance )مضاد/توازن مقابل(مواز
Cultural ثقايف
Cultural ambiguity غموض ثقايف
Cultural correspondence تطابق ثقايف
Cultural differences اختالفات ثقافية
Cultural equivalent مكافئ ثقايف/مرادف
354
Dangerous translation ترمجة خطرة
Dash )شرطة(اعرتاضية/قاطعة
Dead metaphors استعارات ميتة
Definite article الـ التعريف/أداة تعريف
Degrees of expressivity درجات التعبريية
Degrees of popularity درجات الشعبية
Derivation اشتقاق
Derived Arabized terms مصطلحات معربة مشتقة
Despirited text نص ال روح فيه/نص جامد
Dictionary meaning معىن حبيس املعجم غري شائع يف االستعمال/معىن معجمي
Different styles أساليب متباينة
Dimensions of meaning أبعاد املعىن
Diminutive names أمساء مصغرة/أمساء تصغري
Direct idioms b)تعابري اصطالحية مباشرة(يف الرتمجة
Direct language لغة عادية/لغة مباشرة
Direct meaning معىن مباشر
Direct translation ترمجة مباشرة
Directness مباشرية
Disguised irony b)سخرية خفية(الذعة/هتكم م َقنّع
Dramatic irony هتكم درامي
Duality ازدواجية
Dynamic translation متغرية/ترمجة متحركة
Effect(s) تأثري/أثر
Embarrassment إرباك/إحراج
Emphasis bتوكيد/تأكيد
Emphatic redundancy حشو توكيدي
Engendering توليد
English culture bثقافة إجنليزية
355
Equative verb معادل بني كلمتني/فعل مكافئ
Equivalent مرادف/مكافئ
Equivalent style مرادفbأسلوب
Established naturalization معتمد
َ تطبيع
Established transcription معتمد
َ رسم لفظي
Established translation معتمدة
َ ترمجة
Exclamation mark إشارة التعجب
Expressive معرب/تعبريي
Expressive textsمعربة نصوص/نصوص تعبريية
Expressive word باملعاين املعربةbمليئة/معربة/كلمة تعبريية
Expressivity bتعبريية
Expressivity, context and readership التعبريية والسياق والقراء
Faithfulness أمانة/صدق
Familiar alternatives بدائل مألوفة
Familiarity ألفة
Figurative language لغة جمازية
Fixed collocations b)اصطالحية/متالزمات لفظية ثابتة(غري قابلة للتغيري
Fixed expression اصطالحي/تعبري ثابت
Fixed phrase bاصطالحية/عبارة ثابتة
Fixed metaphor اصطالحية/استعارة ثابتة
Fixed saying اصطالحي/قول ثابت
Fixed structure اصطالحية/بنية ثابتة
Fixedness اصطالحية/ثبات
Flexibility مرونة
Foot تفعيلة
Foreign culture ثقافة أجنبية
Foreign nature طبيعة أجنبية
Foreign technical term مصطلح فين أجنيب
356
Foreign term(s) مصطلحات أجنبية
Formal فصيح
Formal Arabic عربية فصحى
Formal language لغة فصحى
Formal metaphor استعارة فصحى
Formal titles ألقاب رمسية
Formal vs. dynamic translation الرتمجة الثابتة مقابل الرتمجة املتحركة
Formal vs. informal language لغة فصحى مقابل لغة غري فصحى
Formality فصاحة
Formality scale الفصاحةbسلم
Free translation ترمجة حرة
Frequency تكرارية/ورود متكرر
Front position b)موقع متصدر(يف أول اجلملة
Fronted clause عبارة فعلية متصدرة
Fronted words )كلمات متصدرة(للجملة
Fronting تصدير/تقدمي
Frozen formal (القحة)اللغة/ًالفصحى جدا
Full meaningمعىن كامل
Full stopنقطة
Full translation of meaning الكاملة للمعىنbالرتمجة
Function وظيفة
Functional view of style رؤية وظيفية لألسلوب
Generalization تعميم/عمومية
General words كلمات عامة
Genitive(case) املضاف واملضاف إليه/حالة اإلضافة
Geographical terms مصطلحات جغرافية
Good reason سبب وجيه
Grading scale سلم تدرجي
357
Grammatical complexity(complication) تعقيد قواعدي
Grammatical construction تركيب قواعدي
Grammatical function وظيفة قواعدية
Grammatical problems bمشاكل قواعدية
Grammatical structure bبنية قواعدية
Grammatical stylistic problems b قواعديةbمشاكل أسلوبية
Grammatical words كلمات قواعدية
Greater context سياق النص كله/السياق األكرب
Grouping ضم/تركيب/جتميع
Honest willingness to Arabize إرادة صادقة للتعريب
Honesty أمانة/صدق
Identical grammatical structure مطابقةbبنية قواعدية
Identical style مطابقbأسلوب
Idiom تعبري اصطالحي
Idiomatic meaning معىن جمازي/معىن اصطالحي
Image(of a metaphor) )املشبه(يف االستعارة
Impact تأثري
Implication تضمني/مضمون
Implied meaning معىن ضمين
Impolite style فظbأسلوب
Importance of style أمهية األسلوب
Inaccurate translation خاطئة/ترمجة غري دقيقة
Indefinite article )نكرة(يف اإلجنليزية/أداة تنكري
Indirect idioms b)تعابري اصطالحية غري مباشرة(يف الرتمجة
Indirect meaning معىن جمازي/معىن غري مباشر
Indirect translation ترمجة جمازية/ترمجة غري مباشرة
Innuendo irony هتكم املدح املذموم/سخرية ملاحة
ّ
Inescapable ال منجى منه/ال مفر منه
358
Inflexible ثابت/غري قابل للمرونةb
Informal غري فصيح/شبه فصيح/عامي
Informal Arabic عربية غري فصحى/عربية bعامية
Informal expressions تعابري غري فصحى
Informal language لغة غري فصحى
Informal sayings أقوال غري فصحى
Informality ال فصاحة/شبه bفصاحة/عامية
Insertions إقحامات/إدخاالت/اعرتاضات(للجملة)
Interchangeable متداخل/قابل للتبادل/متقاطع
Interpretation تأويل/تفسري
Interrogative االستفهام/استفهامي
Intimate style أسلوب bمحيم
Invasion of foreign technology غزو التقنية(التقانة)األجنبيةb
Irony هتكم/سخرية
Language Academies اجملامع اللغوية/جمامع اللغة العربية
Language components مكونات/عناصر اللغة
Language stock خمزون اللغة/املخزون اللغوي
The last resort املالذ األخري/أضعف اإلميان
Legal language لغة قانونية
Levels of meaning مستويات املعىن/طبقات املعىن
Lexical ambiguity غموض لفظي
Lexical family عائلة لفظية
Lexical items ألفاظ
Lexical problems مشاكل معجمية/مشاكل لفظية
Lexical set جمموعة bلفظية/جمموعة مرتادفات
Lexical words كلمات معجمية
Line of camels صف/رتل من اجلمال
Linguistic context سياق لغوي
359
The lion’s share حصة األسد
Literal vs. free translation احلرةb احلرفية مقابل الرتمجةbالرتمجة
Literal meaning غري جمازي/سياقي/شائع/دقيق/معىن حريف
Literal translation الرتمجة احلرفية
Literal translation of meaning احلرفية(الدقيقة)للمعىنbالرتمجة
Literal understanding فهم حريف
Literary collocation متالزم أديب
Literature أدب
Logical acceptability تقبل منطقي
Long sentencing b الطويلةbأسلوب(استعمال)اجلمل
Loose free translation )ترمجة حرة طليقة(من القيود
Machine terms bمصطلحات(أمساء)اآللة
Main verb فعل رئيسي
Major linguistic context )شامل/سياق لغوي كبري(عام
Meaningful ذو معىن/ذو مغزى
Measurement قياس
Measures )مقاييس(لغوية
Medical terms مصطلحات طبية
Message رسالة/فحوى
Metaphor استعارة
Metaphorical جمازي/استعاري
Metaphorical meaning جمازي/معىن استعاري
Metaphorical use استعمال جمازي
Metaphor-word ) مكونات االستعارةbالكلمة االستعارة(كأحد
Methods of Arabization طرق التعريب
Methods of translation طرق الرتمجة
Metonymy كناية
Metre(meter) )حبر(يف الشعر
360
Ministry terms مصطلحات الوزارات
Minor linguistic context سياق لغوي صغري(حمدود)
Mistranslation سوء ترمجة/ترمجة خاطئة
Misinterpretation سوء تأويل/تفسري خاطئ
Modal verbs أفعال مساعدة(يف اإلجنليزية)b
Modals )را املادة السابقة(
)Modern Standard Arabic(MSA اللغة العربية الفصحى احلديثة(املعاصرة)
Modification وصف(قواعدي)
Monolingual dictionary قاموس أحادي اللغة
Monosemic word كلمة bوحيدة املعىن
Monosemy أحادية املعىن
Muslim culture الثقافة اإلسالمية/ثقافة املسلمني
MSA را( (Modern Standard Arabic
Naturalization تطبيع(كلمات أجنبية
Naturalize يُطَبِّع
Naturalized word كلمة bمطبَّعة
Near synonymy ترادف قريب/تقرييب
Neologism مستَ َجدة/كلمة bجديدة
Newly Arabized terms معربة حديثاًكلمات َّ
Nominal vs. verbal sentences مجل امسية مقابل مجل فعلية
Nominalization امسية/استعمال األمساء من دون األفعال
Non-creative vs. creative translation ترمجة خالقة (إبداعية)مقابل ترمجة غري خالقة(غري إبداعية)
Non-frequency عدم توارد/عدم ورود متكرر
Non-literal translation ترمجة غري حرفية
Non-metaphorical use استعمال غري جمازي
Non-Muslim culture ثقافة غري إسالمية
Non-pragmatic vs. pragmatic translation ترمجة غري مقصدية مقابل ترمجة مقصدية
Non-standard measures مقاييس غري معيارية
361
Non-technical terms مصطلحات غري فنية/غري ختصصية/شعبية
Normal word order ترتيب كالم اعتيادي(مألوف)
Normality اعتيادية/ألفة
Noun substitution استبدال االسم
Objectivity موضوعية/حيادية
Obligation إلزام/قسر/فرض/فريضة
Off-beat شطر التفعيلة املخفف
Official style أسلوب bرمسي(منمق)b
One-to-one literal translation ترمجة حرفية واحد بواحد
Onomatopoeia حماكاة الصوت للمعىن
Original metaphor استعارة أصيلةb
Over-exaggeration إغراق/مغاالة/إفراط يف املبالغة
Paragraph by paragraph فقرةّ فقر ًة/فقر ًة بعد أخرى
Parallel مواز
Parallelism تواز
Paraphrase شرح (مقتضب)
Parentheses أقواس هاللية(اعرتاضية)b
Parliamental terms مصطلحات برملانية
Particle أداة
Passive اجملهول/املبين للمجهولb
Passive vs. active style أسلوب املبين للمجهول مقابل أسلوب bاملبين للمعلوم
Patches َرقَع
Pedantic skill مهارة متشدقة/مهارة مفتعلة
املتشدقون/املتحذلقونPedants
نقطةPeriod
Phonological problems مشاكل صوتية
Phonology دراسة األصوات
Phrasal verbs أفعال مركبة
362
Phrase عبارة
Phrase by phrase عبارةً عبارةً/عبارةً بعد أخرى
Pitch طبقة الصوت
Poetry شعر
Political establishments مؤسسات سياسيةb
Polysemic word كلمة متعددة املعاين
Polysemy املشرتك اللفظي/تعدد املعىن
Polysemous تعددي/متعدد(املعىن)
Pompous translation ترمجة طنانة رنانة
Poor text نص فقري/نص رديء(األسلوب)b
Poor translation ترمجة فقرية/ترمجة رديئة
Popular synonyms مرتادفات شعبية
Practical approach منهج عملي
Pragmatic translation ترمجة مقصدية/ترمجة bالنوايا
Precede and proceed يسبق ويلحق
Precision of translation دقة الرتمجة
Prepositional phrase اجلار واجملرور
ّ
Prepositional verbs أفعال جرية/أفعال متبوعة حبرف جر
Problem by problem مشكلةً مشكلةً/مشكلةً بعد أخرى
Presupposed theory نظرية مسلم هبا/مفرتضة مسبقاً
Process of translating عملية القيام بالرتمجة/عملية bسري الرتمجةb
Prosody َعروض
Proverbs أمثال/حكم
Provocative tone نغمة حتريضية/أسلوب استفزازي
Pun تورية
)Punctuation(marks عالمات الرتقيم(الرتقني)b
Purist صفوي/متزمت
Purism صفوية/تزمت
363
Questions bأسئلة
Question mark إشارة استفهام
Quotation marks مزدوجان/عالمات اقتباس
Reactionary irony ردة الفعلbسخرية/هتكم انفعايل
Readership مجهور القراء/ُقّراء
Real meaning معىن فعلي/معىن حقيقي
Recent metaphor استعارة حديثة
Recognized translation ترمجة معتمدة/ترمجة معرتف هبا
Recurrence/recurrency توارد/ورود متكرر/رواج
Redundancy إطناب/حشو
Redundant إطنايب
Relevance(to meaning) )صلة وثيقة(باملعىن
Religious phrase عبارة دينية
Religious titles ألقاب دينية
Render b)ينقل(معىن يف الرتمجة
Rendition )نقل(نص يف الرتمجة
Repetition تكرار
Repetition and variation التكرار والتنويع
Retention of redundancy اإلبقاء على احلشو
Retranslate يرتجم ثانية/ من جديدbيرتجم/يعيد الرتمجة
Revival إحياء
Revived Arabized terms مصطلحات معربة حميية
Rhyme قافية
Rhythm إيقاع
Right translation ترمجة صحيحة
Root verb اجلذر/الفعل اجلذر
Satisfactory translation ترمجة مرضية
Scansion/scanning تقطيع شعري
364
Scientific discoveries bاكتشافات علمية
Scientific terms مصطلحات علمية
Self-correction )تصحيح الذات(ذايت
Semantic داليل/معنوي
Semantic vs. communicative translation التخاطبيةb املعنوية مقابل الرتمجةbالرتمجة
Semi-collocation شبه متالزم لفظي
Semi-colon فاصلة منقوطة
Semitic language لغة سامية
Sensible translation )ترمجة معقولة(مقبولة
Sensitive حساس
Sensitivity حساسية
Sentence by sentence مجلةً بعد أخرى/ًمجلةً مجلة
Sentence connectors روابط(أدوات ربط) اجلمل
Serious mistake خطأ جسيم
Shade of ambiguity أثر غموض/غموض طفيف
Sharp tone نغمة حادة
Short sentencing اجلمل القصريةb)أسلوب(استعمال
Show of muscles إبراز العضالت/استعراض العضالت
Silly mistake غري متوقع/سخيف/خطأً أبله
Simile تشبيه
Simple style بسيطbأسلوب
Simplicityبساطة
SL (Source language (را
Slang سوقي
Social acceptability قبول(تقبل)اجتماعي
Socratic irony هتكم سقراطي/سخرية القدر
Solution by solution حالً بعد آخر/ًحالً حال
Source language(SL) bاألصل/اللغة املصدر
365
Special expression تعبري خاص
Specialist institutions مؤسسات متخصصة
Specific culture ثقافة خاصة
Square bracketsمربعة أقواس
Standard meaning معتمد
َ معىن/معىن معياري
Step by step ًخطوةً خطوة
Strange irony املتناقضاتbهتكم/)سخرية غريبة(عجيبة
Strangeness غرابة
Stress نرب/شدة
Strong language لغة قوية
Style أسلوب
Style of indirectness أسلوب املراوغة/أسلوب غري مباشر
Stylistic device مسة أسلوبية/أداة أسلوبية
Stylistic effect تأثري أسلويب
Stylistic equivalence مرادفة أسلوبية/ترادف أسلويب
Stylistic feature مسة أسلوبية
Stylistic function bوظيفة أسلوبية
Stylistic impact تأثري(أثر)أسلويب
Stylistic problems bمشاكل أسلوبية
Stylistic reason مربر أسلويب/سبب أسلويب
Stylistic tone bنغمة أسلوبية
Stylistics دراسة األسلوب/)علم األسلوب(األساليب/أسلوبية
Subjectivity شخصانية/ذاتية
Sublime رفيع/سام
Substitute verb فعل بدبل
Subtitled T.V. series/programs مسلسالت تلفزيونية مرتمجة/برامج
Superficial translation خاطئةbترمجة/ترمجة سطحية
Sunna(h) )السنة(الشريفة
366
Surprising metaphor )استعارة مدهشة(مثرية
Synonymous مرتادف/مرادف/تراديف
Synonyms مرتادفات/مرادفات
Synonymy )لفظي/ترادف(معجمي
Syntactic ambiguity غموض حنوي
Syntactic complexity تعقيد حنوي
Target Language(TL) الرتمجة/اللغة اهلدف
Technical terms مصطلحات فنية
Temporal connectors/conjunctionsb)توقيتية(شرطية روابط
Term مصطلح
Tester translation b)ترمجة اختبارية(جتريبية
Theories of translationالرتمجة نظريات
Title لقب
TL (Target language(را
Tone (of voice) )نغمة(الصوت
Tools of Arabization وسائل التعريب
Topic and comment املبتدأ واخلرب
Tradition تراث/تقليد
Traditional approach منهج تقليدي
Trainee translators مرتمجون متدربون
Transcription نسخ/رسم لفظي
Transference نسخ/حتويل
Transmission نقل
Transmit ينقل
Translation coupletbثنائية/)(ترمجة
ثنائي
Translation label)ترمجة مؤقتة(مشروطة
Translation procedures حلول(ملشاكل) الرتمجة/إجراءات الرتمجة
Tripletbثالثية/)ثالثي(ترمجة
367
Type of readership نوع(نوعية)القراء
Type of text منط النص
Type of text and context منط النص والسياق
UN acronyms خمتصرات األمم املتحدة
Unclarity انعدام الوضوح/ال وضوح
Uncommon meaning معىن غري شائع
Uncountable nouns أمساء غري معدودة
Unified theory نظرية موحدة
Unit by unit وحد ًة وحد ًة/وحد ًة بعد أخرى
Unit of translation وحدة ترمجة/جزء من املعىن
Unity of Arabization وحدة التعريب
Unseen meaning معىن غري مرئي/معىن خفي
Unsuitable readers قراء غري مناسبني
Unsuitable context سياق غري مناسب
Vandalism ختريب/العيث فساداً
Variation تنوع/تنويع
Verbal sentences مجل فعلية
Verbal word order ترتيب كالم فعلي/ترتيب اجلملة الفعلية
Verbalization فعلية/تفعيل/استعمال األفعال دون األمساء
)Version(of translation رواية(ترمجة)b
Vocabulary مفردات اللغة/رصيد الكلمات
Vocal cords احلبال الصوتية
Voice صيغة/صوت
Vowelization / vocalization تشكيل/شكل(باحلركات األربع)
Vulgar سوقي
Vulgar Arabic اللغة العربية السوقية
Well-established translation ترمجة معتمدة
West Germanic Language لغة جرمانية غربية
368
Western culture ثقافة غربية
Westernization تغريب
Word by word كلمةً كلمةً/كلمةً bبكلمة/كلمة بعد أخرى
Word-for-word translation ترمجة كلمة bبكلمة
Word in combination كلمة bمرتكبة(مع غريها)/يف السياق
Words in isolation كلمات منفردة(مبعزل عن غريها)/خارج السياق
Words of contrast كلمات مغايَرة
Words of obligation كلمات اإللزام/كلمات الوجوب
Word order ترتيب كالم/ترتيب كالمي/ترتيب كلمي
Word play تالعب باأللفاظ
Wrong translation ترمجة خاطئة
Zero article غياب أداة التعريف؛ التنكري(النكرة)
369
SUBJECT INDEX
370
Common meaning 12-13 Foot 295, 307-309
Communicative translation 4 Formal 224-229
Complexity 237 Formal Arabic 226-228
Complexity of style 237-241 Formal metaphor 149
Componential analysis 204-205 Formal vs. dynamic translation 4
-conditional sentences 67 Formality 224
Consonance 294 Formality scale 224
Contrastive irony 266 Free translation 13
Countable nouns 119 Fronting 230
Creative translation 4 Frozen formal 224
Cultural ambiguity 236 Full stop 280
Cultural equivalent 195-196 Functional view of style 223-223
Cultural meaning 193-209, 236 Geographical terms 183
Cultural metaphors 151 Gloss/glossary 208
Cultural problem 193-209, 236 Grammatical complexity 237-241
Cultural terms 193-209 Grammatical problems 28-82
Cultural titles 173-181 Holy Quran 93, 99-100, 284
Cultural193-209 Idiom(s) 128-137
Cultural-specific 195 Idiomatic meaning 128-137
Dangerous translation 85 Indirect idioms 130
Dash 281 Indirect meaning 11-12
Dead metaphors 147-48 Informal 224-229
Degrees of expressivity 90-91, 257 Informal Arabic 226-229
Derivation 163 Informality 224-229
Derived Arabized terms 163 Innuendo 269
Different equivalence 141 Instrument names/terms 163-64
Diminutive names 174 Joke 300
-direct and indirect objects 80 Language Academies 163
Direct idioms 128-130 Language components 2
Direct meaning 10-11 Levels of meaning 89-91
Direct translation 10-11, 146 Lexical problems 83-221
Disguised irony 267 Lexical set 89-91
Dramatic irony 265 Linguistic context 24
Dynamic translation 4 Literal meaning 12-13
Engendering 162 Literal translation 5-13, 83-88
English culture 236 Literal translation of meaning 10
Exclamation mark 282 Literal vs. free translation 4
Expressivity 257-258 Literary collocation 117-118
Expressivity, context and readership 257 Long sentences 237-241, 244-245
Familiar alternative terms 95-96 Loose free translation 15-17
Figurative language 145 Loose translation 15-17
Fixed phrase(s) 128 Measures 163-64
Flexibility of collocations 124 Metaphor 145-155
371
Metaphorical meaning 12, 84-88 Pragmatic translation 4
Meter 294, 307, 308 Prepositional collocations 114
Methods of Arabization 156 -present participle vs. gerund 54
Methods of translation 4 Process of translation 3-4
Metrical foot 308 Proper names 172
-ministries 181 -proper names, political establishments,
Modal auxiliaries/modals 37 geographical terms 172
-modals 37 Proverbs 138-144
Monosemic word 98 Pun 145
Monosemy 98 Punctuation marks 272
Multiplicity of synonymous versions 94-95 Question mark 281
Muslim culture 15-16, 236 -questions 41
Naturalization 159 Quotation marks 284
Near synonymy 89 Reactionary irony 267
Negation 43 Real meaning 12-13
-negation 43 Recent metaphors 153
Neologisms 165 Recognized translation 207
Newly Arabized terms 165-66 Redundancy 253-256
Nominal sentences 47 Religious titles 179-180
Nominal vs. verbal sentences 47 Repetition 249
Nominalization 262 Repetition and variation 249
Non-creative vs. creative translation 4 Revival 162
Non-literal meaning/translation 4, 128 Revived Arabized terms 162-163
Non-Muslim culture 236 Rhyme 294-318
Non-pragmatic vs. pragmatic translation 4 Rhythm 294-318
Off-beat 294 Scanning/scansion 295
One-to-one translation 7-8 Scientific terms 156-171
Original metaphor 153 Semantic vs. communicative translation 4
Parallelism 232 Semi-colon 280
Paraphrase 206, 320-324 Sensitivity 180
Parliamentarian terms 182-183 -sentence connectors 72
Passive vs. active style 246 Short sentences 242-243
-past participle 56 Show of muscles 257
-personal pronouns 52 Simile 117-118
Phonological problems 294 Simple style 237
Phrasal verbs 104, 133-137 Slang 224, 226
Pitch 295 Slang Arabic 226
Poetry 299-318 Socratic irony 265
Political establishments 181-183 Special phrases 128
Polysemous 98 Spoken Arabic 226
Polysemy 98 Standard metaphors 149
Pompous translation 258 Stress 295
Practical approach 26 Style 222-224
372
Style of ambiguity 235
Style of formality vs. in formality 224
Style of fronting 230
Style of irony 265
Style of long sentencing 244
Style of nominalization vs. verbalization 262
Style of parallelism 232
Style of redundancy 253
Style of repetition and variation 249
Style of short sentencing 242
Stylistic problems 222
Stylistics 222
Sunna(h) 15-16
Synonym 89-97
Syntactic ambiguity 235-236, 299-318
Syntactic complexity 237
Technical terms 156-171
Technical translation 156-171
Temporal connectors 79
Tense 61
-tenses 61
Theories of translation 4
Titles 176
Tone 295
Traditional approach 26
Transcription 156
Translation couplet 201
Translation label 206-207
Translation of:
Translation triplet 202
Types of collocations 106
Types of metaphor 147
UN acronyms 186-191
Uncountable nouns 120
Unit of translation 4-
Unity of Arabization 171
Variability of collocation 123
Variation 249
-verb ‘BE’ 28
-verb ‘DO’ 32
373
-verb ‘HAVE’ 35
Verbal sentences 262
Verbal word order 49
Verbalization 47, 262
Vocabulary 2
Vulgar Arabic 226
Western culture 236
Westernization 157
Word order 49
Word-for-word literal translation 5
Words of contrast 774, 94
374